Introduction to Maserati
Volume 1
2009 Edition
English version
Training Documentation for Maserati Service Network
Introduction to Maserati
Introduction
EXCELLENCE THROUGH PASSION
Welcome to Maserati!
You are about to be part of one of the most glorious and renowned names in motoring
history. Maserati stands for more than 90 years of motoring heritage.
Technical innovation, craftsmanship, refined design and countless victories in motor sport
have continuously characterised the long Maserati history. Maserati vehicles express the
maximum Italian style and passion for automobiles.
Let the Maserati passion come to you and be prepared to make an important step in your
professional life.
This manual will introduce you to Maserati and its products. It will take you briefly through
the history of the company and give an overview of its road cars; you will get familiar with
the technical aspects of the most recent Maserati models and its mechanical and electrical
systems and components; it will introduce you to vehicle diagnostics and will take you
through a number of aspects of the Maserati service organisation. During this journey you
will meet some of the most interesting technical constructions in automotive history.
And this is just the first step. If you successfully walk through the simple steps of the
Maserati Academy training program, you will be able to improve your skills and acquire an
in-depth technical knowledge of Maserati vehicles. This will allow you to improve on
servicing Maserati cars on behalf of the customer, the dealer and Maserati – therefore on
behalf of you!
To succeed it is also important for you to be always sensitive for the real needs of the
customers and the people around you in the workshop. Real customer service starts with
your willingness to offer help!
Confident that you will easily grow accustomed to the Maserati service organisation, we
wish you a good and successful start!
Maserati Academy
2
Introduction to Maserati
Index
Index
Volume 1
Introduction
2
1.
Introduction to Maserati
•
Historic overview of Maserati
•
The Maserati Company today
•
Maserati road cars
•
Prototypes and Concept cars
•
The Maserati Connection
4
5
17
22
44
48
2.
Maserati models – technical introductions
•
Coupé, Spider & Gransport (M138)
•
Quattroporte (M139)
•
Quattroporte MY09 (M139)
•
GranTurismo (M145)
49
50
60
160
173
Volume 2
•
GranTurismo S (M145)
223
3.
Mechanical components – technical introductions
•
4200 Dry sump engine
•
4200 Wet sump engine
•
4700 Wet sump engine
•
Robotized gearbox
•
ZF automatic gearbox
•
Modular transmission shaft
•
Graziano differential
258
259
279
302
309
347
361
369
4.
Electric and electronic systems
377
5.
Diagnostics
412
Maserati Academy
3
Introduction to Maserati
1
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati Academy
4
Introduction to Maserati
Historic Overview of Maserati
Hystoric Overview of Maserati
The Maserati Brothers
The Maserati brothers, seven male sons, were all born in a small house on the outskirts of
Voghera, in the province of Pavia, where their father, Rodolfo, a railway engine driver, had
moved from Piacenza after marrying Carolina Losi. Carlo, the eldest son, was born in
1881, Bindo in 1883, Alfieri in 1885: the latter died after only a few months and his name
was given to the next son, born in 1887. Then Mario (1890), Ettore (1894) and Ernesto
(1898) were born.
With the exception of Mario, who turned his creative vocation towards painting, they all
became involved in engineering, in modification and later in design and construction of
automobiles and engines.
The initial experiences were gained by Carlo Maserati.
Carlo the oldest son, who as a very young apprentice in a bicycle factory at Affori, near
Milan, designed a monocylindrical engine in 1898 to power a velocipede. He even found a
patron, the Marquis Michele Carcano di Anzano del Parco who, together with his son
Cesare, started a factory for the production of bicycle engines in the same year.
Maserati Academy
5
Introduction to Maserati
Historic Overview of Maserati
Carcano took part in motor cycle competitions for a few seasons and with Carlo Maserati
riding, some successes were gained such as the Padova-Bovolenta, the 5 km record and
the Brescia-Mantova-Verona-Brescia race, all in 1900. The following year (1901) the
Carcano firm ceased its activity and Carlo Maserati went to work first for Fiat (the current
owners of Maserati) and then, in 1903, for Isotta Fraschini, as technical adviser and testdriver. He quickly made a career for himself: in 1907 he was with Bianchi, in 1908 with
Junior as General Manager, but in 1919 his young life was cut short with an illness.
In 1903, when Carlo joined Isotta Fraschini, he also persuaded them to hire his brother
Alfieri, who was only sixteen, but with a passion at least equal to his refined mechanical
sensitivity. These two qualities were destined to become related in Alfieri with the
progressive expression of his uncommon creative talent.
Alfieri Maserati soon made a name for himself at Isotta Fraschini (where his brother Bindo
and Ettore later followed) both as a technician and as a driver and later the Milanese firm
sent him and his brother Ettore to Argentina, then to London and finally, in 1912 to
Bologna with the task of organising customer service. Two years later Alfieri Maserati set
out on his own.
Maserati Academy
6
Introduction to Maserati
Historic Overview of Maserati
1914-1937: The first Maserati
The 14th of December, 1914, was a normal Monday just like
any other. Italy, the only "great power" of Europe not to have
been overwhelmed by what was to pass into history as the
First World War, was half way through the ten illusory months
which separated its short-lived proclamation of neutrality
(August 2nd , 1914) from its fatal entry into the conflict on
May 24th of the following year.
These were certainly not propitious times for any sort of
business initiative, except perhaps for arms and munitions
factories. Nevertheless, on that cold winter's day towards the
end of the year, the "Societa Anonima Officine Alfieri
Maserati" was born in Bologna at a ground floor office rented
in Via de' Pepoli. A "trademark" was about to be added to the
list of those which "had made" the history of the automobile.
Maserati Academy
7
Introduction to Maserati
Historic Overview of Maserati
Starting business with a workshop specialising in race preparation for Isotta Fraschini
engines, Alfieri was joined by Ettore and Ernesto Maserati (20 years and 16 years old
respectively) and five mechanics. It was the beginning of a legend!
At the outbreak of war, Alfieri and Ettore were called up for action and the workshop was
entrusted to young Ernesto. When Alfieri completed his military service, he set up a spark
plug factory in Milan while hostilities continued and in 1919 moved it to Bologna and
returned with his brothers Ettore and Ernesto. A new site was acquired for the workshop
on the eastern outskirts of the city in an area known as the Alemanni quarter but which
was better known as the Ponte Vecchio. These years were agitated not only by deep
social unrest and upheavals but also by a great fervor of activity in industrial reconversion,
reconstruction initiatives and growth in every sector of the economy. Even at Maserati
activity resumed intensely.
Race modifications were based on Isotta Fraschini mechanics but every now and then
other marques were used especially for Alfieri Maserati's race appearances, which were
becoming more and more frequent as well as promising. The Isotta Fraschini Tipo
Speciale was built in 1920 and this coupled a series-built chassis to a four-cylinder engine
of 6330cc . Alfieri drove this car brilliantly in 1921 races winning the Susa-Moncenisio and
coming fourth at the Mugello Circuit and the Gentleman GP in the Settimana di Brescia. In
1922, Alfieri, together with his brother Ernesto, used an improved version of this car to win
the Mugello Circuit in record time, the Susa Moncenisio again and the Aosta-Gran San
Bernadino.
Maserati Academy
8
Introduction to Maserati
Historic Overview of Maserati
These victories impressed the directors of Diatto who offered Alfieri Maserati a car for the
remaining races of the season together with a technical consultancy contract for
preparation of their competition models. The Monza victory in the GP d'Autunno (3000cc
class), gave rise to big expectations, but was not to be followed up in 1923. In spite of
numerous retirements and the not too healthy state of the company, that same year Diatto
helped Maserati to build a unique racing car powered by a 5000 cc Hispano Suiza V-8
cylinder engine which had been radically modified. This car enabled Alfieri to win the
Coppa Principe Amedeo and gave him his third consecutive victory in the Susa
Moncenisio, followed by his second in the Aosta-Gran San Bernadino.
1924 was less successful and the year in which Ernesto Maserati made his racing debut
with some good results, while Alfieri, after having dominated the San Sebastian GP was
unable to finish because of engine failure. Then he was unceremoniously disqualified (for
five years, but condoned a few months later), for having replaced the two litre engine of
Diatto with a three litre for the Rabassada Hill climb, not too far from Barcelona.
Forced to give up racing, Alfieri dedicated more of his time to work in the factory and this
enabled him to build a Grand Prix Diatto for the 1925 season powered by an eight
cylinder, two litre engine designed to be fed with a supercharger. However, the unhealthy
economic situation at Diatto brought a definite end to the Maserati brothers' collaboration
and so, in the winter between 1925 and 1926, they committed themselves to construction
of an entire car, which would be the first to carry their name ... the Maserati Tipo 26.
Maserati Academy
9
Introduction to Maserati
Historic Overview of Maserati
The first car they were wholly responsible for was the Tipo 26, built in 1926. The engine
was an 8-cylinder in line with a 1.5 litre supercharged displacement that developed 120
bhp at 5300 rpm. Above the radiator a then unknown badge presented a trident that
evoked Bologna's famous statue ofThe Tipo 26 made its debut with Alfieri Maserati at the
wheel and Guerino Bertocchi as mechanic in the Targa Florio on April 25 1926. It came
first in its class, ninth overall.
After that the wins came thick and fast. In
1929 Maserati won the Tripoli Grand Prix
(Borzacchini-E. Maserati) and the Mille
Miglia (overall winner). In the same year,
Borzacchini set a new 3-5 litre world speed
record in a Maserati Tipo V4, an
extraordinary car with a V16 engine made
by coupling together two Tipo 26 engine
blocks. The Maserati's average speed of
246 km/h was achieved from a propelled
start on a 10 km track near Cremona and
was not beaten until eight years later.
It was a performance that did a lot for the
Maserati image and sales figures.
In 1933, Tazio Nuvolari appeared on the
scene, driving the 8C to victory in the Belgian
Grand Prix, the Coppa Ciano at Montenero and
the Nice Grand Prix
Maserati Academy
10
Introduction to Maserati
Historic Overview of Maserati
The Maserati V4: the world’s first supercar
In 1929, a sensational new vehicle was presented by Maserati: the
outrageous 16-cylinder V4 race car.
The engine of this car was created by coupling two Tipo 26B 8cylinder compressor engines together in an angle of 25°. Both
engines shared the same basement and the carburettors were
designed especially for this car by Eduardo Weber.
Similar projects came also into existence by Fiat and Bugatti, and
later also by Alfa Romeo, but Maserati’s V4 project was
courageous and innovative by every standard. With its more than
280 hp, power output was almost double compared the Tipo 26B.
This car had excellent potential as a race car, but tyres and brakes
of the time were not able to hold against the power.
In September 1929, The V4 won the world land speed record by
achieving an average speed of 246,500 km/h over a 10 km straight
(non-asphalted!) near Cremona. This record was beaten only 8
years later by Bernd Rosemeyer in an Auto Union.
Only two of these spectacular V4 cars were ever made. One of
them received in 1931 an elegant new spider body from Zagato
adapted for road use and was finished in a stylish two-tone green
colour. By doing so the world’s first supercar was born before the
word was even invented.
Maserati Academy
11
Introduction to Maserati
Historic Overview of Maserati
The Orsi years: 1937-1967
Omar Orsi with
chief engineer
Giulio Alfieri and
test driver
Guerino Bertocchi
In 1937 the Maserati brothers handed over the financial management of their company to
the Orsi family, while keeping their hands on the engineering side of the business. That
opened the way to operations on a much broader scale, which bore fruit in two successive
race wins on United States soil. In 1939 and 1940, Maserati won the Indianapolis 500 with
Wilbur Shaw in an 8CTF. That made Maserati the first and the only Italian constructor to
win the legendary American race.
Meanwhile in 1939, the firm moved to its now celebrated premises on Viale Ciro Menotti in
Modena. It is here that its extraordinary creativity was deployed in the service of the Italian
war effort as it converted to the production of machine tools, electrical components, spark
plugs and even electric vehicles.
Maserati Academy
12
Introduction to Maserati
Historic Overview of Maserati
In 1957, Stirling Moss left Maserati after he had racked up numerous victories in the 250 F
but had failed to win the F1 world championship. His place was taken by Fangio who
made a triumphant debut in the Argentine Grand Prix where Maserati took all three places
on the podium. (1st Fangio, 2nd Behra, 3rd Menditeguy). By the end of the season Fangio
had won the world title in a Maserati 250 F. At the same time, Maserati was also excelling
itself in the World Sports car Championship with the legendary 450S, a genuine
powerhouse driven by a weighty 4.5 litre V8 engine that developed 400 bhp.
Then at the end of the year Maserati unexpectedly announced that it would no longer
race, though it would go on designing racing cars. Indeed it went on to produce several
masterpieces of the art including the Tipo 60 and the 61 "Birdcage" as well as the 3-litre
V12 power unit used on the Cooper Maserati Formula 1 car in 1965-67.
Maserati Academy
13
Introduction to Maserati
Historic Overview of Maserati
1967-1975: The Citroën Area
In 1968, the Orsi family sold Maserati to Citroën which was
primarily interested in acquiring its engine know-how. Indeed a
6-cylinder Maserati engine was used on the Citroën SM coupé.
Under the new management and in total contrast with Maserati's
traditional insistence on a front-mounted engine, the firm also
produced two centre-engined models: the Bora (1971-79) with a
90° V8 engine and the Merak (1972-83) with a 90° V6 power
unit, both of them with Italdesign bodies. Citroën also introduced
a new version of the Quattroporte with SM mechanicals and
front wheel drive! Very few were ever produced and the model
was never homologated.
1973 saw the debut of the Khamsin, a sharply cut streamlined
coupé with a Bertone body. In the same year, though, Maserati
sales were badly hit by the oil crisis and Citroën pulled out.
1975-1993: the de Tomaso years
In 1975, the effects of the oil crisis forced Citroën to draw
in its horns, which meant abandoning Maserati which was
then sold to Alejandro De Tomaso’s GEPI. Under its
management, the firm produced a 2000 cc version of the
Merak and in 1976 it launched a new version of the
Quattroporte. This went on to become the best selling
Maserati of all time. The Quattroporte was also famous for
being the vehicle of choice for successive Italian
presidents.
Maserati Academy
14
Introduction to Maserati
Historic Overview of Maserati
The eighties brought many changes, not least the creation of a model destined for mass
production. That was the surprising Biturbo, a performance saloon with a 2000cc V6
engine that was launched in 1981. In 1984, an impressive 6,000 Biturbo’s were
constructed. Further development of the turbocharged V6 engine led in 1989 to the launch
of the Shamal that featured the first Maserati V8 adopting twin turbo's.
1993 onwards: under Fiat’s wings
In 1993, Fiat Auto acquired the entire share capital of Maserati,
which was later put under the full control of Ferrari in July of
1997. Work began on the new Maserati factory on 1st October,
1997 and the Quattroporte Evoluzione came out in 1998. That
same year the 3200GT coupé was launched at the Paris
Motorshow. It was both the first Maserati of the new era and a
revival of a 4-seater Grand Tourer tradition that began forty
years earlier with the 3500GT. The 3200GT was first shown to
the Australian public at the 1999 Melbourne Motorshow. The
3200GT instantly captured the attention of automotive
aficionados all over the world.
Maserati Academy
15
Introduction to Maserati
Historic Overview of Maserati
Maserati milestones:
•
The first Maserati, Tipo 26, made its debut by winning its class at the Targa
Florio of 1926. Alfieri Maserati was at the wheel.
•
Maserati breaks the world land speed record in 1929 with the mighty V4.
•
Maserati engine powers the world water speed record in 1931.
•
Maserati introduces the world’s first hydraulic brake system on the 8CM racing
car in 1933.
•
The Maserati breaks the world speed record again in 1934 with the 4CM
(1100cc class).
•
Maserati fills the complete podium (victory, 2nd and 3rd place) of the famous
Targa Florio road race for four consecutive years: 1937, 1938, 1939 & 1940.
•
Maserati wins the Indianapolis 500 miles race for two consecutive years (1939
and 1940) with Wilbur Shaw at the wheel of the 8CTF.
•
Maserati won the Formula 1 world championship in 1957 with Juan Manuel
Fangio at the wheel of the 250F
•
The 3500 GTI introduced in 1957 important innovations such as twin-plug
ignition system, fuel injection and disc brakes.
•
The Quattroporte of 1963 was named the fastest saloon car in the world.
•
Maserati introduced the world’s first twin-turbo engine on the Biturbo in 1981.
•
The same Biturbo model introduced the Torsen limited slip differential for the
first time on a road car.
•
During the early 1990’s the Maserati Racing, and little later also the Ghibli and
Ghibli Cup, were the world’s most powerful 2-litre road cars.
•
Maserati stunned the world in 1998 with the gorgeous 3200GT, which
introduced the world’s first tail lights using led technology.
•
The mighty MC12 has proven to be the world’s most successful GT race car in
the 2004-2008 area with several world championship titles over these years
and three important victories in the Spa 24 hours race (2005, 2006 & 2008).
Maserati Academy
16
Introduction to Maserati
The Maserati Company Today
The Maserati Company Today
Maserati today is a modern and fast growing specialist car manufacturer with
representations worldwide. In 2005 the Maserati ownership has been transferred from
Ferrari S.p.A. to Fiat Partecipazioni S.p.A.
2008 has been a year of absolute record numbers for Maserati. Vehicle sales have grown
to 8759 units, up 17% with respect to 2007. The GranTurismo has established itself as the
most successful model, representing 63% of the Maserati sales. Also the economic results
have been constantly improving. The Maserati trading profit has reached in 2008 72
millions of Euros, or three times the value of 2007.
In 2008, Maserati continued its strategy of broadening its model range with the aim to
match the different costumer needs. An important fact in 2008 was the introduction of the
GranTurismo S model, which is the embodiment of Maserati’s true sports DNA.
Maserati’s successful saloon, the Quattroporte, underwent after five years an important
upgrade and is now offering a wider choice of variants to maintain its leading position in
the sports luxury sedan segment under the challenging 2009 market conditions.
For a better commercial focalise on its most important markets, Maserati has now
subsidiaries in the United States, the United Kingdom, France, Germany and Switzerland,
and a new sales structure for the fast growing Chinese market.
In the sporty sphere, 2008 was again a highly successful year for the Maserati MC12
racing cars: the consolidation of both team’s and driver’s world championship titles for the
fourth consecutive year, and the third victory in four years in the illustrious SpaFrancorchamps 24 hours race, all in GT racing.
Other important facts in 2008 were the appointment of Engineer Harald J. Wester as the
new Maserati CEO on August 1, and the presentation of the GranTurismo MC Concept, a
prelude to Maserati’s future on the race track.
Maserati Academy
17
Introduction to Maserati
The Maserati Company Today
Maserati facts and figures:
President:
Sergio MARCHIONE
Chief Executive Officer:
Harald J. WESTER
2007
2008
Difference
Total revenues (in millions of Euros)
694
825
+18,9 %
Total trading profit (in millions of Euros)
24
72
+ 200 %
Number of employees (at the end of the year)
± 950
± 780
-
Number of vehicles produced
7.353
9.292*
+26,4 %
Number of vehicles sold
7.496
8.759
+16,8 %
(*): 431 produced Alfa 8C vehicles not included
Maserati vehicle production growth 1998-2008:
10000
666
1538
2027
1993
3485
2937
5151
5694
5788
7353
9292
2002
2003
2004
2005
2006
2007
2008
9000
8000
7000
6000
5000
4000
3000
2000
1000
0
1998
1999
Maserati Academy
2000
2001
18
Introduction to Maserati
The Maserati Company Today
Maserati 2008 global vehicle sales divided by model:
QP Duoselect (0,15 %)
QP Aut. (16,9 %)
New QP (20,1 %)
GranTurism o (48,7 %)
GranTurism o S (14,1 %)
Maserati 2008 global vehicle sales divided by market:
North America (30,3 % )
Italy (9,6 % )
UK (8,5 % )
Japan (7,1 % )
Germany (7 % )
Middle East (6,6 % )
China (4,7 % )
France (4,4 % )
Others (22,8 % )
Maserati Academy
19
Introduction to Maserati
The Maserati Company Today
Maserati 2008 overview:
•
January 12:
presentation of the new Quattroporte “Collezione Cento” at the
Detroit Motor Show
•
February 12:
first images GranTurismo S released
•
March 4:
launch of the GranTurismo S at the Geneva Motor Show
•
May 15:
start of production of the GranTurismo S
•
June 23:
first images released of the new Quattroporte S
•
July 10:
start of production of the new Quattroporte and Quattroporte S
•
August 1:
Harald J. Wester becomes the new CEO of Maserati
•
August 3:
Vitaphone Racing Team wins with Maserati the SpaFrancorchamps 24-hour race (Belgium) for the third time in
four years
•
September 24:
presentation of the GranTurismo MC Concept at the Monza
race track
•
October 2:
presentation of the new Quattroporte range at the Paris Motor
Show
•
October 5:
Second victory of the season by Vitaphone Racing Team with
Maserati (Nogaro, France)
•
October 19:
Bertolini-Bartels win with their Vitaphone Racing Team
Maserati at the Zolder race track (Belgium) and secure by
doing so the 2008 FIA-GT world drivers championship title
•
October:
record number of vehicles produced by Maserati in 1 month:
1130
•
October:
launch of the new website Maserati.com
•
November 3:
first prototype built of the Alfa Romeo 8C Spider
•
November 17:
start of production of the new Quattroporte Sport GT S
•
November 23:
Vitaphone Racing Team wins with Maserati the 2008 FIA-GT
world team championship title (San Luis, Argentina)
•
December 3:
presentation of the MC Sport line at the Bologna Motor Show
•
December 19:
record number of Maserati cars produced in 1 year: 9292
Maserati Academy
20
Introduction to Maserati
The Maserati Company Today
Maserati Today:
Maserati Academy
21
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati Road Cars
Maserati Road Cars
1500 Gran Turismo (A6)
Years of production: 1946-1950
Numbers produced: 61
Engine: 6 cylinder, 1500cc, 65 hp
It was already in 1941 that the decision was made for the development of a GT car, but
the first examples of Maserati’s first ever road car were not built until 1946. However this
car was officially called “1500 Gran Turismo”, it is better known under its project name A6
(Alfieri, 6-cylinder). The over head cam engine had a sophisticated valve command
system and the tubular chassis was innovating for its time with round section steel tubes.
Except for one experimental prototype built by Zagato, all bodies were built by Pinin
Farina. First examples had covered head lights and a different rear section. The car
received its final body style in 1948 (see picture).
2000 Gran Turismo (A6G)
Years of production: 1950-1951
Numbers produced: 16
Engine: 6 cylinder, 2000cc, 100 hp
The A6G or 2000 Gran Turismo had a new two-litre engine based on the power unit of the
A6GCS racing cars. Compression ratio and thus power was reduced to allow the engine
to run on commercial fuel, of which excellent quality was not always guaranteed. Coupé
bodies ware built by Frua, Vignale and Pinin Farina and an elegant spyder version was
created by Frua. All bodies were of great luxury, refined and cured in every detail.
However a high list price and performances not matching the quickly changing standard in
the luxury car segment didn’t favour its sales. Only 16 pieces were produced.
Maserati Academy
22
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati Road Cars
A6GCS Berlinetta Pinin Farina
Years of production: 1953-1954
Numbers produced: 4
Engine: 6 cylinder, 2000cc, 170 hp
A very special car was presented at the Turin motor show of 1954. It concerned a 2000
Sport fitted with an elegant closed “berlinetta” body from Pinin Farina. The 2000 Sport
(project name A6GCS) was a higly successful open 2-seater race car designed for road
races and was much beloved by the racing drivers of the area for its excellent driving
qualities. An elegant berlinetta body from Pinin Farina on this basis was the right recipe for
one of the most beautiful creations in automotive history. Only four of them were built
(chassis 2056, 2057, 2059 and 2060), but chassis 2060 had a short life as it was re-bodied
as an open race car in 1955 and received a new identification number (2086). This car is
one of the most sought-after historic Maseratis. One of them is on display at the Paninicollection.
2000 Gran Turismo (A6G54)
Years of production: 1954-1957
Numbers produced: 60
Engine: 6 cylinder, 2000cc, 150 hp
The experience gained with the successful 2000 Sport was used for a small series GT
cars with elevated performances and reserved to a limited number of elite customers. The
A6G54 twin cam engine of the 2000 Sport was detuned and had now a classic oil sump
instead of a dry sump lubrication system. Its 150 horse power gave the 2000 Gran
Turismo of 1954 the true GT performance its predecessor lacked and this car was highly
appreciated by the public. Coupé and spyder bodies were made by Frua, Zagato and
Allemano.
Maserati Academy
23
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati Road Cars
3500 GT & GTI
Years of production: 1957-1964
Numbers produced: 1983 (all versions)
Engine: 6 cylinder, 3.5L, 220 & 235 hp
The 3500 GT was an important car for Maserati as it was the first production car to be built
in large numbers. In 1957 Maserati had officially withdrawn from motor racing and full
attention was now on the production of Gran Turismo road cars. The elegantly shaped
body of the 3500 GT was a creation from Carrozzeria Touring and was made from
aluminium which was attached to a tubular steel frame (Superleggera patent). The 6cylinder engine came from the 350S racing car of 1956 and was characterised by excellent
torque values at low engine speed. In 1961, the triple Weber carburettors were replaced
by a mechanical fuel injection system from Lucas, boosting the power to 235 hp. Injection
equipped vehicles were referred to as 3500 GTI. This car became a big commercial
success and contributed importantly in resolving the economical difficulties of Maserati at
the time.
3500 GT & GTI Spyder
Years of production: 1958-1964
Numbers produced: 242
Engine: 6 cylinder, 3.5L, 220 & 235 hp
Almost simultaneously with the coupé, an open version of the 3500 GT was under
development. Early prototypes of the Spyder were made by Touring and Frua, but the final
design was a masterpiece of designer Giovanni Michelotti when he was working for
Vignale. The body was now made from steel instead of aluminium and was fitted on a 10
cm shortened chassis. Also the Spyder adopted the Lucas fuel injection system and its
drum brakes were replaced by more modern disc brakes on later versions, although drum
brakes remained available upon request.
Maserati Academy
24
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati Road Cars
5000 GT
Years of production: 1959-1966
Numbers produced: 34
Engine: 90° V8, 5.0L, 325 & 340 hp
The worldwide success of the 3500 GT has drawn much attention to the Maserati brand.
Some however desired from Maserati a Gran Turismo that was even more exclusive. On
specific request of the Shah of Persia the 5000 GT was born. Chief engineer Giulio Alfieri
used only the very best components available to built this extraordinary car. Its powerful
V8 engine originated from the 450S racing car by which Juan Manuel Fangio and Jean
Behra won the 1957 Sebring 12 hours race and the vehicle used a reinforced 3500 GT
chassis. The brake system was servo-assisted with discs on the front wheels and drums
on the rear. Performances were unprecedented for a road car at the time. Bodies for the
5000 GT were created by the worlds most famous coachbuilders: Touring, Pinin Farina,
Monterosa, Allemano, Ghia, Bertone, Vignale and Frua.
Sebring
Years of production: 1962-1968
Numbers produced: 600
Engine: 6 cylinder; 3.5L, 3,7L & 4.0L; 220-265 hp
Before the sales of the 3500 GT began to slow, Maserati presented its new Sebring coupe
at the Geneva motorshow of 1962. The new car was named after the race track in Florida
were the 450S racing cars obtained an important win a few years earlier. The Sebring was
based on the short 3500 GT Spyder chassis and its 2+2 body was a design from Michelotti
during his time at Vignale. The 6-cylinder engine had always fuel injection from Lucas and
total displacements were 3.5L, 3.7L and also 4.0L from 1965, with power outputs varying
from 220 to 265 hp. The Sebring showed a number of technical improvements over the
3500 GT. Automatic transmission, air conditioning and Borrani wire wheels were available
on request.
Maserati Academy
25
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati Road Cars
Quattroporte l
Years of production: 1963-1969
Numbers produced: 776
Engine: 90° V8, 4.1L & 4.7L, 260 & 290 hp
In the early 1960’s, Giulio Alfieri started to work on a completely new project. Inspired by
the success of its Gran Turismo cars, Maserati was now thinking about a saloon car. The
new Quattroporte (Italian for “four doors”) must of course have the same level of elegancy,
refinement, power and performances as the other trident products. With a top speed of
230 km/h, it was the fastest saloon production car at the time. The design was from Pietro
Frua and the car had a modern sheet metal monocoque structure instead of a tubular
frame. The De Dion rear axle was replaced by a more traditional rigid axle and the option
was offered for a more powerful 4.7 engine when a second series was presented in 1966.
A curious detail: 5 Quattroportes were converted into pick-ups by coachbuilder Grazia of
Bologna and were used as fire extinguisher cars on the Italian race tracks.
Mistral & Mistral Spyder
Years of production: 1964-1969
Numbers produced: 955
Engine: 6 cylinder; 3.5L, 3,7L & 4.0L; 220-265 hp
With this car started Maserati’s tradition to name its Gran Turismo cars after famous winds
(the Ghibli, Bora, Merak, Khamsin, Karif and Shamal would follow). The Mistral shared its
mechanical base with the Sebring but, thanks to its 2-seater fastback body from Pietro
Frua, had a much more modern appearance compared to the more traditional styled 2+2
Sebring. A first prototype of the Mistral was presented at the Turin motorshow in the
autumn of 1963 but production didn’t start before 1964. The body was from steel but the
doors, bonnet and rear window frame were made from aluminium to reduce the weight. An
open Spyder version was presented at the Geneva motorshow in March 1964. The
Spyder was produced in about 120 units.
Maserati Academy
26
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati Road Cars
Mexico
Years of production: 1966-1972
Numbers produced: 485
Engine: 90° V8, 4.1L & 4.7L, 290 & 300 hp
After the 5000 GT and the Quattroporte, the Mexico is Maserati’s third road car using a
civilised version of the V8 race engine from the 450S sport prototype race car. A first
prototype of the Mexico was shown in 1965, but the official presentation of the final
version was at the Paris motorshow in 1966. The sober but balanced and elegant design
from Vignale keeps the middle between a 4-seater coupe and a 2-door saloon car and the
car offers comfortable interior space to four people thanks to its 2640 mm wheelbase. The
Mexico shares its mechanical base with the Quattroporte and has a steel monocoque
structure combined with a front auxiliary frame. The Mexico was available with both 4.1L
and 4.7L engine and has a top speed between 250 and 260 km/h.
Ghibli & Ghibli Spyder
Years of production: 1967-1972
Numbers produced: 1280
Engine: 90° V8, 4.7L & 4.9L, 340 & 330 hp
In 1966 a project was started for a new sporty Gran Turismo in the best tradition of the
Maserati Brand. The new Ghibli, named after a desert breeze, was strictly a 2-seater and
its beautiful design was a true masterpiece of the young designer Giorgetto Giugiaro
during his period at Ghia. The body of the Ghibli was perfect in every detail and is still
regarded as one of Giugiaro’s most beautiful designs. The V8 engine from the
Quattroporte/Mexico adopted a dry sump lubrication system in order to fit under the long
and low Ghibli bonnet. From 1969 the Ghibli was also made available with a 4.9L engine,
named Ghibli SS, and an open Spyder version was added, of which only 125 units were
produced.
Maserati Academy
27
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati Road Cars
Indy
Years of production: 1969-1975
Numbers produced: 1104
Engine: 90° V8; 4.1L, 4.7L & 4.9L; 260, 290 & 300 hp
The Maserati Indy, officially presented at the Geneva motorshow in 1969, was a tribute to
the two consecutive victories of the Maserati 8CTF race cars in the famous 500 miles race
at the Indianapolis speedway in 1939 and 1940. This new car was designed by Vignale
and could be seen as a model in between the Ghibli and the Mexico. The roof line was
higher compared to the Ghibli in order to offer space for the rear passengers. Mechanicals
were borrowed from the Ghibli and traditional Maserati: 90° V8 engine with four overhead
camshafts, semi-monocoque structure with front auxiliary frame, independent double
wishbone front suspensions and a rigid rear axle with leaf springs. In 1973 the Indy
adopted the brake system from Citroën, who was the new owner of Maserati.
Bora
Years of production: 1971-1978
Numbers produced: 530
Engine: 90° V8, 4.7L & 4.9L, 310 & 320 hp
The Bora was a milestone in Maserati’s history: It was the first Maserati road car with a
central mounted engine - engineer Guilio Alfieri gained much experience with the central
engined Birdcage Tipo 63-65 race cars - and it was the first car which has been developed
under full Citroën ownership. The engine was the well-known V8, first in 4.7L and later
also in 4.9L configuration, while its beautiful fastback body was another masterpiece from
Giorgetto Giugiaro. The Bora was equipped with Citroën’s complex hydraulic system,
which was used for the brakes, the opening of the headlights, the adjustment for the
driver’s seat and the pedals. Sales of the Bora suffered from the oil-crisis in the midseventies, while racing plans were crossed due to homologation problems.
Maserati Academy
28
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati Road Cars
Merak, Merak SS & Merak 2000
Years of production: 1972-1983
Numbers produced: 1820
Engine: 90° V6; 3.0L & 2.0L; 190, 208 & 170 hp
The Merak was Maserati’s answer to the oil crisis, which strongly penalised the sales of
big-engined cars. This small sister of the Bora used a modified version of the type C.114
engine, which Maserati had produced for Citroën. This smaller engine made it possible to
equip the Merak with two small rear seats, while the Bora was a two seater. The Merak
used even more Citroën components as its bigger sister, such as the single-spoke
steering wheel; but much of these components disappeared again on later versions. In
1976, a lighter and more powerful version was presented, the Merak SS, while for the
Italian market a two-litre version was offered. This latter version was recognisable by its
black striping. The combination of its sensational Italdesign body and more economic
engine choice made from the Merak a real best-seller.
Khamsin
Years of production: 1974-1982
Numbers produced: 430
Engine: 90° V8, 4.9L, 320 hp
The Khamsin was a remarkable vehicle, it was not only the last work of Giulio Alfieri as
head of Maserati’s engineering department, it was also Maserati’s first series-production
car to be designed by Bertone. The result was a streamlined, wedge-shaped car with
elegant proportions. The mechanical base was still borrowed from the Ghibli, but now with
independent rear suspensions, while brake system was a legacy from Citroën and not by
everyone equally appreciated.
The Kamshin’s traditional GranTurismo configuration – a big sports car with front mounted
engine and rear wheel drive – indicated the end of an area which would only return in the
late 1990’s.
Maserati Academy
29
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati Road Cars
Quattroporte II
Years of production: 1976-1978
Numbers produced: 12
Engine: 90° V6, 3.0L, 210 hp
The second generation of the Quattroporte conceals one of the obscurest periods in
Maserati’s history. The car has been developed under Citroën’s ownership and was
technically identical to the Citroën SM, included its front wheel drive and hydro-pneumatic
suspension. Performances were behind on the first generation Quattroporte and the car
was unloved by Maserati purists, but nevertheless the Quattroporte II was very
comfortable, well equipped and offered an excellent ride. Its Bertone-designed body was
modern and the build quality very good. Unfortunately, the early end of the agreement with
Citroën in 1975 and financial problems hampered the launch of the Quattroporte II. In fact,
the model has never been homologated for the European market. Only 12 units were
produced in its three years of production and they were all sold to the Middle East.
Kyalami
Years of production: 1976-1983
Numbers produced: 200
Engine: 90° V8, 4.1L & 4.9L, 255 & 280 hp
The Kyalami indicated at the same time the end and the beginning of an area. It was the
last Maserati coupe equipped with the illustrious V8 engine and it was the first that has
been developed under the new ownership of Alejandro de Tomaso. The Kyalami was
actually based on De Tomaso’s own Longchamp model, but the Ford-Cleveland V8 has
been removed in favour of Maserati’s own four-cam V8, and the original design from Tom
Tjaarda has been elegantly reworked by Frua. Only 200 units were produced of this car
that was named after the South African race track where the Maserati-engined Cooper
Formula 1 cars scored an important win almost ten years earlier.
Maserati Academy
30
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati Road Cars
Quattroporte III
Years of production: 1979-1990
Numbers produced: 2155
Engine: 90° V8; 4.1L & 4.9L; 255, 280 & 300 hp
The third generation of the Maserati luxury saloon was meant to make up for the
Quattroporte II fiasco. Alejandro de Tomaso, who disliked Citroën, discarded all Citroën
technology used on the Quattroporte II. Mechanical parts came from the Kyalami and the
Quattroporte had again a V8 engine and rear wheel drive. The impressive body of the
Quattroporte III was designed by Giugiaro and the steel body shells were built at the
Innocenti plant near Milan, prior to assembly in Modena. When the car went on sale in
1979, it was an instant commercial success. In 1987, a restyled version called
Quattroporte Royale offered an upgraded interior and a 20 hp more powerful 4.9L engine.
Production of the Quattroporte III continued until 1990.
Biturbo
Years of production: 1982-1989
Numbers produced: 11919
Engine: 90° V6 twin turbo 18v, 2.0L, 180-223 hp
When the Biturbo was presented in December 1981, a new area started for Maserati.
Alejandro de Tomaso’s plan to resolve Maserati’s financial problems was the introduction
of a compact coupe with first level performances and an interesting price setting, and in
this way attracting new customers to Maserati. Its engine was a modified version of the
Merak V6 with the adoption of two small turbochargers, a world premiere. The Biturbo
became a big commercial success thanks to its excellent performances and luxury
interior, but first generation versions suffered from reliability problems. In 1983, the more
powerful Biturbo S was presented with twin intercoolers and two Naca air ducts on the
bonnet. In 1986 and 1987, both versions were upgraded with fuel injection (Biturbo i and
Biturbo Si).
Maserati Academy
31
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati Road Cars
Biturbo 2500
Years of production: 1983-1991
Numbers produced: circa 6500
Engine: 90° V6 twin turbo 18v,
2.5L, 189-196 hp
While the two-litre versions of the Biturbo were reserved for the Italian market, a 2.5 litre
version destined for exportation was presented in 1983. The 90° V6 three-valve engine
had an increased bore to expand its capacity to 2491 cc, but the cylinder liners were now
from cast iron instead of aluminium and this engine didn’t have intercoolers for the two IHI
turbochargers. The Biturbo 2500 maintained the Torsen limited slip differential from the
two-litre versions (a world first on a production car). A slightly more powerful version was
named Biturbo ES. In 1987 the Biturbo 2500 and Biturbo ES adopted fuel injection and the
name was changed into Biturbo Si 2500.
Biturbo 4-door models (all versions)
Years of production: 1984-1994
Numbers produced: 9809 (all versions)
Engine: 90° V6 twin turbo 18v;
2.0L, 2.5L & 2.8L; 200-248 hp;
90° V6 twin turbo 24v, 2.0L & 2.8L, 245 & 279 hp
With an 86 mm extended wheelbase and two added rear doors, the Biturbo was
transformed into a compact and sporty saloon car. It was presented first in 1984 with the
2.5L engine destined for export (425), but little later also followed by a two-litre version
meant for the Italian market (420, 420S, 420i, 420Si). A minor facelift in 1988 had these
models replaced by the 422, in harmony with the two-door 222. This model was joined in
1990 by the 4.18v. and the four-valve 4.24v., both fitted with a two-litre engine. The export
model received in 1987 the 2.8L engine in 3-valve and in 1991 also in 4-valve version (430
and 430 4v.). Other upgrades and aesthetical modifications were in-line with the coupe
models. In spite of the fact that they had four doors, these models were never named
Quattroporte.
Maserati Academy
32
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati Road Cars
Biturbo Spyder (all versions)
Years of production: 1985-1994
Numbers produced: 3076 (all versions)
Engine: 90° V6 twin turbo 18v; 2.0L, 2.5L & 2.8L;
180-224 hp; 90° V6 twin turbo 24v, 2.0L, 241 hp
Top performances and open top driving fun were again combined in the Biturbo Spyder
who was the first open Maserati since the Ghibli Spyder, more than 12 years earlier.
Development for the body was done by Zagato near Milan while the bodies were
assembled in Turin before transportation to Modena where the mechanical parts were
added. The 2514 mm wheelbase from the Biturbo was reduced to 2400 mm for the
Spyder models. The Biturbo Spyder existed in various versions and followed the same
technical and aesthetical evolutions as the coupe, with exception of the 24-valve 2.8L
engine. The various versions were: Biturbo Spyder, Biturbo Spyder 2500, Biturbo Spyder
i, Biturbo Spyder i 2500, Biturbo Spyder 2.8i, Spyder 2.0 4v. and Spyder 2.8. In 1991 the
Biturbo name was dropped for the open models.
228
Years of production: 1987-1991
Numbers produced: 469
Engine: 90° V6 twin turbo 18v, 2.8L, 255 hp
With the 228, of which production started in 1987, Maserati wanted to offer an alternative
to the big luxury coupes from Mercedes-benz and BMW. The design of the 228 recalls
much to the Biturbo, but its lines were softer and the 228 was built on the longer chassis
taken from the 4-door Biturbo models. The engine capacity was increased to 2.8 litres.
The 228 was a very luxurious coupe and standard equipment included power steering,
alloy wheels, central locking, electric windows and hand-stitched leather seats. ABS was
available on request. This model was in 1991 followed by the 222.4v.
Maserati Academy
33
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati Road Cars
222 & 2.24v
Years of production: 1988-1992 and 1989-1992
Numbers produced: 1156 & 1147
Engine: 90° V6 twin turbo 18v, 2.0L, 223 hp;
90° V6 twin turbo 24v, 2.0L, 245 hp
With its new name 222, the Biturbo received a small stylistic upgrade. The front grille was
new and the Naca air ducts on the bonnet disappeared, while the two-litre engine still had
twin intercoolers. Injection was now electronic from Weber-Marelli with integrated ignition.
The 222 had electrically adjustable seats and electronic climate control.
In 1989, the twin-turbo V6 engine received a substantial technical upgrade. The cylinder
heads were new with four valves per cylinder instead of three and two camshafts per
cylinder bank. The light alloy cylinder liners were treated to reduce internal friction.
Vehicles equipped with this more powerful version of the two-litre engine were named
2.24v.
Karif
Years of production: 1988-1991
Numbers produced: 221
Engine: 90° V6 twin turbo 18v, 2.8L, 248-224 hp
The Maserati Karif, presented at the Geneva motorshow of 1988, was designed for pure
driving fun. It had the same powerful 2.8L twin-turbo engine as used in the 228, but it was
based on the shortened chassis from the Biturbo Spyder. The 114 mm shorter wheelbase
and the increased torsional rigidity due to the reinforced sills from the spyder’s floorplan
had a positive effect on the Karif’s handling. The rear seats from the Biturbo were sacrified
for the Karif. Instead, extra lugguage space was available behind the front seats. This
made the Karif ideal for long and joyful travelling for two persons.
Later versions of the Karif were equipped with a catalytic converter which reduced the
engine power.
Maserati Academy
34
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati Road Cars
Shamal
Years of production: 1990-1996
Numbers produced: 369
Engine: 90° V8 twin turbo 32v, 3.2L, 322 & 326 hp
Named after a Mesopotamian wind, the new Shamal was the most extreme derivate from
the Biturbo model family. It was, just like the Karif, based on the shorter Biturbo Spyder
floorplan, but offered also two small rear seats. The body of the Shamal was completely
new, with exception of the doors. The Shamal’s muscular and aggressive design was the
work of designer Marcello Gandini, which could be easily recognised by the shape of the
rear wheel arches. The biggest news of the Shamal was however found under the bonnet.
The V6 was replaced by a completely new twin-turbo V8 engine with four camshafts and
32 valves. This was coupled to a new 6-speed gearbox from Getrag. The design of the
Shamal gave inspiration for the later Ghibli model. This is one of the most extreme
production cars ever made.
Racing
Years of production: 1990-1992
Numbers produced: 230
Engine: 90° V6 twin turbo 24v, 2.0L, 283 hp
The Maserati Racing was presented in December 1990, at Maserati’s usual press meeting
before Christmas. This latest version of the Biturbo family received a restyling with a nose
that was inspired by the Shamal, but he most important news came from under the
bonnet. The Racing had the same 24-valve version of the two-litre engine as presented
two years earlier for the 2.24v, but a number of modifications were made. The crankshaft
was new, the connecting rods were lighter and the compression ratio has been increased.
Together with modified turbochargers, made this from the Racing the most powerful twolitre production car in the world. Also the Getrag gearbox was new and the car was fitted
with intelligent active shock absorbers from Koni. With a top speed of 256 km/h and an
acceleration to 1000m in only 25,9 seconds, performances of the racing were excellent.
Maserati Academy
35
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati Road Cars
222 SR & 222.4v
Years of production: 1991-1993
Numbers produced: 220 & 130
Engine: 90° V6 twin turbo 18v, 2.8L, 224 hp;
90° V6 twin turbo 24v, 2.8L, 279 hp
While the 222 and 2.24v with their smaller two-litre engine were meant for the Italian
market - Italian tax rules penalised strongly cars with an engine capacity of over two litres
- the 222 SR and 222.4v with their 2.8L version of the twin-turbo V6 engine were destined
for exportation. These cars received the same stylistic upgrade as the Racing a few
months earlier. The 222SR, who replaced the Biturbo Si 2500, still had the engine with 3valve cylinder heads and single over head camshafts, and was fitted with 15” wheels. The
more powerful 222.4v had the 4-valve cylinder heads and received 16” wheels.
Barchetta
Years of production: 1992-1993
Numbers produced: 17
Engine: 90° V6 twin turbo 24v, 2.0L, 315 hp
The Maserati Barchetta is a bit an outsider in the list of Maserati road cars as it was never
really intended for road use. This car was developed for a single-make championship
which was hold on various race tracks across Italy and Europe during 1993. The Barchetta
had a single backbone chassis made from aluminium. This was a technology that has
been developed for the Chubasco-prototype. The centrally mounted engine was the twolitre V6 in 24-valve configuration with power boosted to 315 hp, while its wheel geometry
was Formula 1-style and the body was made from composite and carbon fibre. With a total
weight of only 775 kg, performances were outstanding. A road-going version was
considered but never commercialised due to homologation difficulties.
Maserati Academy
36
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati Road Cars
Ghibli (2nd generation)
Years of production: 1992-1998
Numbers produced: 2303 (all versions)
Engine: 90° V6 twin turbo 24v; 2.0L & 2.8L;
306, 281 & 330 hp
For the latest descendant of the Biturbo family tree, the name of one of the greatest
Maserati Gran Turismo cars of the 1960’s was revived. The new Ghibli was still based on
the Biturbo platform, but had a more modern body design and wider tracks. As usual, the
two-litre version was destined for the Italian market, while the 2.8L was made for
exportation. In 1995, the Ghibli was named Ghibli GT and underwent a number of
technical modifications, included a new rear differential. A more potent version of the 2.0L,
the Ghibli Cup, referred to the one-make racing series which was organised with the
model. This was with its 330 hp the worlds most powerful two-litre production car.
Quattroporte IV
Years of production: 1994-1998
Numbers produced: 1670 (all versions)
Engine: 90° V6 twin turbo 24v, 2.0L & 2.8L, 287 & 284
hp; 90° V8 twin turbo 32v, 3.2L, 335 hp
The fourth generation of the Maserati Quattroporte was presented at the Turin motorshow
in April 1994. It was the first car to be presented under full Fiat ownership. The sober but
elegant design was from Marcello Gandini, just like the spectacular Shamal five years
earlier. With respect to the first generations of the Quattroporte, the Quattroporte IV is very
compact but its performances are at true Gran Turismo level: a top speed of 260kmh and
acceleration from 0 to 100 km/h in less than 6 seconds. From 1996, the Quattroporte was
also made available with the 3.2L 32-valve V8 engine from the Shamal, which improved
performances even further, and fitted with 17” wheels. Standard was a 6-speed gearbox
from Getrag but an automatic 4-speed transmission from ZF (V6) or BTR (V8) was also
available.
Maserati Academy
37
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati Road Cars
Quattroporte Evoluzione
Years of production: 1998-2001
Numbers produced: 730 (all versions)
Engine: 90° V6 twin turbo 24v, 2.0L & 2.8L, 287 & 284
hp; 90° V8 twin turbo 32v, 3.2L, 335 hp
When in July 1997 Ferrari took over control of Maserati, one of the main objectives was to
radically improve the quality of the vehicles. Notwithstanding it was widely renowned for its
excellent driving qualities, the Quattroportre suffered since its introduction from reliability
problems. Measurements taken were a complete revision of the production process and
hundreds of the Quattroporte’s components were redesigned in order to improve quality.
The result was presented in 1998. These revised Quattroporte’s can be recognised by the
“Evoluzione” label on the front wings.
3200 GT
Years of production: 1998-2002
Numbers produced: 4795
Engine: 90° V8 twin turbo 32v, 3.2L, 370hp
With the introduction of the completely new 3200 GT, in Paris 1998, Maserati returned to
its roots by building a true Gran Turismo in the great tradition of the brand and concluded
in this way the Biturbo area. It still had a twin-turbo engine, but everything else on this
vehicle was completely new. The V8 from the Shamal and Quattroporte IV underwent a
number of substantial modifications and delivered now 370 hp. Choice was between a 6speed manual transmission (ZF) or a 4-speed auto gearbox (BTR). The design from
Giugiaro was, just like his creations for Maserati in the past, a true masterpiece and this
model was mainly responsible for Maserati’s sales revival which started in 1998. Its
boomerang-shaped taillights were the first on a production car using led-technology. In
2001, a more edgy version was presented carrying the name “Assetto Corsa”.
Maserati Academy
38
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati Road Cars
Spyder GT & Spyder Cambiocorsa
Years of production: 2001-2007
Numbers produced:
Engine: 90° V8 dry sump, 4.2L, 390 hp
With the introduction of the Maserati Spyder, at the Frankfurt motor show of 2001, again a
new area started for Maserati, this time an area of close technical collaboration with group
partner Ferrari. Whilst the exterior of the new Spyder still reminds strongly to the 3200GT
model, under the skin this car is completely new. Under the hood the twin-turbo unit has
been dropped in favour of a completely new, normally-aspirated 4.2L V8 with a dry sump
lubrication system. Also the transmission is totally new. The gearbox is moved to the rear
end of the car where it forms a single unit with the differential (transaxle). The Spyder has
a shortened wheelbase with respect to the Coupé and is strictly a two-seater only. The
soft-top opens and closes fully automatically. This model initiated the return of the
Maserati brand to the United States.
Coupé GT & Coupé Cambiocorsa
Years of production: 2002-2007
Numbers produced:
Engine: 90° V8 dry sump, 4.2L, 390 hp
Shortly after the introduction of the new Spyder, it was time for the closed model to
undergo the same technical transformation. The result was presented to the public at the
Detroit motor show in January 2002. The Coupé adopted the elegant Giugiaro-designed
body style from the 3200GT model it replaced, but under the skin almost everything is
new. The typical boomerang-shaped taillights from the 3200GT were dropped to meet
American homologation requirements. The new Coupé has the same all-new normally
aspirated V8 engine and offers, just like the open Spyder variant, two gearbox options: a
traditional manual transmission (GT) and a Formula 1-style electro-hydraulic operated
gearbox with gearshift paddles at the steering wheel (Cambiocorsa), both located between
the rear wheels (transaxle layout).
Maserati Academy
39
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati Road Cars
Quattroporte V
Years of production: 2003-2008
Engine: 90° V8 dry sump, 4.2L, 400 hp
While the Quattroporte IV was a compact sports saloon, the fifth generation Quattroporte
marked Maserati’s return to the upper premium saloon segment, in the spirit of the first
generation Quattroporte of 1963. The Quattroporte V combines royal interior space and
the highest levels of comfort with a true sports heart. A powerful dry-sump V8 engine,
mounted well back in the chassis, and a robotized transaxle transmission stand for a
perfect weight distribution and excellent dynamic qualities. After its launch at the 2003
Frankfurt motor show, the Quattroporte became an instant commercial success for
Maserati and has won numerous awards. This is partly thanks to its astonishing
Pininfarina-designed bodywork.
GranSport & GranSport Spyder
Years of production: 2004-2007
Numbers produced:
Engine: 90° V8 dry sump, 4.2L, 400 hp
With the GranSport, presented at the Geneva motor show of 2004, Maserati revives one
of the great names of its own motoring heritage to indicate the most dynamic version of
the M138 model range. The GranSport incorporates all necessary ingredients to convert
the Coupé from a great performance GT car in a true driving machine. Various engine
modifications brought the power up to 400 hp, while the control logic of the Cambiocorsa
gearbox, standard for the GranSport, has been improved. Other modifications include new
19-inch alloy wheels, upgraded suspensions, a new front bumper with larger grille,
aerodynamic side sills and a more sporty interior with new seats. The GranSport was
joined later by an open GranSport Spyder version, presented at the Frankfurt motor show
of 2005.
Maserati Academy
40
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati Road Cars
MC12 Stradale
Years of production: 2004-2007
Numbers produced: ± 50
Engine: 65° V12 dry sump, 6.0L, 630 hp
The MC12 (Maserati Corse, 12-cylinder) represents Maserati in its most extreme and
performant form. The ‘Stradale’, or road-going version, was created to be able to
homologate the model for international GT-racing. With the MC12 Maserati returned to GT
racing in a highly successful way and the GT1 version has proven itself as the car to beat
on race tracks all over the world.
The MC12 is the fastest Maserati road car ever made; acceleration from standstill to 200
km/h takes less than 10 seconds and top speed exceeds 330 km/h. The technology of the
MC12 is based on the Ferrari Enzo model, however substantial modifications were made
to engine, chassis and aerodynamics. In late 2006, Maserati presented the MC12
Versione Corse, an even more extreme track-day variant of this all-conquering supercar.
Quattroporte Automatic
Years of production: 2007-2008
Engine: 90° V8 wet sump, 4.2L, 400 hp
The most important technical evolution came with the introduction of the Quattroporte
Automatic at the 2007 Detroit motor show. While the Quattroporte with Duoselect
transmission has proven to be an ideal match for Maserati’s sporty reputation, demand for
a fully automatic version had always been present. The Quattroporte Automatic is much
more then a Quattroporte simply fitted with a new gearbox. From the 16.500 components
of which the Quattroporte is made, 4.800 are new. The powertrain is completely new with
the adaption of a new wet sump engine (F136UC), 6-speed automatic gearbox from ZF,
propellor shaft and limited slip differential. The Quattroporte Automatic is available in
standard version as well as Sport GT and Executive GT.
Maserati Academy
41
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati Road Cars
GranTurismo
Years of production: from 2007,
still in production
Engine: 90° V8 wet sump, 4.2L, 405 hp
With the new GranTurismo, presented at the 2007 Geneva motor show, Maserati applies
the experience gained in the luxury car segment with the Quattroporte to create a true
luxury GT car. The GranTurismo is based on a modified Quattroporte floorplan. With an
overall length of 488cm, the GranTurismo is significantly bigger than the Coupé/Gransport
models it replaces, and offers comfortable interior space to four adults.
While the mechanical layout of the GranTurismo is identical to the Quattroporte Automatic
– it uses the same 4.2L V8 wet sump engine and automatic 6-speed gearbox from ZF –
various settings are specific to give the GranTurismo a more dynamic ride. Its pure and
elegant body design is from the hand of Pininfarina and reflects perfectly Maserati’s great
tradition in the creation of elegant and sporty grand touring cars.
GranTurismo S
Years of production: from 2008,
still in production
Engine: 90° V8 wet sump, 4.7L, 440 hp
Exactly one year after the presentation of the original GranTurismo, Maserati unveiled a
first derivate of this highly renowned GT car. The GranTurismo S was created to meet the
demand of those who prefer a more dynamic version of the existing GranTurismo. Its
more powerful 4.7L V8 engine and completely new, rear mounted robotized gearbox with
super fast MC-shift strategy, in combination with an upgraded braking system and
modified suspensions turn the GranTurismo S in a true performance car.
The more sporty nature of the GranTurismo S is perfectly reflected in its appearance with
newly designed alloy wheels, dark headlights, new aerodynamic side sills, a boot lid
spoiler, liberated exhaust system and modified interior trim. The character of the
GranTurismo S is unmistakably aggressive, yet it keeps loyal to its GT background by
offering the highest standards of comfort for all four occupants during long travelling.
Maserati Academy
42
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati Road Cars
Quattroporte (MY09)
Years of production: from 2008,
still in production
Engine: 90° V8 wet sump, 4.2L & 4.7L,
400hp, 430hp & 440hp
Five years after its launch and with more than 15.000 vehicles produced, Maserati’s highly
successful Quattroporte saloon underwent a discrete restyling. Pininfarina has reworked
the Maserati flagship without affecting the purity and elegance of its original design. The
new front and rear give the car a more fresh and modern appeal while at the same time
enhancing the connection with its GranTurismo sister model.
Also the interior has been updated with a new and more user friendly entertainment and
satellite navigation system, and new interior colours. Under the bonnet, the classic 4.2L
V8 wet sump engine is now joined by a more powerful 4.7L version (Quattroporte S and
Quattroporte Sport GT S). The restyled Quattroporte is available with an automatic sixspeed transmission only.
Maserati Academy
43
Introduction to Maserati
Prototypes and Concept Cars
Prototypes and Concept Cars
During its history Maserati has inspired the worlds most important designers and
coachbuilders to create some of their best designs. Some of the creations listed below
were intended for production whilst others were meant as show cases strictly.
Simun (1967)
The Simun, named after a Sahara desert wind, was
Giugiaro’s last work as head of design at Ghia. It
was built on the mechanical basis of the Mexico but
had a reduced wheelbase. The Simun was meant to
be Maserati’s next four-seater GT car, with a less
sporty nature than the current Ghibli. Yet its
unremarkable design – it showed strong similarity
with Giugiaro’s Thor concept for Oldsmobile – led to
the decision to choose the Michelotti-designed Indy
for production instead. This car is currently part of
the renowned Panini collection.
Boomerang (1971-1973)
Giorgetto Giugiaro stunned the world with the Maserati Boomerang concept of which a
non-functional model was displayed first at the 1971 Turin motorshow. The fully functional
Boomerang was launched at the 1973 Geneva motorshow and shared its mechanical
parts with the Bora.
In 1966, Giugiaro entered the public eye with his designs for Ghia, such as the stunning
Maserati Ghibli, which was most unconventional for the period in its use of straight lines
and large, flat surfaces. When he created his own design company Italdesign in 1968,
Giugiaro continued to explore this new design medium. The Boomerang is by many
regarded as the ultimate embodiment of Giugiaro’s design genius. It was without any
doubt one of the most important concept cars of all time and its typical wedge shape
influenced car design the next decades. The Boomerang has won numerous awards.
Maserati Academy
44
Introduction to Maserati
Prototypes and Concept Cars
124 GT (1974)
Another prototype from Italdesign was presented at the 1974
Turin motorshow, the 124GT (based on a Maserati 124 type
chassis, Giugiaro called it GT) was clearly inspired by the
Boomerang concept car.
This four-seater GT car bas supposed to be an alternative to
the Bertone-designed Khamsin, but its design was considered
too avant-garde for its time by the Maserati management and
the car never made it to production. Just like the Simun, this
car is on display at the Panini collection.
Medici I (1974) & Medici II (1976)
Together with the 124GT, Giugiaro presented what was his interpretation of the Maserati
Quattroporte. The Medici – named after the famous Renaissance family – was a futuristic
six seater limousine which was again inspired by the Boomerang. A modified version was
presented at the 1976 Paris motorshow, but none of both prototypes made it to
production. Paradoxically, the third generation of the Quattroporte which has been
commissioned to Italdesign had a very traditional styling.
Chubasco (1991)
In December 1990, Maserati presented the Chubasco, a sensational mid-engined sports
car. The work of designer Marcello Gandini can be easily recognised in the vehicle’s
dramatic exterior. Production was intended for 1992 but the project never got further than
the construction of one static prototype. The experience gained with the vehicle’s
aluminium, single-tube chassis was crucial for the development of the later Barchetta
model, which arrived in 1992. The only prototype is currently part of the famous Panini
collection.
Maserati Academy
45
Introduction to Maserati
Prototypes and Concept Cars
320S (2001)
The Maserati 320S concept car, unveiled at the 2001 Genève motor show, is a sporty
racing “barchetta” based on 3200GT mechanicals but with a shortened wheelbase and a
racing set-up. Styling was a development by Italdesign and racing supplier Sparco was
involved in the project. This concept car expressed various themes of the Maserati brand.
On one hand it was with its traditional
Camoradi white and blue colour scheme a
homage to the great Maserati sport prototype
racing cars of the past; on the other hand it
was a prelude to Maserati’s future racing
activities, Maserati’s return to the US and to the
new Spyder model which was to be unveiled
later the same year.
Kubang (2003)
The Kubang concept car, presented in 2003 at the
Detroit motor show, was meant to answer to the new
needs of mobility of the 21st century. This new vehicle,
defined as GT Wagon, was the result of a collaboration
between Maserati and Italdesign and has been designed
to combine true GT performance and driving pleasure
with the versatility of a SUV. It has a 390 bhp V8 engine
and all wheel drive, but the Kubang is not an off-road
car, as such an interpretation would harm its Gran
Turismo concept. In the end, series production of the
Kubang was renounced.
Birdcage 75th (2005)
The Birdcage 75th by Pininfarina was presented
in 2005 in celebration of the 75th anniversary of
the famous Turin-based coachbuilder. The
prototype directly recalls the legendary Tipo 63
racing car, nicknamed “birdcage” due to the
radically triangulated tube construction of its
chassis. This concept car, in homage to the spirit
of the dream car era, is based on the road racing
chassis of the Maserati MC12 and seeks to
capture the ultimate expression of speed,
sensuality and elegance – to create a functional
and dynamic automotive sculpture. The contrast
struck between its organic fluidity and the severe
tension of its mechanicals, creates a dynamism
seldom realized.
Maserati Academy
46
Introduction to Maserati
Prototypes and Concept Cars
GranTurismo MC Concept
The GranTurismo MC Concept was developed on the technical basis of the GranTurismo
S road car. The technicians of the Maserati Corse racing department have improved the
car’s overall performance by drastically reducing its weight and improving the dynamic
qualities of the standard car. The result is a high performance experimental racing car
which contains innovative solutions for future production car applications. The
GranTurismo MC Concept can also be seen as a prelude to a new Trofeo racing series of
the Trident brand, which is planned to take of in 2010.
Technical datasheet GranTurismo MC Concept:
Engine:
V8, 4.691cc
Max power :
331Kw, 450 hp
Max torque:
510Nm
Transmission:
Transaxle, robotized 6-speed gearbox, limited slip differential
Chassis/Body:
Steel monocoque with FIA-approved roll cage, composite
body panels
Weight:
< 1400 Kg
Maserati Academy
47
Introduction to Maserati
The Maserati Connection
The Maserati Connection
During the history of Maserati, a number of technical collaborations with other car
manufacturers came into existence. Mostly it where other car constructors who benefited
from Maserati’s technical know how.
The best known example is probably the Citroën SM, who resulted from the ownership of
Maserati by the French company. Its all-alloy, quad-cam V6 engine was made by Maserati
(tipo C.114) and later in modified versions also used in Maserati’s own Merak and
Quattroporte II models. About 13.000 units were produced between 1970 and 1975. This
car was for many years the world’s fastest front wheel drive production car.
Maserati’s Tipo C.114 engine was also used in the only sports berlinetta made by French
car constructor Guy Ligier, the JS2 (named after racing driver Jo Schlesser, who was
killed during the French Gran Prix of 1968). The engine was first used in 12-valve and
later also in 24-valve configuration, boosting the power to 240 bhp. About 200 units were
built between 1972 and 1977.
During the 1980’s, the friendship between then Maserati owner Alejandro De Tomaso and
Chrysler’s boss Lee Iacocca led to the creation of the “Chrysler TC by Maserati”, a
convertible that was intended to become Chrysler’s image-building flagship. Maserati
delivered know-how and engineered certain components for this vehicle, but despite it had
Maserati written on the valve cover, its engine was not a Maserati unit. 7300 vehicles were
produced between 1989 and 1991, all designated for the American market.
More recently, Maserati’s expertise in the production of limited-series, high performance
sports cars was used by group partner Alfa Romeo for its 8C Competizione sports car. A
lot of its mechanical components, such as the V8 engine and robotized gearbox, origin
from Maserati. Limited production of 500 units started in late 2007 at Maserati’s Modena
plant and will be followed by another 500 units of a spider version (planned for 2009).
Maserati Academy
48
Introduction to Maserati
2
Maserati Models
Technical Introductions
Maserati Academy
49
Introduction to Maserati
Coupé, Spyder & GranSport
Coupé, Spyder & GranSport (M138)
Technical Introduction
Maserati Academy
50
Introduction to Maserati
Coupé, Spyder & GranSport
General Information
Introduction
This new generation of Maserati Grand Turismo vehicles was rung in by the presentation
of the Spyder at the Frankfurt motor show in September 2001. This was followed little later
by the presentation of the Coupé at the Detroit motor show in Januari 2002. Both vehicles
present a completely new technical layout as the result of the close technical collaboration
with Ferrari. With respect to the 3200GT model, the twin turbo engine was abandonned in
favour of a completely new, normally-aspirated V8 engine with a total displacement of 4.2
litres.
Also the transmission was totally new. The gearbox was no longer fixed behind the engine
but was now mounted at the rear of the vehicle where it forms a single unit with the limited
slip differential (transaxle configuration). The possibility for a traditional automatic
transmission (as for the 3200 GTa) was no longer offered. Instead, the Coupé and Spyder
were avalable with both manual and robotized gearbox. The later offers the possibility to
be driven in fully automatic mode. The manual version is refered to as Coupé GT and
Spyder GT, while the version with robotized manual gearbox is called Coupé Cambiocorsa
and Spyder Cambiocorsa.
The Maserati Spyder has a 220 mm shortened floorplan with respect to the
Coupé and exists strictly as a two-seater only.
The body lines of the Coupé resemble
much to its predecessor, the 3200GT, but
the technical layout is completely new.
The boomerang-shaped taillights of the
3200GT were replaced by more traditional
modelled units for American homologation
reasons.
The Coupé and Spyder models introduced
Maserati’s return to the American market.
Maserati Academy
51
Introduction to Maserati
Main characteristics:
•
Optimal weight distribution between front and rear axle (52% front, 48% rear for the
Coupé, 53% front, 47% rear for the Spyder.
•
Monocoque bodyshell reinforced with a tubular structure designed to respond to the
highest standard in passive safety.
•
Typical Italian muscular and harmonious body style with long hood and compact tail.
Designed by Giugiaro’s Italdesign
•
Roof operated by an electro-hydraulic system.
•
Roof of the Spyder operated by an electro-hydraulic system. Fully automatic opening
and closing of the soft top by pushing a button in only 25 seconds. Soft top is fitted
with a heated glass rear window.
•
Spacious luggage compartment of 315 litres (Coupé) or 300 litres (Spyder). A tailor
made set of leather suitcases is available upon request.
•
Some modifications were made for MY03. New 7-spoke alloy wheels were available
as an optional.
•
A special series “Spyder 90° Anniversary” was presented at the 2004 Paris motor
show to celebrate the brand’s 90° anniversary. Only 90 pieces were made, all
finished in a special “Blu Anniversary” blue colour.
•
A special series “Coupé Vintage” was presented in 2005. This model had the same
alloy wheels as the GranSport and is further recognisable by a small chrome grill on
its side wings.
Modifications for MY05:
•
Newly designed front bumper and new chrome grille in line with the GranSport model.
•
Newly designed rear bumpers in line with the GranSport model.
•
7-spoke light alloy 18” wheels as standard.
Maserati Academy
52
Introduction to Maserati
Coupé, Spyder & GranSport
Engine
The Maserati M138 model series use a complete new engine (F136R)
•
Compact and light 8 cylinder in V, 90°
•
4.244 cc overbore engine
•
Dry sump lubrication system, racing pedigree.
•
Four overhead camshafts, driven by chains. Timing variators on the intake camshafts
•
Four valves per cylinder, hydraulic tappets.
•
Bosch Motronic ME7.1.1 integrated injection and ignition system, drive by wire.
•
Immediate throttle response for a sporty driving style, maximum driving pleasure in
daily use.
•
Power output of 390 hp at 7000 rpm
•
Torque output of 452 Nm at 4500 Nm
Engine evolutions:
•
Complying Euro 4 standard from MY06 for the markets where necessary.
•
Double fuel pump replaced by a single unit from MY06.
•
New engine oil reservoir from MY06 for US/CDN specifications.
See chapter 3 for more details on the F136R engine.
Maserati Academy
53
Introduction to Maserati
Coupé, Spyder & GranSport
Transmission
Manual transmission:
•
Newly designed transaxle configuration with
rear mounted gearbox/differential and torque
reaction tube guarantee an excellent weight
distribution between the front and rear axles.
•
Dual plate clutch with reduced rotational
inertia allows the engine to pick up and loose
speed quickly.
•
Standard
Graziano.
•
Limited slip differential, 25 % locking ratio
during acceleration, 45 % during release.
6-speed
gearbox,
made
by
Cambiocorsa transmission:
•
Electro-hydraulic operation system for both
gearbox and clutch control.
•
Mechanical gearbox requires no modifications
for adaption of the Cambiocorsa system
•
Gerashifting by means of tho gearshift
paddles behind the steering wheel.
•
Possibility to be driven in boyh manual and
fully automatic mode.
•
Normal, Sport and Ice (low adherance)
operation modes.
Evolutions:
•
Software update to Sofast (CFC201) for
smoother gearchange, more driving comfort
and less noise.
•
Adaption of Sofast
assembly 12.204.
Maserati Academy
II
(CFC231)
from
54
Introduction to Maserati
Coupé, Spyder & GranSport
Braking System
•
Brembo braking system with light alloy 4pistoncalipers.
•
Ventilated and perforated brake discs, 330 x
32 mm front, 310 x 28 mm rear.
•
Bosch 5.7 integrated ABS system
concludes: ABS anti brake-lock system,
EBD electronic brake force distribution,
MSR to prevent the rear wheels from locking
during downshifting, ASR traction control
system and MSP stability control.
Suspensions and Wheels
•
Light alloy suspension levers, double
wishbone type with antidive and
antisquat geometry.
•
Skyhook system with electronically
controlled damping available upon
request.
•
Two operation logics for Skyhook:
Normal and Sport.
Evolutions:
•
New shock absorbers settings and new
Skyhook
system
software
and
hardware for MY06.
Safety Components
•
Two dual stage front airbags
•
Two side airbags, integrated in door panels
•
Seatbelts with pyrotechnical pretensioners
•
Inertia switch for fuel cut-off in case of a collision.
Maserati Academy
55
Introduction to Maserati
Coupé, Spyder & GranSport
Internals
•
The interior of the Coupé and Spyder is characterised by
the use of precious materials, cured in every detail.
•
Optimal driving position and ergonomic seats which are
fully electrically adjustable.
•
Easy Entry system for easy access to the rear seats
(Coupé)
•
Sportiness without compromising comfort, room for four
adults (Coupé).
•
Classical Analogue instruments, characterized by white
dashes on a blue background.
•
Maserati Info Centre with with a 5,8” colour info screen
showing information about the sound system with CD
player, and automatic climate control. On request also
satellite navigation, GSM telephone and CD-changer.
•
Traditional analogue clock integrated in the center of the
dashboard panel.
Maserati Academy
56
Introduction to Maserati
Coupé, Spyder & GranSport
GranSport
With the GranSport, presented at the Geneva motor show of 2004, Maserati revives one
of the great names of its own motoring heritage to indicate the most dynamic version of
the M138 model range. The GranSport name was used in the 1950’s to indicate an
elegant two-litre coupe on the basis of the famous A6G model with Frua bodywork.
The GranSport incorporates all necessary ingredients to convert the Coupé from a great
performance GT car in a true driving machine. The GranSport was joined later by an open
GranSport Spyder version, presented at the Frankfurt motor show of 2005.
Various modifications gave the GranSport a more sporty temperament:
•
Modified F136R engine delivers now 400 hp at 7000 rpm. 10 horsepower was
gained by adapting a new engine control software, intake air ducts and valve seats
were elaborated and internal friction was reduced by reworking several components.
•
Newly designed exhaust system with electronically controlled pneumatic by-pass
valves for the rear silencers provide a deep and sporty engine sound
•
Excellent performances: top speed of 290 km/h and acceleration from 0 to 100 km/h
in only 4.85 seconds. The standing kilometer is covered in 23 seconds.
Maserati Academy
57
Introduction to Maserati
Coupé, Spyder & GranSport
•
New light alloy wheels with Trident design inspired by the Trofeo
championshiop cars. Diameter increased to 19” and new tyres.
•
10 mm lowered suspension and new suspension settings.
•
New controlling software for Cambiocorsa gearbox (standard)
leads to faster gearshifting (35% faster).
•
6° gear with a 5% longer ratio.
Externals:
Internals:
•
Various external modifications are
the result of intense testing work in
the wind tunel.
•
•
More muscular and sporty
appearance
New leather upholstery and new
special “technical” fabric for the
dashboard coming from the nautical
world
•
•
Coefficient of drag of only 0,33:
amongst the best in its category
New ergonomic seats with improved
lateral support, fully electrically
adjustable.
•
New and larger front grille with
chrome mesh which reminds of the
Quattroporte grille.
•
Newly designed central console with
carbon fibre inlay
•
Blue “START” button on central
console
•
New instrument panel with sporty white
graphics on a blue bachground
•
New leather and carbon fibre steering
wheel with ergonomic grip.
•
New Becker “On Line Pro” audio
system.
•
New aluminium sporty pedals
•
Newly designed front and rear
bumper.
•
Newly designed sporty side sills
•
Small bootlid spoiler
Maserati Academy
58
Introduction to Maserati
Coupé, Spyder & GranSport
GranSport Contemporary Classic
This special edition of the GranSport
was presented at the 2006 Paris motor
show. The GranSport Contemporary
Classic is recognisable by its alloy
wheels with “Ball Polish” finishing and
red painted brake calipers.
GranSport MC Victory
To celebrate the winning of the Constructors Cup with its MC12 racing cars in the 2005
FIA GT Championship, Maserati enriches her model range with a special version of the
GranSport produced in a limited series of only 180 pieces. The GranSport MC Victory has
the following specific features:
•
Special “Victory Blue” external colour
•
A numbered identification plate on the central console
•
A newly designed carbon fibre front spoiler with lateral profiling improves downforce
•
A small boot lid spoiler finished in carbon fibre
•
19” alloy wheels in titanium finishing
•
Label with the Italian flag on both front side wings reminds to the MC12 racing cars
•
Bucket seats made of carbon fibre are taken from the MC12, finished in blue leather
and alcantara.
•
Blue alcantara upholstery for the dasboard.
•
Carbon fibre central console
Maserati Academy
59
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Quattroporte (M139)
Technical Introduction
0.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
General Information
Engine
Clutch
Transmission
Braking System
Driving Controls
Suspensions and Wheels
Safety Components
Electrical Systems and Devices
Body
Maserati Academy
61
71
99
100
115
130
131
137
143
159
60
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
0. General Information
Model Hystory
The Maserati Quattroporte (model code M139) was presented in late 2003 at the Frankfurt
motor show as the fifth generation of the Maserati high performance premium saloon. With
its elegantly-designed Pininfarina body, the Quattroporte made a triumphant return in the
highest segment, 40 years after the introduction of the first, Frua-boddied Quattroporte.
Inimitable Trident style, sophisticated interior and spirited temperament characterise the
new Maserati flagship which has won numerous important national and international
awards. The Quattroporte offers superior handling due to a perfect weight distribution.
This is thanks to an engine mounted behind the front axle and a rear mounted, transaxle
gearbox. Since its first introduction, the model underwent various modifications and has
been subject to a continuous improvement of quality. Also, various different versions were
derived from the original model.
Quattroporte
The Maserati Quattroporte in its original configuration is equipped with a 4.2 V8 dry sump
engine (F136S) and a rear mounted, robotized manual six-speed gearbox (Duoselect).
Quattroporte Sport GT
Presented at the Frankfurt motor show in September 2005, The Quattroporte Sport GT
was created to meet the demands from customers who desired greater performance and
sportiness from the Maserati flagship. The Sport GT has the following specific features:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Specific 20” wheels
Specific exhaust system for a more
intens sound
Specific Gearbox software for faster
gearshifting (35% in Sport mode)
Cross-drilled brake discs
Metallic flexible brake hoses
Specific software for the Skyhook
variable suspension
Standard fitted TPMS
Various specific external and internal
aesthetic features
Maserati Academy
61
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Quattroporte Executive GT
Presented toghether with the Quattroporte Sport GT, the Executive GT represents the
Quattroporte in its most elegant form. Comfort levels of the Executive GT are at their
highest and most exclusive. Standard features include: alcantara roof upholstery, leather
and wood steering wheel rim, rear seat heating, ventilation and massage functions, rear
window curtains, rear stowable wooden tables and rear seat control panel for HVAC.
Technical differences remain limited to newly designed 19 inch rims with ball polish
finishing. Both Executive GT and Sport GT versions co-exist with the standard
Quattroporte model.
Quattroporte Automatic
The most important technical evolution came with the introduction of the Quattroporte
Automatic at the 2007 Detroit motor show. While the Quattroporte with Duoselect
transmission has proven to be an ideal match for Maserati’s sporty reputation, demand for
a fully automatic version has always been present. The Quattroporte Automatic is much
more then a Quattroporte simply fitted with a new gearbox. From the 16.500 components
of which the Quattroporte is made, 4.800 are new. The powertrain is completely new with
the adaption of a new wet sump engine (F136UC), gearbox, propellor shaft and limited slip
differential.
Also the Quattroporte Duoselect benefitted from the important improvements and
modifications introduced in the Quattroporte Automatic (MY07 onwards), such as the
completely redesigned HVAC system and improved comfort due to modifications made at
the wheel suspensions. The Quattroporte Automatic is available in standard version as
well as Sport GT and Executive GT.
Maserati Academy
62
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Quattroporte Sport GT S
The Quattroporte Sport GT S was presented at the 2007 Frankfurt motor show to replace
the Sport GT. The Sporty character of the Sport GT was further enhanced with a number
of new feartures:
•
•
•
•
Suspensions with stiffer springs and stiffer, single rate dampers; a ‘racing’ setup and
a lowered ride (10 mm at the front and 25 mm at the rear). Thanks to these
modifications, bodyroll and pitch has been significantly reduced, while increasing
driving agility.
New tyres developped especially by Pirelli for the Sport GT S. Lateral accelleration
has been significantly increased.
A new revolutionary brake system developped by Brembo uses Dual-cast aluminium
and cast iron discs (first time on a production car), front discs with increased
diameter and six piston calipers.
Various aesthetic modifications, such as door handles in body dolour, dark exhaust
pipes and side window trims and dark chrome 20 inch wheels for what concerns the
exterior. Internally, the sporty character is enhanced by the combination of Poltrona
Frau leather and alcantara.
The Quattroporte Sport GT S is available with automatic transmission only.
Maserati Academy
63
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Quattroporte Collezione Cento
The Quattroporte Collezione Cento, of which just 100 units will be produced, has been
conceived for those who seek the last word in luxury. Original design solutions combine
ellegance and traditional Maserati comfort with cuting-edge technology that includes
mobile office and entertainment facilities. This special version of the Quattroporte was
presented at the Detroit motor show in Januari 2008 and is available with automatic
transmission only.
The Quattroporte Collezione Cento features the following specific items:
•
Exclusive plate numbered from 1 to 100 on instrument panel.
•
Smart new ivory paint color with contrasting pin stripe.
•
Chrome honeycomb grille and side vents.
•
19” or 20” ball-polished rims and silver coloured brake calipers.
•
New tan leather coloured seats with specific stitching and buttons.
•
New wenge wood inlays for steering wheel and central console.
•
New beige grain leather headlining.
•
Booth space with aluminium piping and tan leather pockets.
•
Dual 10.4” touchscreen monitors installed in the front seatbacks.
•
Rear DVD player and commands.
•
AV aux, I-pod socked and two usb ports in rear armrest.
•
Wireless headphones and bluetooth keyboard.
Maserati Academy
64
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Dimensions, capacities and weights
Trunk compartment capacity:
Fuel tank capacity:
450 l
90 l (included 18 l reserve)
Weights Quattroporte Duoselect:
Unladen weight (included 90L of fuel):
Max. permitted weight:
Weight distribution front / rear:
1970 kg
2345 kg
47% / 53%
Weights Quattroporte Automatic:
Unladen weight: (included 90L of fuel):
Max. permitted weight:
Weight distribution front / rear:
Maserati Academy
1990 kg
2365 kg
48,5 % / 51.5%
65
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Performances and Fuel Consumption and emissions
Quattroporte Duoselect:
Top speed:
Acceleration 0 – 100 km/h:
Acceleration from standstill to 400 m:
Acceleration from standstill to 1000 m:
275 km/h
5.2 s
13.3 s
24.2 s
Fuel consumption and emissions (2002/80B/CE standard):
City cycle:
23,2 (l/100 km)
Motorway cycle:
11,5 (l/100 km)
Average fuel consumption:
15,8 (l/100 km)
CO2 emissions (average):
370 (g/km)
Quattroporte Automatic:
Top speed:
Acceleration 0 – 100 km/h:
270 km/h
5,6 s
Fuel consumption and emissions (2004/3/CE standard):
City cycle:
21,99 (l/100 km)
Motorway cycle:
10,50 (l/100 km)
Average fuel consumption:
14,73 (l/100 km)
CO2 emissions (average):
345 (g/km)
Maserati Academy
66
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Towing the vehicle
In case it is necessary to tow the vehicle, screw the towing eye completely till the end into
the towing eye attaching point. Put the gearbox in its neutral position ad disengage the
EPB (QP Automatic).
Note: if the vehicle is towed with the front wheels lifted and the ignition key ON, an error
code will be stored if the MSP system has not been deactivated.
Note (2): towing of a Quattroporte Automatic must be limited (max distance 100 km and
max speed 60 km/h) to avoid gearbox damage due to insufficient lubrication.
Lifting and jacking
Use the indicated points only for lifting or jacking of the vehicle:
Maserati Academy
67
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Scheduled Maintenance Quattroporte Duoselect:
Maserati Academy
68
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Scheduled Maintenance Quattroporte Automatic:
Maserati Academy
69
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati Academy
Quattroporte
70
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
1. Engine
The Maserati Quattroporte is fitted with two different engines (F136S and F136UC). Both
engines are all-alloy 90° 8 cylinder V-engines with a total displacement of 4.2 litres. The
main difference between both engines lies in the lubrication system. Power and torque
figures of both engines are comparable.
The F136S dry sump engine is used in the Quattroporte models with Duoselect
transmission. This engine is an evolution of the F136R engine as used in the M138
models. Certain modifications were made to the cylinder heads, intake manifold and
engine software.
The F136UC wet sump engine is used for the Quattroporte models with ZF automatic
transmission. Although this engine is considered as an evolution of the F136R/S engine,
80% of its components are new.
Both engines can easily be identified when opening the bonnet as the dry sump engine
has red cylinder head covers, while for the wet sump engine they are painted in blue.
For the introduction of the Quattroporte with automatic transmission, a new engine with a
traditional, wet sump lubrication system was developped. This solution is considered as
more adequate for the application in Maserati vehicles as it is less noisy as a dry sump
engine with its external, multiple oil pump. This engine has maintained the high power and
torque values of the dry sump engine while at the same time it is technically less complex
and thus more economical. Also, reliability and fuel economy of the new engine has been
improved.
In order to obtain an ideal weight distribution the engine is put well back in the quattroporte
chassis, positioned completely behind the front wheel axis. See chapter 3 for more
technical details on both engines.
CAUTION!
Oil level check and filling procedures are
specific for both engines
Maserati Academy
71
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Engine specifications:
Engine code
F136S
F136UC
configuration
V 90°
V 90°
Number of cylinders
8
8
Bore
92 mm
92 mm
Stroke
79,8 mm
79,8 mm
Total displacement
4243,8 cm³
4243,8 cm³
Compression ratio
11: 1
11: 1
Power output
294,9 kW (400bhp)
294,9 kW (400bhp)
Corresponding engine speed
7250 rpm
7000 rpm
Torque output
444,5 Nm
460 Nm
Corresponding engine speed
4750 rpm
4250 rpm
Lubrication system
Dry sump
Wet sump
Engine control system
Timing variation system (intake)
Bosch Motronic ME 7.1.1
High pressure
Low pressure
Note: the quattroporte is complying with Euro 4 regulations from MY06 in the markets
where necessary.
Maserati Academy
72
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Engine performance curves:
F136 Carter secco
vs
F136 Carter umido
500
310
490
300
480
290
470
280
460
270
450
440
260
430
250
420
240
410
230
400
220
390
TORQUE (Nm)
370
200
360
190
350
180
340
170
330
160
320
POWER (Kw)
210
380
150
310
140
300
290
130
280
120
270
110
260
100
250
90
240
80
230
220
70
210
60
200
50
80
75
70
65
60
55
50
45
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
0
00
50
rpm
Torque F136 S
Maserati Academy
Torque F136 UC
Power F136 S
Power F136 UC
73
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Bosch Motronic ME7.1.1 engine control system
System components:
•
ME7 engine control unit
•
8 ignition coils
•
Mass Air flow meter with integrated intake air
temperature sensor
•
Fuel pump unit
•
Two Air Coolant temperature sensors
•
Anti-evaporation system
•
Accelerator pedal unit
potentiometers
•
DMTL system
•
Secondary air system
•
RPM sensor on flywheel side
•
Timing sensors on both intake camshafts
•
Timing variators with solenoid valves on intake
side
•
4 Knock sensors
•
Wide-band oxygen sensors (pre-cat)
•
Two-level oxygen sensors (post-cat)
•
Motor-driven throttle
position sensors
•
8 fuel injectors
Maserati Academy
with two integrated
body
with
integrated
74
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
The engine management system is divided into two 4-cylinder units, with an ECU and
integrated ignition/injection controls and fuel pump control. It is connected, via CAN line, to
other vehicle control systems which interact with the engine management.
For the USA version: On-Board Diagnosis 2 complying with the California 96 regulations.
For the EUROPEAN version: on board diagnosis (EOBD) complying with European
regulations. The ignition and injection systems are integrated and equipped with special
technical solutions capable of detecting operating malfunctions in the engine control unit,
so that compliance with the emission control standards is assured.
The accelerator is of the "Drive by wire" electronically controlled type and follows a precise
operating logic: small angles or reduced pressure on the pedal are followed by optimally
proportional opening angles of the throttle.
Fuel
Injector
Air flow
meter
Air
Main path
Throttle
Spark
Accelerator
pedal
Maserati Academy
Spark
plug
75
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Engine control system software version:
Example table, always check Modis for the latest
release published!
Checking of the engine node software combined with the transmission software is of
fundamental importance for correct diagnostics.
Before making any replacements or disassembling any parts of the car involving problems
related to the engine or transmission control unit, it is mandatory to check the
correspondence between the Engine SW and the Transmission SW, as shown in the table
published on Modis, which is constantly updated by the Maserati Technical Assistance
Service.
Also in the event of replacement of a control unit it is indispensable to subsequently check
correct matching as per the table, in accordance with the assembly N°, Model, Year, and
hardware version of the node concerned.
The Software is checked with SD3, interrogating the engine control node and the
transmission control node and subsequently checking compatibility by means of the table
and performing a remote download if necessary.
Maserati Academy
76
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Air intake system:
The air intake system of the Quattroporte is composed of the following components:
•
Plastic intake manifold with optimised lengths
•
Electronic throttle body
•
Mass air flow meters
•
Two resonators
•
Air filter en filter housing placed in front of the engine.
•
Dual air intake duct placed in high position.
The minimum hydraulic diameter is 80 mm
1. Air inlet
2. Filter housing
3. Air flow meter
4. Plenum chamber
5. Motor-driven throttle body
For MY07 and Quattroporte Automatic, a new, horizontally positioned air filter and filter
housing was introduced:
Maserati Academy
77
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Accelerator pedal module:
The accelerator pedal module is composed of two
independent potentiometers with separate supplies to
obtain a redundant signal for safety reasons. The signal
value of one potentiometer is half that of the other.
Reference values
Potentiometer 1
- Rest position = 0.65 ÷ 0.85 V
- Max. position = 3.7 ÷ 3.9 V
Potentiometer 2
- Rest position = 0.33 ÷ 0.42 V
- Max. position = 1.85 ÷ 1.95 V
V
1
2
Pedal position
Potentiometer 1 = main
Potentiometer 2 = secondary
The recovery strategy in the event of a
fault is different for the two potentiometers
Maserati Academy
78
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Motor drive throttle :
The throttle is driven by a PWM signal.
Throttle position control is provided by two complementary potentiometers. Idle speed is
maintained by adjusting the position of the throttle directly. In the event of a fault a
recovery position is guaranteed to arrive at an engine speed that is slightly higher than
idling.
Technical data:
•
Actuation: The throttle is actuated in a 0-12 V duty-cycle (PWM)
•
Reading voltage: 0-5V
•
Max. current: 9.5A
•
Time to reach 90% of target opening: <100 ms
•
Throttle opening with engine idling: 2-3%
•
Throttle opening in recovery conditions: 8% (mechanical zero = 1600 rpm)
V
2
1
1 = position sensor 1
2 = position sensor 2
Throttle position
Whenever the engine is started the throttle resets to the idle speed position;
for this reason the accelerator pedal should never be pressed during engine
starting.
Maserati Academy
79
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Self-learning of the motor-driven throttle
For proper operation of the throttle a self-learning procedure must be executed. Throttle
self-learning concerns 3 parameters:
•
•
•
Throttle totally closed position
Unpowered closed position.
Checking the return springs and maximum opening
The self-learning values (stored in the ECU) are lost when power is disconnected from the
ECU (battery disconnection or unplugging of ECU connector). Following a power
disconnection the self-learning procedure must be performed when power is reconnected.
Procedure: Key ON (without starting) > wait at least 20 seconds > Key OFF
Tester SD3 can be used to check that the self-learning procedure has been executed
correctly.
Throttle self learning counter = 11:
Throttle self learning counter = 0:
Throttle self learning counter = 1-10:
self learning to perform or
in execution
self learning completed
self learning not completed
This latter condition may denote a problem with the motor-driven throttle or that the
correct conditions for self learning have not been fulfilled.
Motor-driven throttle circuit diagram:
1. Ground
2. Throttle ground position
3. Stabiliser sensor 1 power supply
4. Fuel supply
5. Throttle position 2
6. Throttle position 1
Maserati Academy
80
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Air flow meter:
The air flow meter supplies the value relative to:
• Mass flow of aspirated air
• Temperature of aspirated air.
The sensor is supplied by a current value designed to maintain it as a reference
temperature. When it is subjected to an air flow it tends to cool and the ECU must
increase the current required to maintain the reference temperature. A variable NTC
resistance indicates the aspirated air temperature value.
3
4
5
1
6
7
8
9
2
1 - Sensor
2 - Cylindrical Frame
3 - Casing
4 - Measuring channel cover
5 - Hybrid-SHF
6 - Sensor-CMF
7 - Carrying plate
8 - Plug-In Sensor Casing
9 - O-Ring
10 - Temperature sensor
1
0
12Volt
MOTRONIC
Maserati Academy
81
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Fuel system:
1. Fuel tank
2. Electric pump
3. Delivery pipe (rail)
4. Injectors
5. Multifunctional valve (ventilation,
roll-over, tank filling stop)
6. Ventilation and roll-over valve
7. Decanter
8. Inertia switch
9. Fuel filler neck
The fuel systems utilised in Maserati cars are of the "Returnless" type
The fuel pump module is mainly composed of:
•
Fuel filter
•
Fuel pump with electric motor
•
Pressure regulator: 3.5 bar
•
Float with level sensor
The two fuel pump relays are driven directly by the
ECU. In contrast, the fuel level sensor is connected
to the Body Computer. The ECU receives the
information associated with the fuel level from the
Body Computer via the C-CAN network.
When the fuel level is very low, the ECU changes the misfiring
detection strategy. This means that a fuel shortage is not interpreted
as a misfire. This strategy avoids storage of unjustified misfiring
errors.
The fuel level is also important in order to enable or disable several
diagnostic functions.
All cars from MY06 onward have a single fuel pump.
Maserati Academy
82
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Fuel pump control circuit electrical diagram:
Pin 65 from the NCM has a dual function:
•
Ground for relay R17 (Key ON)
•
+ 12V for TEST mode of the DMTL system (Key OFF)
In order to reduce noise levels and avoid overheating of the fuel in the
tank, the fuel pump runs at low speed (by means of R17 and two
resistors) when fuel demand is low.
In hot start (water temp. > 120°C) and cold start conditions the fuel
pump runs at high speed for a few seconds.
Maserati Academy
83
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Injectors:
The injector is active when the pin from the engine ECU is connected to ground.
Technical data:
•
flow rate: 239.7 g/min
•
internal leakage: 2 mm3/min
•
voltage: 12 V
•
injection time: 2-4 ms with engine idling
•
injector resistance: +-12 Ohm (20°C)
Inertia switch:
The operating logic of the inertia switch is implemented through the control of the common
earth of the NCM and NVB nodes.
In the event of an accident, the switch cuts the earth connection (C009) with the NCM and
“routes” the connection to the NVB. This way, fuel delivery is cut off and the NVB unlocks
the doors and activates the hazard lights to facilitate the operations of the rescue team.
Maserati Academy
84
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Canister purge valve:
The canister purge valve is controlled in Duty-cycle (PWM). The use of this valve makes it
possible to eliminate fuel vapours from the tank system by routing them to the aspiration
system. The engine control module activates the purge valve periodically and determines
the necessary opening of the valve based on the engine running conditions and the fuel
level in the fuel tank.
Connection
line
O-Ring
Coil Armature
Gasket Seat
Spring
IGNITIO
N COIL
Connection
line
Magnetic body
with bore hole
DMTL system:
The Diagnostic Module Tank Leakage (DMTL) is employed on cars for the US market for
tank seal diagnostics and for canister purging. For diagnostic purposes, the reference
used by DMTL is the current required to drive a motor that forces air through a 0.5 mm
hole. Subsequently it pressurises the tank and, if it detects a hole, the required current will
be lower than the reference current of the 0.5 mm hole.
In contrast, during canister purge mode, the DMTL controls the inlet of ambient air which
then flows through the canister toward the aspiration system.
Maserati Academy
85
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Bleeding procedure:
Throttle
Antievap.
solenoid valve
Tank
Canister
Engine
Changeover
Valve
Calibrated
opening
Ambient air
M
pump
Air filter
Calibration procedure:
The motor drives the pump and the air flows through an 0.5 mm calibrated hole, during
which procedure the constant current absorbed by the motor, which is strictly dependent
on the size of the hole, is recorded.
Throttle
Antievap.
solenoid valve
Canister
Tank
Changeover
Valve
Calibrated
opening
Air filter
Ambient air
M
motor
Maserati Academy
pump
86
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Test procedure:
The changeover valve is open and the anti-evaporation valve is closed. The canister/tank
air circuit is set and held under pressure by the pump. The absorbed current is measured
and compared to the reference current value.
Antievap.
solenoid valve
Throttle
Tank
Canister
Engine
Changeover Valve
Calibrated
opening
Air Inlet
M
motor
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
pump
Air filter
engine rpm
=0
altitude
< 2800m
engine temperature (off)
> 3.8 °C
ambient temperature 3.8 °
< T < 35,.3 °C
fuel level
from 15% to 85%
vehicle speed
= 0 Km/h
battery voltage
10.95 < Vb < 14.5
Correct operation of the altitude, engine temperature, vehicle speed, air
pump, and anti-evaporation valve sensors.
Driving cycle of at least 600 seconds, then
Engine off for at least 5 hours, then
Driving cycle of at least 800 seconds
Test launched several seconds after KEY OFF
The test can also be launched manually by means of the short trip
(cycle environment in SD3)
Maserati Academy
87
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Ignition coils:
The ignition coil is of the magnetic closed circuit type. The windings are housed in a
plastic casing immersed in epoxy resin and positioned one on top of the other around a
central ferrous core.
The Motronic activates the power stage (thanks to a series of transistors) on the coil for
the necessary charge time to bring the primary winding current to its maximum value. The
energy stored in the coil is proportional to the charge time.
At the time of ignition (which corresponds to the required advance) the power stage
interrupts the flow of current on the primary winding. At this point the significant change in
the magnetic field generates a voltage on the secondary winding. When this voltage is
applied to the spark plug it results in the generation of a spark.
Technical data:
•
Power supply: 12V
•
Primary winding current: 7 A
•
Charge control: 5V
•
Dwell time: 2.8 ms
•
Secondary winding voltage: 30 kV
+12V
ECU
GROUND
Maserati Academy
88
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Eldor coil:
All Quattroporte vehicles from Assembly 24275 are fitted with Eldor type ignition coils.
Benefits of the Eldor coil:
•
Simplification of fixing on the cylinder head covers.
•
Provision to accommodate future developments for knock and misfiring
diagnostics.
•
More stable combustion at high revs.
ECU
+15
1
2
E
3 4
C
Pin 3 = 5V control signal from ECU
The Eldor coil requires a specific spark plug. This results also in a
modification of the cylinder head for all engines equipped with Eldor coils.
Always check the correct match when replacing spark plugs.
Maserati Academy
89
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
RPM sensor:
The RPM sensor is a variable reluctance transducer (also known as a pick-up or inductive
sensor) located in proximity of the tone wheel keyed to the crankshaft.
The tone wheel has 58 (60-2) teeth.
Resistance = 1134 ÷ 1386Ω (20°C).
The prescribed gap between the tip of the sensor and the tone wheel to obtain correct
readings is between 0.5 and 1.5 mm. The output voltage varies with the rotation speed.
Timing sensor:
The timing sensor is a Hall-effect transducer fitted in correspondence with a tone wheel
with four cams on the intake camshafts.
In normal conditions the timing sensor output signal is 5V, but when the magnetic cam is
aligned with the sensor the signal is lost, thereby informing the ECU of the position of the
camshaft (the ECU reads the downward flanks of the timing signal)
The timing sensor is an active transducer. This means that the position of the camshaft is
recognised even when the engine is stopped. The timing signal is utilised to recognise the
position of the engine and for the VVT system.
Maserati Academy
90
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Broad band oxygen sensor (Bosch LSU)
Oxygen Sensor Current [mA]
The pumping or measuring cell is maintained with a stoichiometric A/F ratio. In the
presence of excess oxygen in the exhaust gas, positive pumping current makes it
possible to remove said excess oxygen. The opposite situation occurs with rich
mixtures.
The pumping current therefore indicates the stoichiometric ratio and the concentration
difference generates a current.
3
1
"Rich" mixture
2
"Lean" mixture
2
2
1
0
1
-1
-2
0.7 1
1.3
1.6
1.9
2.2
Lambda factor (Excess oxygen)
LSU type broad band oxygen sensors always function in CLOSED LOOP mode except
during the "light off" period and for very short intervals during transients.
Maserati Academy
91
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Two-level oxygen sensor (Bosch LSF)
The oxygen sensor measures the A/F ratio in burnt exhaust gas with respect to a
stoichiometric composition. In practical terms, the sensor measures the difference in the
concentration of oxygen in the exhaust gas and in ambient air.
Once the sensor has been heated by its internal heating circuit, the oxygen on the
external electrode is broken down into ionic form by the catalytic film of the electrode. A
similar process occurs on the internal electrode with ambient air. The concentration
difference generates a voltage signal in mV. These sensors are capable of defining only
whether the mixture is rich or lean, without providing any
quantitative information. The sensors are therefore also known as on-off or LSF sensors.
1
2
Sensor Voltage [mV]
1000
1
"Rich" mixture
2
"Lean" mixture
800
600
400
200
0
0.8
0.9
1
1.1
1.2
Lambda factor (Excess oxygen)
Technical data:
•
Power supply: 12 V
•
heater power: 7 W
•
heating current: 2.1 A
•
heating control: PWM 0-12 V
•
exit: 0-900 mV
Maserati Academy
Closed loop check conditions:
feedback on the rear oxygen
sensors can be checked with a
road test, by means of
acquisition with SD3.
92
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Catalytic converter monitoring:
Catalytic converter
λ-post-cat
sensor
Air Flow
Sensor
λ-post-cat
sensor
Catalytic
converter
monitoring
Injectors
Fault
managem
ent
Calculated
Injection
time
*
λ-control
λ-limitcontrol
MIL
Pre-cat oxygen sensor = LSU
Post-cat oxygen sensor = LSF
Lambda > 1 :
Lambda = 1:
Lambda < 1 :
Mixture = lean
Mixture = correct
Mixture = rich
In accordance with regulations, the engine must always* run
with Lambda = 1 (correct mixture)
(*): except during a brief interval after cold starting and during short-term transients.
To obtain and maintain a correct F/A mixture the Lambda monitoring system must function
in "Closed Loop" mode (with feedback). The "open loop / closed loop" state can be
checked by means of tester SD3.
Maserati Academy
93
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Pre-cat lambda monitoring:
The Lambda value for the two banks upstream from the catalytic converters is monitored
by means of LSU type sensors (broad band oxygen sensors). These sensors make it
possible to measure the Lambda value in real time and with high precision.
The measured Lambda value is subsequently compared by the ECU with the value
calculated in accordance with a model and any changes are compensated by means of
the "Fuel Trim" strategy (Closed Loop operation)
Fuel trim:
•
The expression Fuel Trim is used in various regulations to indicate the correction
of the quantity of fuel based on information supplied by the oxygen sensors.
•
The ECU compares the real Lambda value measured by the pre-cat sensor with
the target Lambda value.
•
To maintain the correct stoichiometric air/fuel ratio the ECU calculates a correction
of the injection quantity in real time.
•
This real time correction is designated "Short Term Fuel Trim".
•
The "Short Term Fuel Trim" is expressed as a percentage correction of the fuel
quantity.
•
When the mixture is too lean or too rich, the ECU continues to make corrections
until the limit is reached (in both directions).
•
The ECU transfers the Short Term Fuel Trim value continuously and progressively
to the "Long Term Fuel Trim" (= integral correction). The Motronic subsequently
corrects the carburetion map and adapts it by "moving it".
•
A "Long Term" correction corresponds to a 1% correction of the map (positive or
negative) and is saved in the ECU.
•
When the Long term Fuel Trim reaches a certain limit (usually a 10% variation,
although this depends on the standard), an error code is stored and the engine
check warning light illuminates.
•
This condition indicates the presence of a problem in the air or fuel system
(malfunction of air flow meter, injectors, oxygen sensors, exhaust, EVAP
system...).
•
The Long Term Fuel Trim is specific for engine idling and for low/high engine load
conditions.
•
The Fuel Trim is specific for both cylinder banks and can be verified with the SD3
tester.
Maserati Academy
94
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Post-cat Lambda monitoring:
The Lambda value down-stream of the catalytic converters is monitored by LSF type
oxygen sensors (two-level sensors). These Oxygen sensors are less precise than LSU
type sensors, and they are utilised primarily for diagnostic purposes.
The Lambda value down-stream from the catalytic converters is used to:
•
Check proper operation of the catalytic converters: In the event of detection
of low efficiency of the catalytic converters, the Motronic ECU stores a DTC
and illuminates the MIL warning light.
•
Check proper operation of the Oxygen sensors up-stream of the catalytic
converters (plausibility check).
•
Provide a minor contribution to the Fuel Trim.
Slow Down strategy:
•
The catalytic converters may be damaged if the temperature rises excessively.
•
A mathematical model integrated in the ECU makes it possible to calculated the
temperature of the catalytic converters in real time.
•
The parameters utilised for the calculation are as follows: engine coolant
temperature, ambient temperature, engine load, ignition advance and Lambda
value.
•
The calculated temperature allows the ECU to protect the system from serious
problems by implementing suitable strategies
•
When the calculated temperature reaches 980°C the Slow Down warning light
flashes on the dashboard to alert the driver to the presence of a critical situation.
•
When the calculated temperature reaches 1040°C the Slow Down warning light
remains steadily illuminated and the ECU switches off the engine. Higher catalytic
converter temperatures would damage the converters and may result in a fire
outbreak.
Maserati Academy
95
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Exhaust system:
The exhaust system of the Quattroporte with dry sump engine (Duoselect) is composed of
the following components:
•
Two ceramic pre-catalytic converters, one per bank
•
Two ceramic main catalytic converters
•
Four Lambda sensors, two upstream (wide band) and two downstream (two
level) of the pre-catalytic converters
•
Central pre-silencer
•
Two rear silencers
•
Air-gap technology, external diameter: 75 mm, internal diameter: 65mm
The system has a specific design for USA and Europe specifications. With the introduction
of the Euro 4 anti pollution standard (from MY06), the USA type exhaust system was used
also for Europe specification vehicles.
The Euro 4 configuration was used from MY06 in the markets where necessary.
Euro 4 markets:
•
Europe
•
USA
•
Canada
•
Hong Kong
•
Singapore
•
Korea
•
Taiwan
Maserati Academy
Euro 3 markets:
•
South America
•
Middle East
•
Japan
•
Australia
•
China
•
Russia
•
Philippines
•
South Africa
•
Malaysia
•
Indonesia
96
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Euro 3 specification:
USA and Euro 4 specifications:
Maserati Academy
97
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Quattroporte Automatic (wet sump engine):
•
•
•
•
Two main metal-core
catalytic converters
Four oxygen sensors
Central pre-silencer
Two rear silencers
For the Quattroporte versions with a wet sump engine, the exhaust system is newly
designed for emission control. Modifications made to the secondary air system has
allowed to eliminate the pre-catalytic converters. Catalytic converters in a single metal
piece instead of the pre-catalytic converter solution upstream of the main catalytic
converter.
The V8 is connected to an exhaust gas expulsion system which uses metal instead of
ceramic catalytic converters: by means of a technology deriving from the racing world, the
cell density is decreased, with consequent reduction of the section resistant to the gas
flow and therefore less counter pressure upon exhaust.
Maserati Academy
98
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
2. Clutch
Quattroporte Duoselect:
All Quattroporte Duoselect models are
fitted with a dry 215 mm twin-plate
clutch. This solution significantly
reduces the rotational inertia and
consequently allows the engine to pick
up speed more quickly. A contact-less
position sensor continuously monitors
the actual clutch position.
See chapter 3 for more details.
•
From assembly 18822 (Sofast III), a clutch actuator pressure sensor was applied.
•
From assembly 21926 (Sofst III+), a new clutch with improved thermal inertia was
introduced. This new clutch can be retrofitted on previous vehicles but such an
operation includes replacement of the clutch housing.
Quattroporte Automatic:
The Quattroporte Automatic is fitted with a hydraulic torque converter which at the same
time operates as a drive-away clutch and contains an integral lock-up clutch. See chapter
3 for more details.
1.
2.
3.
Maserati Academy
Turbine
Stator
Pump
99
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
3. Transmission
Quattroporte Duoselect
Quattroporte Automatic
The Maserati Quattroporte is available with to different types of transmission:
The Quattroporte Duoselect has a transaxle configuration similar to the configuration of
the M138 models. A robotized manual 6-speed gearbox is positioned at the rear of the car
where it forms a sigle unit with the limited slip differential. A twin-plate clutch is mounted at
the engine side. The propellor shaft is located inside a steel reaction tube which forms a
solid connection between engine and gearbox.
From the beginning of 2007, the possibility is offered to costumers to enjoy the comfort of
a traditional automatic transmission in their Quattroporte. The 6-speed automatic gearbox
is made by ZF and has an adaptive shift strategy. A new limited slip differential is located
at the rear side while the propellor shaft is of the composed type.
The new powertrain configuration of the Quattroporte Automatic has also a certain
influence on the vehicle’s weight distribution, with a weight transfer from the rear to the
front axle of approximately 30kg. Total weight distribution remains however nearly perfect
with a slight emphasis on the rear axle.
Maserati Academy
100
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Quattroporte Duoselect transmission
System layout:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
Maserati Academy
Steel reaction tube
Clutch housing
Gearbox with integrated differential
Power unit
Hydraulic shift actuator
High pressure lines
Gearbox oil cooler
101
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Electronic gearbox control:
The transmission control unit (NCR –
Nodo Cambio Robotizzato) is located
in the trunk compartment, at the right
hand side.
CAUTION!
In case of replacement or software updating of engine or
transmission control ECU’s, always check if the correct software
version is used. It is crucial that engine software and transmission
software are matching. Note that transmission software is specific for
various model versions, model years and markets (EU – USA).
Always check the software version by means of the vehicle
assembly number.
Refer to the technical publications from the Maserati SAT
department to verify the correct software version.
Indicator lights:
The instrument cluster is fitted with following transmission-related warning lights:
The gearbox warning light is “ON” under self-test conditions and whenever an
anomaly has been detected. The activation signal is sent over the CAN line.
The oil level warning light relating to the reservoir of the hydraulic circuit is not
controlled by the NCR but by the imperial module (NIM). Activation passes
through the CAN line.
Maserati Academy
102
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Duoselect operating strategies:
System activation
By turning the ignition key to ON, the system will be activated and all the display segments
on the information display will be activated, during which time a self-test of the system is
performed. The gearbox malfunction indicator will go out after a few seconds if no
anomalies were detected. The inserted gear will remain indicated on the display.
Key ON, engine OFF
When the engine is not running, only Neutral, 1st gear and Reverse gear can be selected.
Driver requests to select other gears are ignored.
Note: if continuous gear changes are performed while the engine is not running, a
protection strategy will be enabled which will disable further gear changes for a
determined period depending on various parameters. This strategy is to prevent
overheating of the electric pump and battery discharge. The rejection to perform further
gear changes will be announced by the buzzer.
Engine starting
The engine can be started with the gearbox in neutral or in gear, always with the brake
pedal depressed. The system opens the clutch, brings the gearbox in the neutral position
and enables the engine control module (NCM) to activate the starter engine.
Engine running
Once the engine is running, the system behaves in the following way:
•
When a gear is selected, the brake pedal is not depressed and the driver's door is
opened, the gearbox will immediately return to neutral.
•
When a gear is selected, the doors are closed and the brake pedal is not depressed,
the gear will remain engaged. If no further actions are taken, the system will return to
neutral after a 1 minute delay.
•
When a gear is selected and the brake pedal is depressed, the gear will remain
engaged for 10 minutes, after which the system will return to neutral if no further
actions are taken.
•
The gearbox will always return to neutral if the bonnet is opened.
Driving away
For driving away, the clutch has to close progressively. The engaging speed of the clutch
depends on the engine speed and accelerator pedal depression speed.
Note: at cold temperatures, the clutch will be engaged at a higher engine speed.
Note (2): when taking off is continued or repeated excessively, there is a high risk of
clutch overheating. The transmission control module (NCR) will detect the raise of the
clutch temperature and activate the buzzer signal to warn the driver.
Maserati Academy
103
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Upshifting
•
Upshifts can be carried out by pulling the “Up” lever without lifting the accelerator
pedal.
•
Only one gearchange at a time can be performed. Wait until the gearchange operation
is completed before demanding a next one.
Downshifting
•
Downshifts can be carried out by pulling the “Down” lever.
•
Only one gearchange at a time can be performed. Wait until the gearchange operation
is completed before demanding a next one.
Different gearbox operating modes
The gearbox can be used in either “Manual” and “Automatic” mode, for manual or fully
automatic operation. The “Sport” button enables the driver to opt between “Normal” or
“Sport” operating modes. Normal mode aims to achieve the best balance between comfort,
performance and fuel economy, while Sport mode adapts the gearshift strategy to
maximise driving pleasure and vehicle performance.
The “Ice” button activates a specific gearshift strategy to offer maximum safety and
handling on ice or low-grip road conditions.
Note: when both “Sport” and “Ice” modes are selected, Ice (low grip) mode has priority
and the Sport mode will be cancelled.
Maserati Academy
104
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Normal-Manual operating mode
In this mode the gears are selected by the driver using the gearshift paddles behind the
steering wheel. The selected gear (R,N,1,2,3,4,5,6) will be indicated on the information
display.
In Manual mode certain functions are still controlled automatically:
•
When the vehicle is slowing down and the engine speed decreases to around 1200
RPM, the system engages automatically a lower gear to avoid under-revving of the
engine.
•
When the engine speed is reaching its maximum RPM with the accelerator pedal
depressed (around 7200 RPM), a higher gear will be selected automatically.
Normal-Automatic operating mode
In this operating mode the gearshifts are performed completely automatically according to
a gearshift map which is programmed in the transmission control module (NCR). The
gearshift strategy is designed to offer the best compromise between driving comfort, fuel
economy and vehicle performance.
In this mode, the actual gear is indicated on the information display together with the
“AUTO” indicator.
Note: when driving in Automatic mode, gear changes can still be requested manually by
using the gearshift paddles. By doing so, the gearbox will temporary return to Manual
mode, during which time the “AUTO” indicator on the information display will flash for 5
seconds. After this the system returns to Automatic mode.
Sport operating mode
In Sport operating mode, the accent shifts towards driving pleasure and vehicle
performance. This function can be selected in both Manual and Automatic driving mode
and the “SPORT” indicator will be activated on the information display. Gearchanges are
performed more quickly and more aggressively with respect to Normal mode. The shifting
speed will also increase proportionally with throttle angle and engine speed.
When downshifts are performed at an engine speed superior to 5000 RPM, doubleclutching is performed automatically to raise the engine speed before engaging a lower
gear.
Note: in Manual-Sport mode, no automatic upshifts are performed when the engine speed
reaches the maximum RPM and the accelerator pedal is depressed. The engine will
remain at speed limiter revs if no manual upshifts are performed.
Note (2): in Manual-Sport mode, the automatic downshift function remains active to
prevent under-revving.
Note (3): when Ice (low grip) mode is activated, the Sport and MSP OFF modes will be
cancelled to give priority to driving safety.
Maserati Academy
105
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Ice (low grip) operating mode
By pushing the “Ice” button, a specific gearshift strategy for low adherence conditions
(rain, snow, ice,…) will be enabled and the “ICE” indication will be activated on the
information display. The Ice function can be used in both Manual and Automatic driving
mode and will cancel the Sport mode if it was activated. The Ice gearshift strategy
operates as follows:
Downshift requests which cause an engine speed higher then 2800 RPM are ignored.
Note: in Manual-Ice mode, the automatic upshift strategy is identical to that used in
Manual-Normal mode. Automatic upshifts are performed when the engine reaches its
maximum speed of around 7200 RPM.
System safety
The gear disengages:
•
Immediately when the engine compartment is open;
•
After 2 seconds when the door is open and the brake pedal is released;
•
After 1 minute when the door is closed and the brake pedal is released;
•
After 10 minutes when the door is closed and the brake pedal is depressed;
Accoustic signals
An accoustic warning signal will be given in the following situations:
When the reverse gear is engaged with key on and engine running.
When you wish to park the vehicle in neutral (key on / neutral selected / key off).
When automatic shift to neutral is signaled in the following conditions:
•
Key on, engine running: if the accelerator and brake pedal are not pressed for at
least 50 seconds.
•
Key on, engine running: if the brake pedal is pressed for more than 10 minutes.
•
Key on, engine running: If the door on the driver’s side is opened when the
accelerator and brake pedal have not been pressed for at least 5 seconds.
•
During the ignition stage: If a gearbox malfunction has been detected.
Maserati Academy
106
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Quattroporte automatic transmission
System layout:
The Quattroporte Automatic uses the ZF 6HP26 6-speed gearbox with hydraulic torque
converter with integrated lock-up clutch. The engine/gearbox assembly is supported by a
front subframe which has been redesigned for this purpose.
The rear differential from the Quattroporte Automatic is completely new and is built by
Graziano. The rear subframe has been redesigned and modified to house this new
differential.
Maserati Academy
107
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
The Quattroporte Automatic has a completely new transmission shaft which is of the
composed type and uses three constant-velocity joints. This solution was chosen because
of a not perfect alignment between the gearbox output axis and the differential input axis.
In case parts of the transmission have been removed or replaced (gearbox, transmission
shaft, differential), a shaft balancing procedure must be performed. This is to avoid the
appearance of vibrations inside the passenger’s compartment when driving at highway
speeds. See chapter 3 for more details.
Maserati Academy
108
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Gearshift operation:
The automatic and electronically-controlled gearbox has six forward gears and one
reverse gear, in addition to automatic gear engagement, the driver can also opt for manual
gear engagement. The gearshift lever can be shifted to the following positions:
•
•
•
•
•
P (park)
R (reverse gear)
N (neutral)
D (drive)
+ / - (Manual)
The lever position is shown on the gear display by the illumination of the corresponding
letter. This letter is also shown on the instrument panel display. The engine can only be
started when the gearshift lever is in P or N.
WARNING: After starting the engine and setting off, do not depress the accelerator pedal
before and while shifting the gearshift lever. This is particularly important when the engine
is cold.
Shift-Lock
This safety system allows you to shift
from P (PARK) to another position only
if the release button on the gearshift
lever and the brake pedal are
depressed. This prevents the vehicle
from involuntarily jumping forward or
backward.
A
Key-Lock
This function allows you to remove the key from the ignition switch only when the gearshift
lever is in P and within a maximum time of 30 seconds; when this time has elapsed the
key can no longer be removed from the ignition block. The gearshift lever can only be
shifted from P when the ignition key is in MAR position and the button on the lever (A) and
the brake pedal are depressed (Shift-Lock).
WARNING: In the case of an emergency, (e.g., breakdowns, battery flat, etc.) the ignition
key can be removed even if the gearshift lever is not in P. To do this, turn the key to
STOP, press the button F on the gearshift lever and at the same time remove the key.
Maserati Academy
109
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Parking
When parking the vehicle, shift the lever to P. An integrated gearbox device will lock the
rear wheels.
WARNING: To prevent accidental engagement, the gearshift lever can only be shifted
from P to any other position when the button on the gearshift lever and the brake pedal
are depressed.
WARNING: Shift the lever to position P only when the vehicle is stationary.
WARNING: Before getting out of the vehicle, check that the automatic parking brake is
engaged. Shift the gearshift lever to P even when you need to get out of the vehicle for
only a few seconds leaving the engine running.
WARNING: If you turn off the engine with the gearshift lever in a position different from P,
an acoustic signal will sound for a few seconds. If the driver’s door is opened with the
gearshift lever in a position different from P, an acoustic signal will sound for a few
seconds.
CAUTION!
When parking on steep slopes, it is recommended to shift the lever to
PARK before leaving the vehicle (whether the engine is running or not).
This is recommended since the EPB system installed in the vehicle is
capable of ensuring that the vehicle is properly parked and stationary when
fully laden only on a gradient up to 20%
Automatic or Manual operating mode
The gearbox can be used both in fully automatic (position D) and in sequential manual
(positions + or -) mode. The operating modes can be activated through the following
selections:
• D
• M (+ / -)
Automatic gearshifting (AUTO)
Sequential manual gearshifting (MANUAL)
The lever can always be shifted between these two positions even if the vehicle is moving
and without depressing the brake pedal. The lever can continuously be shifted between D
and M.
If automatic gearshift mode is selected, the word AUTO and the letter D will be shown on
the instrument panel display, while for sequential manual gearshifting, the word MANUAL
and the gear engaged will be shown.
Maserati Academy
110
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Automatic operating mode
Select this position when you wish to use of all the automatic gearshift functions.
With the vehicle stationary and the brake pedal depressed, shift the gearshift lever to D; if
the gearshift lever is in P or R, also press the button A on the lever knob.
When the function is set, the letter D illuminates on the gear display and on the instrument
panel.
With this function active, the ECU controls automatic engagement of the six gears. The
gears will be engaged in relation to the travelling speed, engine RPM, accelerator position,
speed with which the pedal is depressed, as well as the travelling conditions (uphill,
downhill, curves).
The system is programmed to classify all driving styles related to the above mentioned
parameters, matching them to ten different vehicle settings which go from extremely
comfortable and fuel-economy driving to full racing-style driving. The setting is selected
automatically.
Kick-down strategy
This strategy is activated by rapidly and fully depressing the accelerator pedal, which
causes engagement of a lower gear than the current one; this function assists the driver
when maximum acceleration is required. When the pedal is released, the best gear in
relation to the vehicle speed and the position of the accelerator pedal is automatically
engaged. The kick-down strategy can be activated only when automatic operation has
been set, with the gearshift lever in position D.
Strategies for downhill driving
When the accelerator pedal is released and the transmission in “DRIVE” mode, the
gearbox system detects that the vehicle is moving downhill and deactivates upshifting.
When the accelerator pedal is depressed, upshifting is reactivated, however, with a delay
of a few seconds.
When the brake pedal is depressed, the gearbox system downshifts to provide enhanced
engine braking power.
In other words, when driving downhill, the gearbox system operates so as to avoid
upshifting and shifting gears when the accelerator pedal is released, and delays gear
engagement by a few seconds when the accelerator pedal is depressed. In addition, when
the brakes are applied, it engages the lowest gear in order to provide enhanced engine
braking power.
This strategy is aimed at making downhill driving safer.
Strategies in curves
The system detects when the vehicle goes into a curve through the lateral acceleration
and the steering angle. Detecting this condition with the “DRIVE” mode selected, the
system deactivates both upshifting and downshifting until the vehicle comes out of the
curve. In particularly tight uphill curves the system downshifts.
Gearshifting is reactivated when the vehicle comes out of the curve at a distance that
varies depending on the vehicle speed.
Maserati Academy
111
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Manual operating mode
Down
Up
To engage the gears, move the gearshift lever to the following two positions:
+ UP to engage a higher gear
- DOWN to engage a lower gear.
Gearshift paddles on the steering wheel (standard for the Sport GT, optional for other
versions): in sequential manual operating mode, upshifting and downshifting can be
controlled not only with the gearshift lever but also with the two levers positioned behind
the steering wheel.
Also in automatic operation with the gearshift lever positioned in D (DRIVE), the driver can
request a gear different from the current one by activating one of the levers. This action
will temporarily switch the system to sequential manual operation. If the driver then keeps
to a constant driving style (low longitudinal and lateral acceleration), the gearbox
automatically switches back to automatic operation.
WARNING: Even if manual gearshifting mode has been activated, some functions are still
controlled automatically. When the engine is overrevving or underrevving, the system
automatically engages a higher or lower gear.
WARNING: If the driver requests a gearshift in conditions where the engine is overrevving
or underrevving, the system will not accept the command.
WARNING: The electronic control unit is programmed to handle one gearshift at a time,
therefore, fast and repeated requests will not necessarily result in a gearshift. The higher
or lower gear is engaged only if the previous gearshift procedure has been completed.
Acoustic signals
If the engine is turned off with the gearshift lever in a position different from P, an acoustic
signal will sound for a few seconds.
If the driver’s door is opened with the gearshift lever in a position different from P, an
acoustic signal will sound for a few seconds.
With the lever in R, the system emits an acoustic signal for a few seconds to warn anyone
in the vicinity that you are about to reverse.
Maserati Academy
112
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Adaptive shift strategy (ASIS)
Resulting from co-operation between ZF Getriebe GmbH, Robert Bosch GmbH and
Maserati, a new software for electronic transmission control has been developped,
containing a number of usefull functions. The ASIS system goes much further than a
simple adaptation of the gearshift strategy on the actual uphill or downhill road gradient, as
is used by most electronically-controlled automatic transmissions.
By increasing the interlinking of the transmission control with other vehicle control
systems, such as engine control, brakes (ABS) and stability control, a number of signals
are available that permit to describe the actual driving status.
By processing the information about lateral and longitudinal acceleration, engine speed
and torque, position and movement of the accelerator pedal, steering wheel angle, turning
speed of the individual wheels, oil temperature,… a conclusion can be drawn about the
vehicle’s load status and road topography, but also about the driving style of the driver,
which is infinitely variable between very sporty (dynamic) and extremely economic driving.
These informations are applied to the transmission operation. This function is refered to as
adaptive transmission control. It recognises the driver’s intentions, takes note of his or her
driving style and adapts its selection of gears accordingly. Manual intervention becomes
thus unnecessary.
The ASIS functions can be divided in two groups:
1) Evaluation of the driving style and determination of the type of driver: ASIS contains 20
different gearshift maps (10 for Auto Normal mode and 10 for Auto Sport mode). For each
driving mode the most suitable gearshift map is chosen according to the driving style.
2) Selection of the driving mode according to the driving situation, the topographical
conditions and the load status: based on the calculation of the road gradient, ASIS can
choose between 5 different gearshift maps (one for downhill driving, one for driving on
level roads and three gradations of uphill driving). The road gradient and vehicle load
status can be estimated by comparing the vehicle’s actual acceleration with the theoretical
acceleration given the vehicle’s weight, selected gear and engine torque.
The ASIS adaptive shift strategy based on the driving style comprehends a long-term
smoothing of the calculation of the driver’s driving style in order to be able to select the
most suitable gearshift map.
Note: the ASIS adaptive memory can be reset only by performing the cycle function with
the SD3 diagnostic tool. This can be necessary, for example when the vehicle is sold to a
new owner.
Note (2): the ASIS functions do not operate if the ICE mode is selected or if diagnostic or
safety functions (i.e. hot mode) are active.
Maserati Academy
113
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Hot-mode strategy
In the event that the transmission oil or coolant temperature or both are too high, the
gearbox system reduces the maximum engine speed to 4000 RPM. For this reason,
upshifting will occur at this limit.
This strategy does not affect downhill driving, so as to always have the efficiency of
engine braking together with the standard braking system.
Gearbox failure
This message, highlighted in red, indicates a gearbox system failure, therefore, if you are
travelling, the ECU that controls the device sets an emergency program. In these
conditions, we recommended that you stop the vehicle and turn off the engine for at least
one minute. When restarting the engine, the auto-diagnostic system may cancel the
malfunction, which will in any case be recorded by the ECU.
In failure conditions, the gearshift lever can however be shifted to R, N and D. When
shifting to D, only a few gears will be available for shifting, depending on the malfunction
found.
Automatic gearbox failure indication light:
depending on the message displayed it signals:
- a gearbox failure
- a too high temperature of the gearbox oil.
Low gearbox oil level indication light:
This icon indicates that the gearbox oil level is too low. If the warning
light comes on, stop the vehicle. Check the gearbox oil level.
Gearshift lever emergency release procedure
In the event of failure of the electrical power supply system with resulting dead battery, the
vehicle may only be moved after the gearshift lever has been released from the P position
and moved to the N position. When there is no power, the lever can only be released
using the emergency procedure.
•
Remove the cover (A) in front of the gearshift lever.
•
Using the screwdriver contained in the toolkit, push on the release mechanism
through the hole and at the same time shift the gearshift lever to N.
•
The gearshift lever has now been released.
NOTE: In order to tow the vehicle, the emergency release procedure of the EPB system
must also be performed.
Maserati Academy
114
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
4. Braking System
Characteristics:
•
Hydraulic brake circuit, X-separated (steel flexible brake lines on Sport GT)
•
15/16” master brake cylinder with 18+18 mm stroke
•
Vacuum brake assistance Ø 8 + 9”, control ratio of 13.5
•
Ventilated front discs, 330 x 32 mm (cross-drilled on Sport GT)
•
Front brake calipers with 4 pistons
•
Ventilated rear discs, 316 x 28 mm (cross-drilled on Sport GT)
•
Rear brake calipers with 2 pistons
•
Drum parking brake, integrated in rear brake discs
•
ABS / stability control Bosch 5.7 containing the following functions: ABS, EBD, ASR,
ESP, and MSR
Upgrades:
•
Adaption of the new Bosch ESP 8.0 ABS / stability control system (from assembly
24275 onwards)
•
upgraded rear brakes: 330 x 28 ventilated discs and 4 piston calipers (from MY07
onwards)
•
Adaption of an electrically operated parking brake (EPB) for the Quattroporte
Automatic.
•
Adoption of the Pre Release function of the EPB system for Quattroporte Automatic
for MY08 (assembly 34071 onwards)
•
New revolutionary dual-cast ventilated front brake discs with increased diameter
(360mm) and six piston calipers for the Quattroporte Sport GT S
Maserati Academy
115
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Dual-cast braking system
For the Quattroporte Sport GT S, a new revolutionary braking system has been developed
in collaboration with Brembo. This innovative technology uses dual-cast brake discs (cast
iron and aluminium) for the front brakes. It is the first time such a technology has been
employed on a road car.
This new technology, together with the larger disc diameter (360 mm) and new 6-piston
calipers makes from the Quattroporte Sport GT S one of the fastest stopping road cars
(from 100 km/h to standstill in little more than 35 m), while its reduced unsprung weight
offers important benefits in terms of comfort and driving precision.
Note: the rear brakes are identical to those from the Quattroporte Sport GT.
1) Cast iron friction ring
2) Aluminium central part
The co-cast or dual-cast floating brake disc is made of two materials, cast iron and
aluminium. This new disc has many advantages: reduced weight (15% lighter), greater
driving comfort, less corrosion, less wear and better brake performance.
The co-cast floating brake disc has a cast-iron braking surface and an aluminium hat:
ideally combining the advantages of heat-resistance and excellent friction characteristics
provided by cast iron with the lightweight properties of aluminium. The innovation is in the
way the two materials have been combined to a single component, and in the behaviour of
the disc during operation, functioning effectively as an integral disc at low temperatures,
then as a floating disc at high temperatures, when maximum performance is needed and
distortion tends to occur.
Unlike an integral disc, the co-cast brake disc presents a symmetrical braking surface,
favouring a more uniform temperature distribution when the brakes are applied: this
means considerably less residual deformation after the brake is released (–70%). This
effectively emulates the performance capabilities of a floating disc, but without the number
of components needed for a floating assembly.
Maserati Academy
116
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
MSP (Maserati Stability Program)
The MSP system (Bosch ABS/ESP 5.7) integrates the following functions:
•
ABS (Anti-lock Brake System): This system prevents the wheels from locking
during hard braking or braking under low adherence conditions. ABS guarantees the
controllability of the vehicle under braking conditions (control of the longitudinal
stability of the vehicle).
•
EBD (Electronic Brake force Distribution): Electronic distribution of the brake
force between front and rear axle.
•
ASR (Anti Slip Regulation): Traction control. This systems prevents the driven
wheels (rear wheels) from spinning during acceleration, improving traction in low-grip
conditions. For this function, MSP interacts with the engine control system.
•
MSR (Motor Schleppmoment Regelung): Electronic control of the engine brake
torque under downshift conditions. This system prevents the rear wheels from locking
under downshift conditions due to the high engine brake torque and thus guarantees
the vehicle’s stability. Also this system interacts with the engine control system.
•
ESP (Electronic Stability Program): This system monitors the vehicle’s stability
during cornering. ESP can apply the four brakes independently to bring the vehicle
back on track if a dangerous situation for the vehicle’s stability is detected (control of
the lateral stability of the vehicle).
•
Hill Holder (from ABS/ESP 8.0): this function will prevent the vehicle of moving
backwards during uphill departing.
Instruments and controls:
1
2
3
1.
2.
3.
4.
ABS system failure warning light
ASR system failure warning light
EBD system failure warning light
MSP (ESP) system failure warning light
Maserati Academy
1.
2.
3.
Sport switch
Low adherance switch
MSP off switch
117
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
MSP operation logic:
NORMAL mode
This mode provides maximum grip and the risks related to the most diverse driving
conditions are reduced. This offers the driver an invisible "safety guard", for any driving
style. If losing grip or in the event of skidding, the system operates in a targeted way
braking one or more wheels, thus allowing the driver to fully control the vehicle. The
operation is accurately performed without involving the driver. In this way, the vehicle will
continue to move in the desired direction without taking account of the action on the
accelerator pedal or the input transmitted to the braking system by the driver, whatever
the road conditions.
SPORT mode
This is the second option provided by the management system. When this mode is set,
the system will continue to provide the driver with an electronic protection system that is
capable of correcting possible critical situations, but at the same time it will offer more
demanding drivers enhanced driving freedom. For example, the vehicle is allowed to slide
sideways until reaching an angle of six degrees so as to offer the driver a sufficient
handling margin to express his vehicle control skills. This mode also offers the driver the
opportunity to explore the limits of the vehicle in full safety.
MSP OFF mode
If the vehicle is driven under "extreme" conditions, the ESP, ASR and MSR systems can
be fully deactivated by the driver. The vehicle will perform without any safety system and
the driver will have to rely only on the vehicle and his driving skills for particularly exciting
driving. Even if the control system is deactivated, ABS and EBD will remain active to
prevent wheels from locking.
MSP OFF is also the applicable driving mode in case snow chains are installed.
Low Adherance mode (ICE)
This mode can be used on particularly slippery road surfaces (e.g., snow, ice) and it is
activated/deactivated by pressing the button on the NIT. The word ICE will illuminate on
the instrument panel display. In “Low-grip" mode the system uses 2nd instead of 1st gear.
This means that when y start from a stationary position with the engine running - both in
automatic mode and manual mode - the vehicle will start in 2nd gear. When sequential
manual mode is selected with 2nd gear engaged, a downshift request will be ignored.
While driving, the system automatically switches to the upper gear if the engine reaches
the pre-established speed rate (3,000 RPM). “Low-grip" mode has priority over SPORT
mode and assists the MSP system.
If “ICE” mode is activated when “SPORT” mode is active, during the transition stage it may
happen that both the “ICE” and the “SPORT” messages are present on the CAN line. In
this case, the system will give priority to the “ICE” message, immediately showing it on the
display.
Maserati Academy
118
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
ABS operating principle
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Stage 1)
Stage 2)
Stage 3)
Stage 4)
Stage 6)
Stage 7)
Stage 8)
Stage 9)
Vehicle speed
Wheel speed during braking
Wheel acceleration
Solenoid valve current
Pressure in the braking
wheel’s hydraulic circuit
Wheel deceleration nearing limit: locking risk (-a )
Circuit pressure reduction: brake force reduction, wheel deceleration reduction
Pressure maintenance: wheel speed decreases, then rises again
Pressure increase: wheel acceleration to value + A
Peripheral acceleration reduction
Maintenance
Pressure increase: wheel acceleration +a, vehicle and wheel speeds similar
Maximum pressure: maximum brake force
Operation speed: From 4 to 10 adjustments are carried out every second, depending on
the friction conditions. Processing takes just a few milliseconds.
CAUTION!
Performance of the ABS system is strongly affected by the condition of
the wheel/tyre assembly. For the correct operation of the system it is of
most importance that the vehicle is fitted with rims, tyres and brake pads
approved by the manufacturer and in perfect working order.
Maserati Academy
119
Introduction to Maserati
There are two solenoid valves for each circuit
branch:
Inlet solenoid valve (9):
0 Volt = Open = Pressure on caliper
12Volt = Closed = Maintenance
Outlet solenoid valve (10):
0 Volt = Closed = No Pressure Relief
12Volt = Open = Pressure Relief
On Low Pressure Accumulator 2
Scavenge pump (4) delivers oil back to brake
master cylinder high pressure accumulator (5)
Maserati Academy
Quattroporte
1 ECU
2 Low pressure accumulator (tank)
3 Scavenge pump control motor
4 Scavenge pump
5 High pressure accumulator
(damping chamber)
6 Brake control master cylinder
7 Brake servo
8 Fast pressure reduction valve
9 Inlet solenoid valve
10 Outlet solenoid valve
11 Brake calliper
12 Rpm sensor
13 Toothed wheel
14 Restraint
120
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
ASR operating principle
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.
ECU
Low pressure accumulator
(reservoir)
Scavenge pump control motor
Scavenge pump
High pressure accumulator
(damping chamber)
Brake control master cylinder
Brake servo
Pressure fast reduction valve
Inlet solenoid valve
Outlet solenoid valve
Brake caliper
Rpm sensor
Toothed wheel
Restraint
Intake solenoid valve
Control solenoid valve
The purpose of ASR is to maintain traction (and thus guarantee the longitudinal stability of
the vehicle) when the driven wheels have the intention of skidding. This is usefull while
curving (dynamic load transfer between both driven wheels), when excessive engine
torque is transmitted to the wheels or in situations of low adherance. When skidding
occurs, ASR manages the following operations:
•
•
1° step: applying the brake(s) of the skidding wheel(s)
2° step: reduction of torque delivered from engine:
•
•
Reduction of spark advancing
Reduction of throttle valve opening and injection duration
Note: The threshold of intervention of the ASR system is set at a higher level when the
vehicle is driven in Sport mode.
Maserati Academy
121
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
EBD operating principle
EBD reduces the hydraulic pressure on the rear brake circuit when excessive deceleration
of the rear wheels is detected.
Pressure maintenance stage
Pressure reduction stage
MSP (stability control) operating principle
This system monitors the vehicle’s stability during cornering. ESP can apply the four
brakes independently to bring the vehicle back on track if a dangerous situation for the
vehicle’s stability is detected (control of the lateral stability of the vehicle). Besides
applying the brakes, MSP can also temporary deactivate automatic gearshifting in order
not to compromise the vehicle’s stability in emergency situations.
The MSP ECU processes the following signals:
•
steering angle, steering wheel rotation (steering angle sensor is located on the
steering column)
•
lateral acceleration and yaw (a combined lateral acceleration / yaw rate sensor is
located on the central tunnel, near the vehicle’s centre of gravity.
•
throttle valve position
•
Rotation speed of each wheel
•
hydraulic brake system pressure (pressure sensor integrated in HU)
Note: For both steering angle sensor / lateral acceleration and yaw rate sensor, a
calibration procedure is required after replacement.
!
The MSP system with its integrated functions (ABS, EBD, ASR, MSR, ESP) is
designed as a safety net only to secure the vehicle’s stability in emergency
conditions. Thanks to the Quattroporte’s well-balanced chassis, ideal weight
distribution and limited slip differential, MSP does not have to intervent under
normal driving conditions. This is one of the aspects that make from the
Quattroporte a superior driving machine amongst the luxury saloons.
Maserati Academy
122
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Bosch ABS/ESP 8.0
From assembly number 24275 onwards, a new generation of the integrated ABS/stability
control system was adopted to replace the current Bosch ABS 5.7 system. The Bosch
ABS 8.0 system integrates the following functions: ABS, EBD, ASR, MSR, ESP and Hill
Holder. The various operation strategies of the system have remained unchanged. The
only difference from the costumer’s point of view is improved comfort during ABS/EBD
intervention thanks to a more refined system operation.
Modifications with respect to Bosch ABS 5.7 system:
•
Basic functions have remained identical
•
Reduced weight by 25%: from 3 kg to 2,2 kg
•
Reduced dimensions by 30%: from 2,5 l to 1,6 l
•
Possibility to upload software updates.
•
Improved noise behaviour on account of new inlet valves and pump motor speed
control.
•
Control of system pressure in ASR or ESP operation by PWM control of the electrovalve and failsafe monitoring.
•
Submersible HU due to tight accumulator design and sealed motor.
•
Improved performance of integrated ECU.
•
Introduction of the Hill Holder function.
Maserati Academy
123
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Electric Parking Brake (EPB)
With the introduction of the Quattroporte Automatic, a new, electrically-operated parking
brake was introduced.
EPB system overview:
The system consists of the following components:
•
Electro-mechanic EPB actuator with integrated ECU
•
Drum parking brakes, integrated in the rear brake discs
•
Brake cables and divider
•
EPB activation lever
•
EPB Off switch
•
Emergency release tool
•
Parking brake warning light
The EPB actuator is locatd in the
trunk compartment, underneath the
trunk floor.
EPB Off switch
EPB activation lever
Maserati Academy
124
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
EPB operating strategies:
Assisted parking brake
The parking brake can be engaged and disengaged when the vehicle is stationary by
pressing the EPB activation button on the centre console. To ensure activation of the EPB
system, pull and hold the lever positioned on the gearshift lever console for about 2
seconds. The system can be deactivated by holding the brake pedal depressed and
pulling the lever
2
Automatic parking brake
Automatic parking brake engagement when the vehicle is stationary and the key is turned
OFF (default condition); this function can be disabled by the EPB OFF switch on the
central console before turning the key to OFF.
The PARK OFF switch positioned on the central console must be pressed before
switching off the engine to prevent automatic activation of the EPB. The message PARK
OFF is displayed on the instrument panel. The system is disabled only for next key-off
action, and when the engine is next started the default status is reset.
P
P
EPB ON
EPB OFF
km
km
000999
000999
When the electric parking
brake is engaged, the specific
warning light comes on. The
EPB activation status is
displayed on the instrument
panel in the display area (EPB
ON or EPB OFF).
When the EPB is engaged, the parking brake warning light is on.
Parking brake warning
light (EU, Japan
specifications)
Maserati Academy
Parking brake
warning light (US
specifications)
125
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Key-ON conditions
The parking brake is always active by default (PARK ON) and is not displayed on the
instrument panel.
When pressing the PARK OFF switch, the PARK OFF message is displayed on the
multifunctional display for 5 seconds.
Subsequently, if the PARK OFF switch is pressed again, the PARK OFF message
disappears and is replaced with the message PARK ON, which is displayed for 5 seconds
and then disappears.
18:30
EXT-23°C
3
EXT-23°C
3
5 sec.
MANUAL
km
18:30
km [A]
km
EXT-23°C
3
MANUAL
MANUAL
000999 998.9
18:30
km [A]
000999 998.9
km
km [A]
000999 998.9
Key-OFF conditions
When turning the key from ON to OFF, the EPB activation status is displayed on the
instrument panel, regardless of whether PARK ON or PARK OFF has been set. If the
engine is turned off when the PARK OFF function is active, the EPB function can be
reactivated by commanding the EPB activation switch. The new strategy suggested will be
shown on the display as EPB ON.
Drive away
Automatic parking brake disengagement during acceleration (accelerator pedal angle
>3%), always active.
Pre Release (from MY08 onwards)
Dynamic brake
Dynamic braking (while the vehicle is moving) is controlled by the ABS/VDC system until
the vehicle is stopped,
Keeping the EPB button active. In these conditions braking is controlled through the four
brake calipers. When the vehicle has come to a stop, the parking brake is automatically
engaged.
Maserati Academy
126
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
EPB control logic
It must be possible to activate (but not deactivate) the parking brake also when the engine
is off and for this reason, a specific power management strategy has been introduced.
The EPB is connected to the C-CAN line for communication with other control modules
and for diagnosis.
NFR
With the EPB, the ABS/VDC unit (NFR) is the system master and the EPB unit the slave.
Therefore, it is the ABS/VDC unit that determines when and how to activate/deactivate the
parking brake depending on the driving speed and the surrounding conditions (e.g., slope,
engine on/off, engine power delivered, etc.).
EPB emergency release procedure
If the EPB has jammed (complete system failure, dead battery,…) a special tool is
required to manually release the parking brake cables. This tool can be found in
the tool kit, delivered with the vehicle. A small opening can be found in the wall
behind the driver’s seat. To release the EPB, insert the tool in the tube and turn
clockwise until the parking brake cables are fully released.
Note: after having performed the emergency release, the EPB system has to be
calibrated with SD3. Therefore the vehicle has to enter an authorised service point.
Maserati Academy
127
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
EPB SD3 functions:
Control cable release
If replacing one or more components of the EPB system (control cables, brake shoes,
etc.) the cable tension must be slackened until fully releasing the cables: this will allow you
to remove the different parts.
Actuator calibration
Calibration is an operation whereby the nominal operating position of the ECU is set. In
brief, the ECU pulls the cables until the nominal tension is attained, determining the zero
position in the actuator stroke. This operation is absolutely essential after having removed
or replaced components of the EPB system or after performing the emergency release
procedure.
EPB function for cable running-in function (Cable Bedding)
If one or both the system cables are replaced, a running-in procedure must be performed
using the SD3 tester. This procedure, which repeatedly tensions the cables in 5 different
steps, allows the system to reach maximum operating efficiency, preventing residual
elastic effects during the operating phases.
EPB running-in function (Garage Braking)
This function enables a running-in procedure of the parking brake shoes, to be performed
after the rear brakes have been replaced.
Maserati Academy
128
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
EPB system failure
The electric parking brake failure information is sent to the instrument cluster via a signal
from the B-CAN line. In these conditions, the “EPB failure” warning light comes on (for all
markets except the USA where the BRAKE warning light is used) and at the same time a
“Parking brake failure” message is shown on the display. This specific message is
accompanied by an acoustic warning.
In case of a ABS/VDC system failure, also the EPB functioning will be disabled, this
because the EPB unit is controlled by the ABS/VDC unit.
EPB failure light
CAUTION!
EPB failure light
(US specifications)
when performing the emergency release procedure, a specific DTC will
be stored in the EPB unit, indicating the mechanical release of the EPB.
If afterwards the vehicle is driven and thus the EPB intents to operate,
another DTC will be stored indicating the non-calibrated status of the
EPB actuator.
In this case the EPB has to be mechanically released again, followed by
the calibration procedure with SD3. Afterwards DTCs have to be deleted.
Note: in particular conditions where the battery voltage is low, the electric parking brake
system may temporarily be deactivated. Therefore, typically upon starting the engine,
when the battery voltage is reduced, the message PARK OFF may be temporarily
displayed, indicating that automatic operation is momentarily disabled.
Maserati Academy
129
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
5. Driving Controls
1. Hydraulic steering pump
2. Steering rack
3. Cooling radiator
4. Hydraulic fluid reservoir
5. Steering angle sensor
The Quattroporte is fitted with rack and pinion steering system made by TRW. The
hydraulic power steering is vehicle speed sensitive. An electro-valve located on the
steering rack variates the degree of powering by controlling the hydraulic flow. This
electro-valve is controlled by the CSG unit (Centralina Servo Guida) and based on the
vehicle driving speed. By this way the steering feel and the neeeded steering force are
always in accordance with the driving conditions.
Specifications:
•
Colapsible, electrically adjustable steering column with easy entry function
•
Steering angle sensor located on steering column (for MSP)
•
Speed sensitive power steering
•
Belt drive hydraulic power steering pump
•
Hydraulic steering fluid radiator
•
Minimum steering diameter: 12,3 m
•
Steering rack ratio: 60 mm / revolution
•
Steering rack stroke: 200 mm
•
Hydraulic fluid:
Note: for MY07 and Quattroporte Automatic, a new steering rack was introduced with new
control valve with a larger number of internal grooves for greater driving accuracy and
enhanced filtering of road bumps.
Maserati Academy
130
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
6. Suspensions and Wheels
Front suspension
•
•
•
•
•
•
Articulated quadrilateral independent
wheel suspension with double
oscillating triangle
Anti-dive and anti-squat geometry
Forged aluminium levers, aluminium
hub carrier
25 mm ø articulated stabilizer bar on
ball joints
Aluminium hydraulic shock absorbers
with Skyhook variable damping
control
Suspension mounted on a separate
frame rigidly connected to the
bodywork
Rear suspension
•
•
•
•
•
•
Maserati Academy
Articulated
quadrilateral
rear
independent wheel suspension with
double oscillating triangle
Anti-dive and anti-squat geometry
Forged aluminium levers, aluminium
hub carrier
24 mm ø articulated stabilizer bar on
ball joints
Aluminium hydraulic shock absorbers
with Skyhook variable damping
control
Suspension mounted on a separate
frame rigidly connected to the
bodywork
131
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
With the introduction of MY07 and Quattroporte Automatic, a number of modifications
were adopted to improve the driving comfort and stability:
•
The upper levers of the front suspension have been modified in the connection area
to the chassis in order to house a larger bushing, using a softer and radially
asymmetrical rubber, so as to allow the wheel centre to move further backward in the
event of longitudinal impact (basically, the upper lever turns during opening on
longitudinal impact).
•
The fixing points of the rear toe-in control links has been slightly modified in order to
reduce toe-in variations caused by vertical wheel movements
Quattroporte Automatic:
On top of the modifications described above, the shock absorber calibrations for the
Quattroporte Automatic have been modified to enhance driving comfort and adopt to the
different weight distribution of the vehicle.
Maserati Academy
132
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Tyre pressure monitoring system (Optional)
The Quattroporte can be optionally fitted with a Tyre Pressure Monitoring System or
TPMS (standard for Sport GT and Sport GT S). The system consists of a TPMS control
module (NTP) located in the drivers side floor area which receives information related to
the tyre pressure and tyre temperature from 4 antennas located in the wheel arch areas.
The 4 antennas receive data sent by the sensors which are integrated in the wheel valves.
Each sensor has its own ID code, which is sent together with pressure and temperature
related data using radio waves. The NTP sends information related to the TPMS to the
instrument cluster (NQS) over the B-CAN line.
15-05-2002
Tyre
Pressure
TRIP button: push this button to
display the tyre pressure
information for 10 seconds.
2,2
bar
2,2
bar
2,2
bar
2,2
bar
SPORT
km
Information displayed :
-23°C
3
km [A]
000999 998.9
- System temporarily inactive (for example : external radio interference)
- System not calibrated (for example : a tyre has been replaced )
- System failure
- System not active (if it is disabled by the diagnostics system)
- Low pressure or puncture in front LH, front RH tyres or rear LH and RH tyres
- Low pressure or puncture in unidentified tyre
System Calibration
After replacing or inflating one or more tyres, the system must be calibrated. This
condition will be indicated on the information display by a message and the TPMS
indicator light. To calibrate the system, press and hold the calibration button, located near
the front ceiling light, for a time ranging between 4 and 10 seconds. The system takes a
maximum of 20 minutes to complete the calibration procedure with the vehicle in motion,
during which the message "Calibration started” will appear on the information display. If
the user recalls the information page showing the pressure levels of each tyre, dashes
“–.–” will be viewed in the place of the status.
Maserati Academy
133
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Skyhook suspension
The Maserati Quattroporte is equipped with Skyhook continuous varible damping control.
This system adapts the damping rate of the shock absorbers in function of the driving style
and the road conditions.
An ECU controls solenoid valves inside the shock absorbers based on the signals from
various sensors and informations received from other vehicle systems (received by CAN
line). Skyhook monitors in continuation the vertical acceleration of both the vehicle body
and the wheels by means of specific sensors.
By calculating the relative body/wheels speed, it modifies the damping force of each wheel
in terms of compression and extension to curb the absolute motion of the vehicle body in a
vertical direction, as if the body were hooked up to the sky with a shock absorber.
With respect to a conventional system, Skyhook offers superior damping comfort while
body roll and pitch angles during dynamic driving are reduced.
Notes:
•
The Skyhook damping setting is affected by the selected driving mode (Normal /
Sport). In Sport mode, the emphasis lies on the driving precision and the reduction of
body roll and pitch angles, while in Normal mode precedence is given to comfort.
•
The Skyhook control software for the Quattroporte Sport GT is specific, in order to
offer a more firm ride and higer driving accuracy.
•
The Skyhook control software for the Quattroporte Automatic is specific to meet the
changed weight distribution of the vehicle, in order to maintain a balanced setup.
•
Skyhook suspension is not available on the Maserati Quattroporte Sport GT S
Maserati Academy
134
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Skyhook system layout
1 Front shock absorbers
2 Rear shock absorbers
3 Electronic control unit (Sachs)
4 Front wheel acceleration sensors
5 Body vertical acceleration sensors
The Skyhook system is the result of a cooperation between Maserati and Sachs and
consists of the following components:
•
•
•
•
•
4 telescopic shock absorbers with integrated CDC (Continuous Damping Control)
valve
Electronic control unit (NCS – Nodo Controllo Sospensioni), located in the left hand
side floor area and connected to the C-CAN line
Two front wheel vertical acceleration sensors, mounted on the front hub carriers
Two front body vertical acceleration sensors, mounted on the body close to the front
suspension struts.
One rear body vertical acceleration sensor, mounted on the rear cross member.
Each shock absorber has an integrated solenoid valve which
is commanded by the Skyhook ECU (NCS). The value of the
current passing through the solenoid valves changes the
opening of a calibrated orifice through which the damping
fluid flows, thereby defining the damping factor and thus the
shock absorber setting.
Maserati Academy
135
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Vehicle geometry
Geometry
Front
Rear
Tyres
245/45 R18
285/40 R18
245/40ZR 19
285/35ZR 19
245/35 ZR20
285/30 ZR20
8.5 x 18” ET52
10.5 x 18” ET50.5
8.5”J x 19”
10.5”J x 19”
8,5" J x 20"
10,5" J x 20"
Camber
-0°30’ +/- 0°10’
-1°30’ +/- 0°10’
Toe-in
-2.0 +/- 0.4mm
+4.0 +/- 0.4mm
Caster
+3°48’ +/- 0°20’
Heigt
173+10/-5mm
159+10/-5mm
Track
1587mm
1569.6mm
weight
983 kg
1136 kg
Steering angle
Int. 34.0° / ext.40.8°
Rims
-
-
When adjusting the vehicle’s wheel alignment, follow the sequence as indicated below:
Ride height (front and rear)
Camber rear
Toe in rear
Caster front
Camber front
Toe in front
•
Caution
•
•
Maserati Academy
The vehicle’s geometry must be verified during “static load”
configuration, that is, with all the fluids on level tanks, the fuel tank
full (90 litres) and 75 kg on each front seats.
When verifying the vehicles geometry, it’s of most importance that
the tyres are at the correct pressure and all components related to
the wheel suspension are in good condition, without broken or
deformed parts.
See the workshop manual for more details and reference images.
136
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
7. Safety Components
The Maserati Quattroporte is equipped with two dual-stage front airbags, two side airbags
integrated in the front seats, two window bags and pretensioners for all 4 seatbelts.
The system is operated by a central ECU which calculates both the severity and the angle
of an impact on the basis of one internal deceleration sensor and six external crash zone
sensors.
1 Electronic control unit
2 Passenger airbag module
3 Key-operated cut-out switch
for front airbag on passenger side
(not for USA and Japan versions)
4 Passenger side pretensioner
5 Passenger sidebag module
6 Right-hand side impact satellite sensor
7 Passenger's windowbag module
8 Driver's windowbag module
9 Driver's sidebag module
10 Left-hand side impact satellite sensor
Maserati Academy
11 Driver's pretensioner
12 Airbag system malfunction indicator
13 passenger’s airbag deactivation
warning light
14 Driver's airbag module
15 Clock Spring
16 Diagnostics socket
17 Rear left-hand pretensioner
18 Rear right-hand pretensioner
19 Front Crash Zone Sensor (left)
20 Front Crash Zone Sensor (right)
137
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Airbag control unit
The airbag ECU (NAB – Nodo AirBag) manages the
entire system, monitoring all its components. It is
connected to the B-CAN line for diagnostics.
The ECU is fixed, rigidly, to the casing underneath the
vehicle's central console, near the vehicle’s centre of
gravity, this is necessary for the correct operation of
the integrated deceleration sensor.
Software is specific for USA versions with Advanced
Weight Sensing system.
To guarantee the correct system management the ECU has a number of safety devices:
•
Energy storage: the ECU can operate for a few fractions of a second even in the
event of a power failure or voltage drop.
•
Earth fastening check: The ECU checks the electric contact between the bodywork
and the ECU.
•
Fault memory: The ECU checks the circuit functions and all the system’s electric
parts, signalling the presence of faults by activating the “Airbag system fault”
warning light on the instrument panel and memorising the relative error code.
•
Crash memory: The ECU records information relating to impact situations which are
followed by the activation of the pretensioners and the front or side airbag modules.
System operation:
Front impact:
Comparison of the front sensors’ deceleration signal with the signal from the ECU’s
integrated sensor.
In accordance with the severity of the impact measured. If the passengers are not wearing
their seat belts, the airbags’ intervention threshold is altered, taking this into account.
N.B : The front airbags are dual stage airbags (they can be activated in two different
ways).
Side impact:
Comparison of the side sensors’ deceleration signal with the signal from the ECU’s
accelerometer. Depending on the severity of the impact measured and the direction of the
impact, the ECU controls the activation of the safety components on the side concerned.
Maserati Academy
138
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Driver’s front airbag module
The module is composed of:
• a plastic cover with a leather finish
• a woven nylon bag, with a volume of
approximately 60 litres
• a dual-stage hybrid gas generator
• an external housing
Operation:
depending on the intensity of the impact,
the ECU determines both the activation of
the first stage, and the delay before the
second is implemented, so optimizing the
bag inflation force.
Thanks to the permeability of its fabric, the
airbag is deflated in tenths of a second.
1 Fastening bracket
2 Cover
3 Folded bag
4 Gas generator
5 Warning plate
6 Connectors with safety lock
Clock spring
The clock spring has three cables on the steering wheel side, two of which are used to
connect the airbag module (first and second stage) and one for the connection to the
steering wheel's electrical functions (horn, radio controls).
1 Connector for first stage airbag (green)
2 Connector for second stage airbag (yellow)
3 Cable for steering wheel electrical functions
4 Light switch
5 Clock spring
Maserati Academy
139
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Passenger’s front airbag
The passenger’s side airbag module is
located inside a compartment in the
dashboard, just above the glove
compartment.
Operation:
depending on the intensity of the impact,
the ECU determines both the activation of
the first stage, and the delay before the
second is implemented, so optimizing the
bag inflation force.
Thanks to the permeability of its fabric,
the airbag is deflated in tenths of a
second.
1 Cover
2 Connection points
3 Gas generator
4 Folded bag
Passenger’s airbag deactivation switch (not for USA, Japan, Australia specs.)
A switch operated with the ignition key can be used to enable (ON) or disable (OFF) the
passenger's airbag module to allow the installing of a child seat
With the key in the OFF position, the ECU also controls the "passenger's airbag disabled"
warning light located on the instrument panel and the "passenger's airbag disabled"
warning light on the roof console.
The excessively bright warning lights is to ensure they are clearly visible to both the driver
and the passenger.
Maserati Academy
140
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Side airbag module
The side airbag modules are integrated in
the backrests of the front seats and are
composed of:
• a plastic housing
• a gas generator
• a permeable nylon bag with a volume of
approximately 12 litres
Operation:
In response to a signal produced by the
ECU, a pyrotechnic ignition charge is set
off which causes the expansion of the
gases contained in the generator, bringing
about the bag’s inflation.
After being inflated with the gases, the
airbag deflates in tenths of a second
thanks to the fabric's permeability.
1 External cover
2 Casing
3 Electrical connection point
4 Gas generator
5 Folded bag
6 Warning plate
Windowbag module
The windowbag module is designed to cover the vehicle’s complete side glass area and
thus offer protection to both front and rear occupants in case of a lateral impact. The
module consists of:
• gas generator
• a steel pipe with calibrated holes, which diffuses the gas evenly along its length
• a bag with a volume of approximately 21 litres, made of a permeable nylon fabric
• a plastic housing which covers and protects the bag, and forces its inflation direction
Note: the windowbag is always activated together with the side airbag.
1 Fastening mounts
2 Plastic bag container
3 Gas generator
4 Warning plate
5 Connector
Maserati Academy
141
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Seatbelt pretensioners
The front and rear side belt winders are fitted with pyrotechnic pretensioners operated by
the airbag ECU, with a load limiting device.
Operation:
In response to the signal generated by the ECU:
• The gas generators’ pyrotechnic charges (5) are set off.
• The pressure of the gas generates a force which pushes the rack piston (4) upwards.
• The seat belt is wound in by a few centimetres.
1 Gearwheel
2 Gearwheel
3 Toothed bushing
4 Rack piston
5 Pyrotechnic charge
6 Propellant
A Before activation
B After activation
Maserati Academy
1 Gas generator
2 Piston
3 Rack
4 Belt winder
5 Safety belt
6 Torsion bar
142
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
8. Electrical Systems and Devices
Electronic vehicle architecture
The electronic and electric functions of the various ECUs and nodes are controlled by the
F.L.ORE.N.C.E system. The use of this new system, designed for CAN communication,
has allowed Maserati to find immediate solutions as to communication, dimension, weight
and cost problems. Each electronic control unit is positioned in the barycentre with
respect to the functions it controls, so that the system is fully optimised. The Quattroporte
is the first Maserati model that employs the F.L.ORE.N.C.E. architecture.
The F.L.ORE.N.C.E. system is made up of two CAN communication networks:
•
C-CAN network: dynamic control and management of the vehicle (high speed);
•
B-CAN network: control of the standard bodywork functions (low speed).
The C-CAN and B-CAN networks are connected to each other by the body computer unit
which is equipped with both the interfaces and hence performs the network
GATEWAY function for transferring information.
The system also provides a number of serial lines used for diagnostics and other specific
functions:
•
K-line diagnostics for NCM / NFR / CSG / NCS / CAF
•
Serial line W for immobilizer recovery
•
A-BUS serial line for alarm, windscreen wiper and twilight sensor control.
Maserati Academy
143
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Overview of controlling modules
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.
17.
18.
CAF Headlights ECU
NCS Suspension control node
NCA Automatic gearbox node
NCM Engine control node
NFR Braking system node
NAS Steering angle node
NSP Parking sensors node
CSG Power steering ECU
NAB Airbag node
NVO Steering Wheel Node
NVB Luggage compartment node
NCL HVAC system node
NAG Driver's position node
NPG Driver's door node
NPP Passenger's door node
NIM Inside roof node
NQS Instrument panel node
CSP Rain/ twilight sensor ECU
Maserati Academy
19.
20.
21.
22.
23.
24.
25.
26.
E
G
CTC
CAV
CSA
NTV
DSP
NIT
NBC
NTP
Windscreen wiper ECU
Motion-sensing alarm ECU
Alarm system siren ECU
TV node
Hi-fi system amplifier
IT node
Body Computer Node
Tyre Pressure Node
Diversity amplifier
Fuse box
144
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
ECU self-learning
Every time the battery is disconnected, a self-learning cycle is required in order to allow
the correct operation of certain ECUs.
Motor-driven throttle:
Turn the ignition switch to the ON position (Key ON) and wait for at least 30 seconds.
Central door locking system:
Perform a lock/unlock operation with the remote control or the key.
NIT (IT Info Node):
Reset the correct time and date using the specific NIT service menu
Sunroof:
The following initialisation procedure must be carried out with sunroof closed and key ON:
•
Rotate the selector switch fully, to the maximum tilting position (the part of the
selector switch with three notches).
•
Press the selector switch and, keeping it pressed, wait for the sunroof to lock
mechanically.
•
Release the selector switch.
•
Within 5 seconds, press the selector switch again and keep it pressed.
•
After a few seconds the sunroof will begin an automatic cycle (continue to keep the
selector switch pressed).
•
At the end of the movement, the initialisation is complete.
•
Release the selector switch.
Maserati Academy
145
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Central door locking system
Locking/unlocking the vehicle using the key:
Key rotated anticlockwise in lock on DRIVER’s door (opening).
All 4 doors are unlocked (or driver’s door only if set with NIT); if the alarm is connected:
the red leds turn off for 4 seconds (after which they will start flashing again)
Key rotated clockwise in lock on passenger’s door:
All 4 doors are unlocked; if the alarm is connected: the red leds turn off for 4 seconds
(after which they will start flashing again)
N.B: When the vehicle is unlocked from the outside with the key, the alarm is not
disarmed. To disarm the alarm, simply insert the key in the ignition lock. The immobilizer
acknowledges the code automatically.
Luggage compartment opening button:
Long press: luggage compartment opens (when vehicle speed is below 4 km/h or when
the ignition switch is set to off
Inertial switch:
The intervention of the inertial switch results in the release of all the doors and the
luggage compartment, and the internal ceiling light and the four direction indicators
switching on. It is located beneath the front seat on the driver’s side.
Vehicle speed over 20 Km/h:
When the vehicle speed exceeds 20 Km/h the doors are locked if this function has been
previously set in the IT Info Node (NIT) user menu
Luggage compartment closing:
To close the luggage compartment, simply rest it on the lock.
Vehicle closing with flat or disconnected battery:
The 2 front doors must be closed with the key and the 2 rear doors with the small lever
hidden beneath the weather strip, near the lock.
Vehicle setup:
From the NIT user menu, the driver can decide whether tounlock all the doors or just the
door on the driver’s side.
Using the relevant menu, the driver can select whether the opening/closing of the luggage
compartment should be linked to the central door locking or it should be independent.
Maserati Academy
146
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Locking/unlocking the vehicle using the remote control:
Door lock button:
Single press: If the alarm system fails, the siren will emit a long beep and the red LEDs
will start flashing quickly. If one of the doors has not been closed correctly , the doors do
NOT lock and the alarm system is NOT activated, the direction indicators and the red
LEDs flash nine times (three seconds).
Long press : closing of all 4 windows and sunroof (if fitted).
Stop long press : closing of 4 windows and sunroof is interrupted
Door unlock button.
Double press: Unlocks all the doors (if enabled by the NIT, driver’s door only is unlocked),
low beams switch on for 30 seconds
Long press : all four windows open and sunroof (if fitted).
Stop long press : opening of the 4 windows and sunroof is interrupted
Antitheft alarm system
Activation:
The direction indicators will light up, and the alarm siren will emit a synchronised beep. At
this point, a red LED starts flashing intermittently to indicate the monitoring status.
Deactivation:
The direction indicators will double flash , the alarm siren will emit a double beep.
Note: the alarm system is also deactivated by inserting a key with an ID code which is
acknowledged by the immobilizer.
Motion-sensing alarm and anti-inclination alarm:
When the alarm system is disarmed, the motion-sensing and anti-inclination alarm can be
switched off using the specific buttons on the front ceiling lamp.
Luggage compartment opening:
The luggage compartment can be opened with the alarm armed; in this case, the
motionsensors and inclination sensors are temporarily deactivated. If the luggage
compartment is then closed, the sensors are reactivated.
Power windows
All the doors have a finger-trap prevention device for the power windows
If an obstacle is detected, the window’s stroke is interrupted then reversed until it is fully
lowered.
In case the finger-trap prevention device should fail, the automatic upwards movement is
inhibited and the window can only move with a jogging motion. If the protective device
should fail, this is signalled on the instrument panel.
Maserati Academy
147
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Internal lights
Day/night condition
This is determined by:
- the light switch
-“night condition” detected by the vehicle’s twilight sensor.
-Therefore the activation of the position lights does not necessarily determine the
activation of the internal lights.
Timing
3 minutes: Step lights under the door, and front and rear central ceiling lamps.
15 minutes: Glove compartment light, diver’s glove compartment light, sun visors' light,
spotlight, front and rear central ceiling lamps if activated with the local control or by the
inertia switch.
20 minutes: Luggage compartment light.
External lights
Lights managed by the twilight sensor (AUTO mode):
The external lights are activated automatically by the twilight sensor. From the NIT user
menu, the driver can set the twilight sensor’s sensing level (3 levels).
’Follow me home’:
Control enabling the position lights and low beams to switch on automatically for a timed
period immediately after the vehicle is switched off (Key-OFF).
Activation: After Key-OFF, the flash lights control on the steering column stalk must be
pressed. The instrument panel activates the ‘follow-me-home’ signal and displays the time
(in seconds) during which the lights will remain switched on. (Signal active for 20 sec.)
Activation time increase: when the function is active, every time the flash lights control is
pressed, the time the lights remain switched on is increased by a further 30 seconds (max.
210 sec.)
Deactivation: keep the flash lights control activated for over 2 seconds, then switch the
ignition key from OFF to ON.
Maserati Academy
148
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Front seats
Seat controls:
1.
2.
3.
4.
Adaptive (only on seat base)
Massage ON/OFF
Seat base shifting/tilting
Memories
5.
6.
7.
8.
Seatback angles/height
Ventilation
Heater
Lumbar support adjustment
Memorisation:
With the three buttons (4) the user can store three different combinations of the following
positions:
• Seat position
• Steering column position
• External rear view mirror position
The position combination is stored by pressing one of the three buttons for over 3
seconds.
To confirm a successful memorisation, the ECU sends the message via the CAN network
to make the confirmation buzzer sound.
Heating:
The seats are designed with a
heating pad stitched onto the lining
of the seat back and the cushion’s
central sections.
Maserati Academy
149
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Ventilation:
The seats are built with a "forced" ventilation system with three levels of speed, operated
by two brushless fans, controlled by an ECU.
A.
1.
Ventilated areas
Axial fans 80 x 80 mm
4- way lumbar support adjustment:
The front seats are standard equipped with electropneumatic lumbar support adjustment.
The adjustment at point X is carried out by inflating
the lower bag (1) (the larger one). The adjustment at
point Z is carried out by inflating the upper bag (2)
(the smaller one)
The two bags, which partially overlap, are located
between the padding and the support membrane.
Electro-pneumatic system:
An optional electro pneumatic adjustment system is
available for the front seats. This system is
composed of six inflatable plastic bags, an air
compressor and an ECU with integrated solenoid
valves.
This system operates the 4-way lumbar support
adjustment, self-adaptive and massage functions.
The self-adaptive function, ensures the seat provides its occupant with the optimum
support regardless of the person’s shape and size.
Action: all bags are inflated to maximum pressure; subsequent and sequential deflation
until the same pressure is obtained throughout the complete system. This cycle is
repeated every 4 minutes.
This function is activated by pressing the corresponding button and it is switched off by
pressing the same button again.
1.
2.
Three partially overlapped bags located between the padding and the support
membrane
Seat base side bags are located inside the padding.
Maserati Academy
150
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Massage system:
The massage function inflates and deflates the following bags in sequence:
Thigh / lower lumbar / central lumbar / upper lumbar / thigh
The repetition interval lasts approximately a minute and depends on:
• whether the maximum pressure is reached
• the time the pressure is kept constant.
The massage cycle lasts five minutes in total, after which the function cuts out and the
previous settings are restored.
Rear seats
The rear seats are fitted with seatbacks engineered to guarantee the occupants the
maximum safety in the event of a collision.
Headrest: two side rests with adjustable heights and tilting movement, and one central
rest, which can be power tilted and then reset manually by the driver.
Armrest: can be folded-down and opened. Inside its compartment one will find:
- 12V socket,
- front passenger seat sliding control (on all versions),
- control switches for heating (Winter Pack and Comfort version) and for lumbar support
adjustment, massage and ventilation (for Comfort version).
Maserati Academy
151
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Parking sensors
The vehicle has two possible types of equipment for assisted parking:
rear parking sensors only or front and rear parking sensors.
N.B: The typology of the ECU supplied changes depending on the vehicle equipment
The driver is alerted about the presence/distance of the obstacle by means of warning
signals from:
- a rear buzzer - for vehicles equipped with rear parking sensors;
- two buzzers, one at the front and one at the rear - for vehicles equipped with front and
rear parking sensors
The frequency of the beeps also depends on how far away the obstacle is.
1.
2.
Front buzzer position
Rear buzzer position
The front sensors (when fitted) are
activated/deactivated with the specific
button on the control plate on the lefthand side of the steering column.
Ultrasonis sensors:
The sensor is an ultrasound transducer, which acts as a smart transmitter and receiver of
ultrasound pulse packages. The pulses emitted are reflected off any obstacles there may
be; so the transducer receives an echo which is amplified and converted into a digital
signal, then sent to the ECU. Each sensor can also operate as a receiver only, so that it
can perform a triangular measurement between two sensors. This technique provides a
better detection of small obstacles and in situations where reflection is critical.
Maserati Academy
152
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
The front sensors are activated under the following conditions:
- key ON,
- vehicle speed below 15 km/h,
- deactivation button in OFF position.
The rear sensors are activated in the following condition:
- key ON,
- reverse gear engaged.
The front or rear buzzers start to beep as soon as an obstacle is detected and continue to
beep with increasing frequency as the vehicle nears the obstacle.
Operating principle:
•
The Electronic Control Unit controls the sensors (10 measuring processes per
second).
•
The signal, reflected off any obstacles, is intercepted by the sensor and sent to the
ECU in digital form.
•
The ECU compares the signal emitted with the one received and calculates, the
time that elapses between the emission of the signal and the reception of the echo
(transit time).
•
This information is translated into distance and passed on to the driver in the form
of beeps. The measurement accuracy is ±1 cm. A comparison with the previous
measurements allows the system to establish whether the obstacle is getting
nearer or further.
Note : a continuous beep indicates the obstacle is less than 30 cm away.
Recovery strategies:
•
The system must be capable of automatically identifying any failures occurring during
operation.
•
Error which does not jeopardise the overall system operation: the system continues
to operate.
•
Error which jeopardises operation or performance reliability: the system cuts out
automatically and sends out an error message, indicated on the instrument panel
(both visually and audibly)
Maserati Academy
153
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Heating, ventilation and air conditioning (HVAC)
the air conditioning and heating system allows the user to adjust the temperature and
humidity within the passenger compartment. Its main components are:
1. Compressor
2. Condenser.
3. Dehydrator filter.
4. 4-level pressure gauge.
5. Expansion valve
6. Distribution unit (made up of):
Electric fan
Evaporator
Anti-pollen filter
Heater radiator
The refrigerant used is R134a.
The system is filled with 1100 ± 25 g fluid
The oil used is Ucon RL897 Oil
The system is filled with: 150 ± 10 cc oil
Description of components:
Compressor:
The variable piston compressor (1) makes it
possible to change the coolant flow to the
evaporator gradually. It is driven directly by the
crankshaft by means of a Poly-v belt (2) and
activated by an electro-magnetic clutch.
Dehydrator / filter:
The dehydrator / filter is connected to the
condenser outlet and to the evaporator inlet. It
performs the following functions: it filters any
impurities in the coolant (which contains oil
particles from the compressor), it separates the
fluid to eliminate any humidity, it works as a
reservoir for the coolant.
Maserati Academy
154
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Multi level pressure sensor (4 levels):
This sensor controls the system operation, it
controls the compressor and cooling fan
activation/deactivation:
1st level (approx. 2,5 bar): minimum pressure
enabling the compressor activation;
2nd level (approx. 15 bar): pressure requiring the
activation of the electric fan’s first speed;
3rd level (approx. 20 bar): pressure requiring the
activation of the electric fan’s second speed;
4th level (approx. 27° bar): max. pressure
deactivating the compressor.
Expansion valve:
This valve regulates the flow and expansion of fluid
R134a at the evaporator’s inlet. Inside the valve,
the coolant is subject to a sudden and sharp
pressure and temperature drop
Front air distribution unit:
This is the housing within which, the external (or recirculation air) is conditioned/heated
and distributed to the vents selected by the user. This unit contains:
Air flaps
Evaporator: this is a heat exchanger housed inside the air distribution unit. It is used to
take off heat and humidity from the air conveyed to the passenger compartment. This is
obtained by means the change in the coolant status – from liquid to gaseous – which
takes place inside it.
Heater radiator: this is a heat exchanger connected to the engine cooling circuit by means
of two lines: one line sucks warm water from the engine, the other returns the coolant to
the engine. The heater is used to provide the heat required to warm up the air conveyed to
the passenger compartment.
Flap actuators.
Air temperature sensors.
Anti-pollen filter: this is a combined air filter for the passenger compartment: particle +
active carbon filter. It is used to filter the air entering the passenger compartment. The
first filter layer (particle) prevents pollen and polluting particles from entering the
passenger compartment; the second layer (active carbons) reduces nasty smells due to
the humidity on the filter surface)
Electric fan: this is operated by a brushless electric motor, 12 V power supply, and can be
controlled at different speeds by a signal coming from the NCL (HVAC control module). It
is housed inside the air conditioning/heating unit, next to the evaporator
Maserati Academy
155
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Air pollution sensor:
When the air pollution level exceeds the preset
harmfulness thresholds, the recirculation flap closes the
external air inlet and the NCL (HVAC control module)
activates the recirculation of inside air. When the air
pollution level goes back to acceptable preset values, the
flap opens the external air inlet once again and the NCL
deactivates the recirculation of inside air. This sensor is
fitted in the external air inlet on the air distribution unit on
the first generation models. From MY06 onwards, the
location of this sensor has moved to the radiator housing.
The demisting sensor:
When the windscreen misting level exceeds the preset thresholds, the recirculation flap
opens the external air inlet cutting-out the AQS sensor signal. When the windscreen
misting level goes back to acceptable preset values, the recirculation flap will get to the
status requested by the system. It is fitted on the internal rear view mirror
Sun radiation sensor:
The sun sensor is used to measure the thermal energy generated by the sun radiation. It
is positioned on the dashboard, next to the windscreen. This is a DUAL ZONE type
sensor, to optimize the control of the dual air conditioning / heating system temperature.
External air temperature sensor:
This is a NTC sensor fitted inside the external rear view mirror, driver’s side. Its operating
range is -40°C / 80°C.
Maserati Academy
156
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Treated air temperature sensors:
These sensors (1) are used to read the temperature
of the air treated by the air conditioning/heating
system before it is conveyed to the passenger
compartment. The two treated air temperature
sensors are positioned next to the central vents.
Passenger compartment temperature sensor:
These sensors (1) are used to read the actual
temperature inside the passenger compartment. This
sensor is equipped with a tiny electric fan, fitted inside
it. This fan is constantly powered, so that the
temperature reading is not affected by any stationary
air inside the dashboard.
Air mixing flap actuators
The treated air temperature is adjusted using the
temperature setting buttons (1 and 2).
Air distribution actuators
The actuator moves the distribution flaps into the 5
possible positions. Main positions: DEF, VENT,
FLOOR. Combined positions: BILEVEL, HEAT
Recirculation actuator
The recirculation actuator controls the flap rotation in
the two threshold positions (dynamic air and air
recirculation) without intermediate positions.
Note: For MY06 (assembly
number 21926 onwards), the
software of the NCL module
has been modified to improve
performance.
Maserati Academy
The HVAC control module (NCL):
This module is positioned on the right of the front
passenger’s foot area, is fitted on the air
conditioning/heating unit. It is connected to the low
speed
B-CAN network. The NCL receives the
following information from the Body Computer (NBC)
node, via CAN network:
- Outside air temperature
- Engine water temperature
- Engine Rpm
- Vehicle speed (tachometer signal)
- Battery voltage (battery charge status)
- Heated rear window activation
- Compressor status
- Vehicle light status.
157
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
Modifications for MY07 and Quattroporte Automatic:
With the introduction of the Quattroporte Automatic and MY07 (from assemby number
27860 onwards), a number of important modifications were made to the HVAC system in
order to improve its performance.
The amount of refrigerant gas and lubrication fluid has been changed due to a modified
dehydrator / filter:
•
•
Coolant: R134a PAG RL – 897, the system of this vehicle is filled with 1050 ± 20 g
of coolant.
Lubricant: the oil used is Ucon RL897 system is filled with: 200 ml ± 10 ml of fluid.
Also various parts of the front air distribution unit have been redesigned or modified. The
heating radiator is new, as well as the anti-pollen filter. The ventilation motor is new and is
now more powerfull while it is at the same time less noisy. The NCL unit has new
software.
The air conditioning/heating system of the
Quattroporte Automatic and MY07 provides
enhanced air flow obtained with new and
suitably dimensioned air lines.
Thanks to these modifications, the overall
performance of the ventilation system has
increased by 50% (370 m³/h instead of 240
m³/h previously).
Maserati Academy
158
Introduction to Maserati
Quattroporte
9. Body
The Quattroporte uses a steel sheet monococque body structure in combination with two
auxiliary steel frames to support the powertrain and wheel suspensions.
The quattroporte’s floorplan has been modified with the introductiion of MY07 and
Quattroporte Automatic to house the new automatic transmission. Attaching points were
added for the transmission support and the central supporting bearing of the propellor
shaft while the transmission tunnel was enlarged to house the gearbox.
Central tunnel area
modified to support the
gearbox and propeller
shaft
Maserati Academy
159
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati Quattroporte MY09
Maserati Quattroporte MY09 (M139)
Technical Introduction
0.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
General Information
Engine
Clutch
Transmission
Braking System
Driving Controls
Suspensions and Wheels
Safety Components
Electrical Systems and Devices
Body
Maserati Academy
161
165
167
168
168
169
169
172
160
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati Quattroporte MY09
0. General Information
The Quattroporte – the car which created the “Sport Luxury Sedan” category – can be
considered as a true masterpiece of Maserati. After five years and more than 15.000 sold
units, Maserati has decided to reinterpret the Quattroporte and bring it to a new level.
For the MY09 version, Maserati’s flagship saloon car underwent an important
technological and stylistic upgrade.
Pininfarina has further improved the Quattroporte’s elegant body design by giving it a more
modern look and enhancing the GranTurismo family feel.
Stilistic modifications include: new front bumper with a new grill, new headlight units, new
tail lights, new rear bumper, new wheel design, new rear view mirrors and redesigned side
sills.
Internally, the MY09 Quattroporte is fitted with a complete new infotainment system with
extensive listening options and also new interior trim combinations are available.
Under the bonnet, the classic 4.2L V8 engine is now joined by a more powerful 4.7L
version, always linked to an automatic 6-speed transmission.
The new Quattroporte range offers three variants:
•
The Quattroporte is the Maserati luxury saloon in its purest form. Fitted with the
4.2L wet sump engine and focus on smoothness and driving comfort.
•
The Quattroporte S is the flagship of the Quattroporte range. Fitted with a 4.7L
engine and improved chassis dynamics to match the higher engine power.
Luxury reaches new heights with the Quattroporte S.
•
The Quattroporte Sport GT S (added in January 2009) is the most exciting
combination of a luxury sedan and a performance sports car that Maserati has
ever produced. Modifications to chassis, gearbox and exhaust system ensure
maximum handling and performance to further heighten the driving pleasure.
Maserati Academy
161
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati Quattroporte MY09
Quattroporte:
New "Quattroporte “ 4.2
• Current 4.2 V8 400 hp, 460 Nm torque
• Single damping suspension rate with
focus on comfort
• Skyhook suspension available as
optional
• 18” wheels with new wheel design
• 330 mm brake discs with 4-piston
calipers
• Acceleration 0-100 km/h in 5,6 s
• 0-1000 m with standing start in 25,2 s
• Max speed of 270 km/h
Maserati Academy
162
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati Quattroporte MY09
Quattroporte S:
New "Quattroporte S“ 4.7
• New 4.7L V8 430 hp, 490 Nm
torque
• Skyhook suspension comes as
standard for the best set-up
between comfort and handling
• V-Style 19” wheels
• Chromed front grill with convex
vertical fins
• 360 mm dual cast brake discs with
6-piston calipers
• Acceleration 0-100 km/h in 5.4 s
• 0-1000 m with standing start in
24,7 s
• Max speed of 280 km/h
Maserati Academy
163
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati Quattroporte MY09
Quattroporte Sport GT S:
Esthetical features for QP Sport GT S
•
Black front grill with concave vertical fins
•
Red accent in trident logos
•
Black instead of chromed headlight
surround
•
Standard red brake calipers
•
“Black line” window trim
•
Door handles painted in body colour
•
Oval exhaust tail pipes in black finishing
•
Carbon fibre interior finishing
•
Specific seat and door panel upholstery
with alcantara
•
Chrome line for window trims, door
handles and exhaust pipes available on
request
New "Quattroporte Sport GT S“
• New 4.7 V8 440 hp, 490 Nm torque
• Sport exhaust System
• Single-rate sport setting dampers and
stiffer springs (+25% rate increase)
• Specific gearbox calibration
• 20” Multi Trident wheels with specific
design
• 7-spoke 20” wheels available on request
• 360 mm dual cast brake discs with 6-piston
calipers
• Longer gearshift paddles behind steering
wheel to allow easy gear shifting during
cornering
• Acceleration 0-100 km/h in 5,1 s
• 0-1000 m with standing start in 24,1 s
• Max speed of 285 Km/h
Maserati Academy
164
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati Quattroporte MY09
1. Engine
The new generation Quattroporte is exclusively available with the new generation of wet
sump V8 engines (F136UC for Quattroporte, F136YG for Quattroporte S and F136YH for
Quattroporte Sport GT S).
Bosch Motronic ME9
The Quattroporte models fitted with the new 4.7L engine introduce the new generation
Bosch Motronic ME 9.1.1 engine control system.
Basic operating principles remain unchanged with respect to the previous generation
Motronic ME7 system. A number of engine control related components have changed, but
their operating principle remains unchanged. The most important difference concerns the
engine control unit.
The Motronic ME9 ECU is located in the
engine compartment behind the left
hand side wheel arch.
A shield is applied to protect the ECU
from heat and possible brake fluid loss
The most important modifications with respect to the ME7 system are the following:
•
New, larger cast aluminium ECU housing with new connectors (94 pin vehicle side
connector + 60 pin engine side connector) and new pin-out.
•
New location of the ECU in the engine compartment to reduce wiring length.
•
Increased calculating capacity of the ECU thanks to new, more powerful processor
(GreenOak MPC564 64-bit, 56Mhz main processor)
•
Eliminating of the K-line for diagnostics. All communication for diagnostics and
programming passes through the C-CAN line in compliance with the new ISO 15765-4
standard.
•
Immobilizer function is managed by the engine ECU and body computer through the
C-CAN line only. The W-line for back up is eliminated.
•
New hydraulic VVT actuators with a variation range increased to 60 degrees. The aim
is obtaining a more smooth idling and better low-end torque for application in the new
Quattroporte with 4.7L engine. The operating principle remains unchanged with
respect to the actual 50-degree actuators.
Maserati Academy
165
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati Quattroporte MY09
More open intake and exhaust system for Quattroporte Sport GT S
The power increase of 10 hp of the Quattroporte Sport GT S with respect to the
Quattroporte S is achieved by modifications to the air intake system and to the exhaust
system, combined with a specific engine mapping.
The absence of a strainer for the mass air
flow meter allows a more free air flow into the
engine. This modification requires a specific
calibration of the engine control system (in
analogy with the GranTurismo S model).
In analogy with the GranTurismo S model, the Quattroporte Sport GT S is equipped with a
sport exhaust system with bypass valves for the rear silencers. The opening/closing of the
valves is linked to the Sport/Normal mode selection.
“Normal” mode – valves closed
In “Normal” mode special exhaust valves are
closed, forcing the exhaust to follow a longer
path.
A longer exhaust path means the exhaust will
lose energy and as a consequence the engine
sound is not as pronounced.
“Normal” mode is designed to ensure comfort
on board but also limits top engine
performance.
“Sport” mode – valves opened
In “Sport” mode, the exhaust flaps are opened
allowing the exhaust to follow a shorter, quicker
path.
A shorter path increases the exhaust flow,
allowing the engine to develop its maximum
power (440 hp).
The “Sport” mode has to be selected in order to
extract the maximum, overall performance.
Maserati Academy
166
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati Quattroporte MY09
3. Transmission
The Quattroporte MY09 model is available with automatic transmission only.
Main ZF 6HP26 improvements
The new, more aggressive torque supply of the 4.7L engine is coupled with transmission
management software that has been tailored to optimize the acceleration and shifting
sensation of the Automatic transmission.
The driving experience is characterized by:
•
Optimum off-the-line acceleration, with
ideal alignment of the increased torque
•
New shifting feel between 4th and 5th
gears: maximum power available to
highest rpms, (7600)
Specific gear shifting software for the Quattroporte Sport
GT S with new features designed to heighten the “fun to
drive” quotient:
“MANUAL MODE”: gear holding
•
In manual mode, gear shifting is directly controlled by the
driver, allowing the engine to reach the rev limiter.
•
Finding the optimum gear point is facilitated by the car’s
“Tachometer”, a carry-over from the GranTurismo S; the
paddle shifters (Active Shifting, std) with ergonomic
“Trofeo” shape (also carry-over GranTurismo S) always
ensures optimal gear changes, especially on twisty
roads.
“AUTO SPORT” mode : “Fast Start” strategy for max perfomance
•
In order to optimize standing starts, the automatic transmission offers a new
performance edge called “fast start” that is easy for the driver to control and
repeatable with no limits (pls see Owner’s Manual for instructions – not ideal for
street use as MSP must be turned off). This strategy enables a reduction in the 0 to
100 km/h time from 5.4 seconds to 5.1 seconds.
“MANUAL SPORT”/”AUTO SPORT”: Downshifting with throttle “blips”
•
Throttle “blipping” while downshifting enables the engine revs to match the proper
gear and, in the case of the Sport GT S, creates the right exhaust note ensuring
driving pleasure. In “SPORT” mode the shifting quality offers a sporty feel with higher
gear shift speeds.
Maserati Academy
167
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati Quattroporte MY09
4. Braking System
The Quattroporte models fitted with the 4.7L engine
(S and Sport GT S) are equipped with the enhanced
braking system as used on the GranTurismo S. This
system features 360 mm front brake discs with dual
cast technology and 6-piston brake calipers.
The brake calipers have standard grey finishing on
the Quattroporte S and red finishing on the
Quattroporte Sport GT S
All Quattroporte models are equipped the MSP
system featuring ABS, ASR, ESP, EBD, MSR and
Hill Holder function (Bosch ESP 8.0)
6. Suspensions and Wheels
Wheels and tyres
A number of new wheel designs have been introduced with the introduction of the MY09
version of the Quattroporte. The dimensions of wheels and tyres depends on the model
version:
Version
Wheels
Tyres
Quattroporte
Front: 8,5J x 18
245/45 ZR 18
Rear: 10,5J x 18
285/40 ZR 18
Front: 8,5J x 19
245/40 ZR 19
Rear: 10,5J x 19
285/35 ZR 19
Front: 8,5J x 20
245/35 ZR 20
Rear: 10,5J x 20
295/30 ZR 20
Quattroporte S
Quattroporte Sport GT S
Note: 19” wheels and 20” wheels are available as optional for the Quattroporte. 20”
wheels are available as optional for the Quattroporte S.
Maserati Academy
168
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati Quattroporte MY09
Suspensions
The New Quattroporte range builds upon experience gained over the years with regard to
suspension and braking improvements, focused on different driving needs and vehicle
requirements.
•
•
•
The New "Quattroporte“ 4.2L has a comfortable, single damping suspension set-up
developed to focus on smooth ride. The result is a more comfortable ride while still
offering solid and poised driving behavior.
Skyhook is optional for the Quattroporte 4.2L
The New "Quattroporte S" 4.7L features an improved Skyhook Suspension system
with new damper settings and consequently improved handling / balance. Moreover,
the adoption of a new piston valve optimizes the frequency response.
Quattroporte Sport GT S
The Quattroporte Sport GT S features a sporty, single-rate damping suspension system
(Skyhook available as option) designed to further complement the already ideal weight
distribution and balance of the Quattroporte S.
The new suspension set-up reduces ground clearance accordingly: at the front, the fender
gap has been reduced by 10 mm and at the rear by 25 mm additionally, the spring
stiffness has been increased by 25%.
All these changes ensure:
•
Body roll reduction.
•
Lateral “G” force enhancement.
These improvements result in the following customer benefits:
•
The Quattroporte Sport GT S conveys a higher sensation of agility from corner to
corner (higher cornering speed) and greater feedback (road feel).
•
Traction coming out of corners is more stable thanks to reduced weight transfer.
•
Increased stability thanks to stiffer springs.
Maserati Academy
169
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati Quattroporte MY09
7. Safety Components
The MY09 version of the Quattroporte uses a new type of front passenger airbag. This
new type airbag is of the “intelligent-LRD” type.
The passenger Low Risk Deployment bag represents an important evolution step for the
occupant protection. With this feature the bag is able to provide the highest safety for front
occupants of different age and size, from one year old kids placed in rear facing child
seats to adults in all conditions of frontal collisions.
The airbag is designed with some elements that permit to adapt well to all possible
conditions: additional vent holes allow a reduction of pressure when the bag hits an
obstacle close to the dashboard, the lower shape is designed to adapt to the children head
when placed on cradles. The shape of side panels is able to restraint the shoulder,
reducing pressure on head and chest.
The airbag has been re-designed completely for volume, shape, features and folding in
order to fulfil the most strict occupant protection regulations without the need of the
complex Advanced Weight Sensing system (AWS) (for the markets where this system
was used). Further, the new type of airbag offers improved aesthetics.
Note: the other components of the restraint system did not undergo modifications.
8. Electrical Systems and Devices
New headlight features:
New tail light features:
•
•
•
•
•
•
17 led direction indicators
•
12 led stop function
•
2 led position light
•
2 led rear fog lamp
•
1 led integrated side marker
•
Reverse lamp
•
•
•
Bi-Xenon technology
Additional driving beam (Flash to Pass)
Position light – DRL function
10 led direction indicator
Integrated sidemarkers (family look with
GranTurismo)
Headlight washing system
Automatic level control
Auto adaptive headlight system for
cornering (up to a maximum angle of
15°) in analogy with the GranTurismo
model
Maserati Academy
170
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati Quattroporte MY09
New infotainment system (NIT)
The new Quattroporte features a new Multi
Media System with extensive listening
options, which is available in two variants:
Maserati-Marelli multi media system:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
RDS tuner
Satellite navigation system
CD/CD-rom drive, MP3 compatible
30GB Hard disk Drive for MP3 music files and juke box function
Bluetooth wireless technology
USB / Aux input
Voice control
Steering wheel controls
Bose multi media system, which additionally offers:
•
•
•
•
•
DVD player
Compatibility for reading files with the extension wav, wma, acc
User interaction with UMusic virtual DJ and Music Library
I-pod connection on request
TV tuner on request
User interface Marelli
Maserati Academy
User interface Bose
171
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati Quattroporte MY09
9. Body
Quattroporte MY09 Body Enhancements:
New headlights with LED
technology, DRL function
and embedded sidemarkers,
Carry-over GT mirrors
(no courtesy light)
New taillights with LED
technology and
embedded sidemarkers
New front grill with
vertical bars
New front bumper
Maserati Academy
new alloy wheels
New
sideskirts
New rear bumper
172
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo
Maserati GranTurismo (M145)
Technical Introduction
0.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
General Information
Engine
Clutch
Transmission
Braking System
Driving Controls
Suspensions and Wheels
Safety Components
Electrical Systems and Devices
Body
Maserati Academy
174
178
182
192
195
196
201
203
219
173
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo
0. General Information
The new Maserati GranTurismo, introduced at the Geneva motor show in March 2007, is a
technical spin-off of the Quattroporte Automatic and reflects its power, stability and comfort
features.
Its authentic and unmistakably Maserati style transmits an image of power and elegance.
Pininfarina has tailor-made the sleek and sensual bodywork, developed around the
GranTurismo project idea: create a sports car yet with plenty of space to suit one and all.
From the large oval mouth that envelops the radiator grille right through to the rear, the
bodywork sits on the mechanics like a tight-fitting dress on sinuous hips. The resulting
powerful, trim and elegant shape arouses an emotion that only a timeless design can give.
The elegant design of the interior, made warm and cosy by the quality materials and
handmade finishes, embraces the passengers in a bright, comfortable and sporty
atmosphere.
The new Maserati GranTurismo springs from the experience gained with the Quattroporte
in the luxury car sector, and provides a unique implementation of those concepts that have
made the model an unchallenged international success.
The new Maserati GranTurismo has the following features in common with the
Quattroporte:
•
the mechanical configuration designed to provide an emotional driving
experience
•
meticulous care in the choice of materials and equipment, aimed at creating a
sophisticated and comfortable ambience.
•
a complete range of customisation options so that the customers can express
their own personality and satisfy their needs.
Maserati Academy
174
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo
Dimensions, capacities and weights
Length:
Width:
Width:
Height:
Wheelbase:
Front track:
Rear track:
4,881 mm
1,847 mm
2,056 mm
1,353 mm
2,942 mm
1,586 mm
1,590 mm
Dry weight (UE version):
Unladen weight (UE version):
Kerb weight with driver (UE version):
Maximum permitted weight:
Technically permitted weight:
Kerb weight distribution:
Maserati Academy
Front overhang:
Rear overhang:
Luggage compartment
capacity:
Fuel tank capacity:
873 mm
1,066 mm
260 l
86 l
1,780 kg
1,880 kg
1,955 kg
2,180 kg
2,250 kg
49% Front; 51% Rear
175
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo
Vehicle performances
51 %
49 %
Top speed:
Acceleration from 0 to 100 km/h:
Acceleration from 0 to 400 metres:
Acceleration from 0 to 1000 metres:
Pickup from 80 to 120 km/h:
Stopping distance from 100 km/h to 0:
285 km/h (at 7050 RPM in 5° gear)
5.2 s
13.4 s
23.9 s (output speed 225 km/h)
3.7 s
35 m
Weight distribution is one of the key reasons behind the stability and balance of the
vehicle, which also enhances the safety features perceived while driving. The
configuration designed for the GranTurismo was obtained by moving the engine assembly
to behind the front axle which, in everyday driving, translates into smooth and predictable
vehicle behaviour. This not only enhances comfort and handling but also maximises
traction during acceleration and road holding.
With respect to the Quattroporte Automatic, overall vehicle performances have been
improved, while fuel consumption has decreased (3%), notwithstanding the mechanical
base is identical. This is thanks to the lower vehicle weight, improved aerodynamic
efficiency (Cx: 0.33), specific software for engine and gearbox control, and a slightly
shorter final drive ratio of the differential.
Fuel consumption and emissions (2004/3/EC directive)
City cycle:
21.58 (l/100 km)
Motorway cycle:
10.02 (l/100 km)
Average fuel consumption:
14.31 (l/100 km)
CO² emissions (average):
335.0 (g/km)
Scheduled maintenance
The scheduled maintenance program for the Maserati GranTurismo is identical to the one
for the Maserati Quattroporte Automatic.
Maserati Academy
176
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo
Towing the vehicle
If you need to tow the vehicle, observe the following recommendations:
if possible, have the vehicle transported on a vehicle equipped with loading platform and
specific for roadside assistance and recovery.
If this is not possible:
tow the vehicle lifting the driving wheels (the rear ones). If this is not possible:
tow the vehicle for a distance of less than 100 km at a speed below 60 km/h. Tow the
vehicle using the towing hook found in the toolkit. Screw the towing hook down tightly in
its seat, on the lower, right-hand side of the front bumper.
In addition, for towing you must engage Neutral by moving the gearshift lever to position
N. Do not extract the key, as the steering wheel will lock automatically and you will be
unable to steer the wheels. WARNING: If you have to tow the vehicle with 2 wheels
raised, ensure that the ignition key is in the STOP position. Otherwise, with the MSP
activated, the relative electronic control unit stores a malfunction and the warning light on
both the instrument panel and the display will come on; the vehicle will have to be taken to
the Maserati Service Network to have the malfunction corrected.
Lifting and jacking
Use the the indicated points only for lifting or jacking of the vehicle.
Maserati Academy
177
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo
1. Engine
The Maserati GranTurismo uses a 4.2 90° V8 wet sump engine, code named F136UD.
This engine is basically the identical to the engine used by the Quattroporte Automatic
(F136UC). Modifications were made only to the controlling sofware (different mapping),
which gives the engine a slightly higher power output for the GranTurismo and more allert
reactions to the commands of the accelerator pedal. This to enhance the dynamic
characteristics of the vehicle.
The basic technical solutions of this new engine has been designed to obtain high specific
power and to rapidly increase and decrease of the RPM, which is typical of competition
engines, yet always with a watchful eye on fuel consumption, driving smoothness and
silent operation.
The specific tuning of the V8 engine of the Maserati GranTurismo, unlike that of the
engines used in the automatic versions of the Quattroporte, was aimed at improving the
response to the accelerator commands (+20% in SPORT mode compared to the
Quattroporte Automatic). In this configuration, the engine reaches its maximum 405 HP at
7100 RPM (specific power of 96.4 HP/litre) and the maximum torque of 460 Nm at 4750
RPM, 75% of which is already available at 2500 RPM.
See chapter 3 “Mechanical Components” for more detailed information about this engine.
Maserati Academy
178
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo
Engine performance curves:
Max power:
Maximum torque:
297kW (405 HP) at 7100 rpm
460 Nm (47Kgm) at 4750 rpm
Engine control system:
The engine control system and its variuos components of the GranTurismo is identical to
the system of the Quattroporte with automatic transmission. The used engine control
system is Bosch Motronic 7.1.1; calibration software is however specific for the
GranTurismo.
On the next pages are only described the systems or parts which have been modified for
the GranTurismo.
Maserati Academy
179
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo
Air intake system:
The air intake system of the GranTurismo has the
same characteristics as the Quattroporte Automatic.
The shape of the front air duct has been modified
and is thus specific for the GranTurismo.
Fuel system:
The fuel and anti-evaporative system used in the Maserati GranTurismo has the same
characteristics as the system used in the Quattroporte.
Maserati Academy
180
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo
Inertia switch:
The opertion logic and the location
of the inertia switch in the
GranTurismo is identical to the
Quattroporte. The difference lies in
the fact that the inertia switch is at
one side now connected to the
body computer (NBC).
The body computer will activate
the hazard lights and the interior
lighting and will unlock the doors in
case a collision is detected.
Exhaust system:
The exhaust system of the Maserati GranTurismo is
derived from the system used in the Quattroporte
Automatic and has the same characteristics. The
shape of the system has been modified to fit the
GranTurismo’s floorplan. Tailpipes are specific.
Maserati Academy
181
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo
3. Transmission
The automatic transmission of the Maserati GranTurismo has been engineered to offer
the best possible compromise between performance, driving comfort and fuel economy. It
consists of the following components:
ZF 6HP26 automatic 6-speed gearbox: hydraulic gearbox with torque converter, lock-up
clutch and integrated control unit (Mechatronic). Various driving modes are offered: fully
automatic gearchange in normal, sport or ice mode, or manual sequential gear selection
by use of the gearshift lever or gearshift paddles at the steering wheel. This gearbox is
mechanically identical to the one used in the Quattroporte Automatic. The controlling
software is specific for the Maserati GranTurismo to enhance the sporty character of the
vehicle (faster gearshifting).
Composed transmission shaft: the transmission shaft is composed of a front and rear
part and uses three homokinetic joints. This solution was chosen because of a slight
desaxation between the gearbox output shaft and the differential input shaft, both in the
horizontal and in the vertical surface. The transmission shaft is sorter as the one used in
the Quattroporte Automatic due to the sorter wheelbase.
Note: the transmission shaft requires a balancing procedure after the removal of
transmission components (gearbox, transmission shaft, differential). This balancing
procedure is identical for GranTurismo and Quattroporte Automatic.
Graziano limited slip differential: with respect to the differential of the Quattroporte
Automatic, the final drive ratio has been changed. This was done to improve
performances and reduce differential noise.
Note: see chapter 3 “Mechanical Components” for more detailed information on the
individual transmission components.
Maserati Academy
182
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo
Adaptive gearbox strategy
By enhancing and synchronising the transmission control with other systems in the vehicle
(e.g. engine, braking system, driving wheels and steering wheel) a series of signals are
made available: these provide a description of the driving condition in real-time. After
applying longitudinal or lateral acceleration, the ECU activates (through acquisition of
signals such as engine speed and torque, oil temperature, accelerator position and
movement and the rotating speed of the individual wheels) implementation of additional
functions of the electronic transmission control. Based on this information, the
transmission control is capable of recognising whether the vehicle is in a curve and
whether the driver is braking or wishes to accelerate. By means of these signals, it is
possible to draw conclusions relating to the actual vehicle load and the topography of the
road (uphill or downhill) which can then be applied to the transmission function. This
system is known as automatic transmission with adaptive transmission control.
It is capable of recognising the driver’s intentions, recording the driving style and
consequently adapting the gear selection. Manual operation is therefore not necessary.
ZF Getriebe GmbH and Robert Bosch GmbH have worked together with Maserati to
produce new software for the electronic transmission control, which contains some very
useful functions. The Adaptive Shift Strategy (ASIS) is based on a few important factors.
Gear selection depends on the gradient of the slope while driving. The novelty is
represented by the capability of continuously adapting the gearshifts to the individual
driving styles which may vary infinitely from racing-style (dynamic) to extremely
“economic” driving.
All the functions and their operating modes are described and represented in this brief
description of ASIS. Examples of signals sent by other systems in the vehicle are given
together with the evaluation these systems provide for electronic transmission control.
Lateral acceleration: The transmission ‘learns’ the driver’s style and assigns a theoretical
count system to certain driving scenarios. When it recognises an acceleration action,
including after long periods of regular driving, it increases the number of counts for the
driver until reaching the maximum level in approximately 10 seconds. The resulting counts
for the driver and the time it takes to reach this level depends on the lateral acceleration
level.
Longitudinal acceleration: The longitudinal acceleration is evaluated mainly to allow a
decrease in counts when the driving style is constant and no other information is available
(pick-up or lateral acceleration). When the driver brakes, the count system is stopped.
Calculation of the road gradient: The road gradient is calculated by comparing the
actual acceleration of the vehicle with the acceleration the vehicle would have when
driving on a thoroughly level road. Acceleration on a level road is calculated based on the
vehicle weight and the actual torque delivered by the transmission. The ASIS system
distinguishes 5 different categories of road gradient, each of which is associated with a
gearshift map. The five conditions are: downhill, level, and three different uphill gradients.
Maserati Academy
183
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo
Auto Normal mode
Normal driving style and reduced consumption. In the case of a
driving style watchful of consumption and with reduced acceleration
levels (longitudinal and lateral) the gearshift programmes are
adjusted in such a way as to obtain maximum cruising comfort. In
order to reduce vibrations and acoustic feedback of the engine to a
minimum, upshifting must be performed as quickly as possible.
Downshifting during pedal release or downhill driving (0% pedal
depression) occur at 1000 RPM. Downshifting following the action
on the accelerator and/or brake pedal is less aggressive than in the
other modes.
Racing-style driving:
When a more racing-style driving is detected in Auto Normal mode,
upshifting with reduced pressure on the pedal occurs at a higher
engine speed. In this way, the gearbox and engine have a greater
reserve of power without having to downshift. Anticipation of
downshifting during braking considerably increases, so that the
correct gear is engaged before entering a curve.
Auto Sport Mode
Generally, when using Sport mode, gearshifting occurs at much higher RPM and, at the
same time, as a result of the fuel cut-off, gearshifting is faster than in Normal mode with a
reduction of up to 40% in gearshift times.
This difference is very evident when the accelerator pedal is not fully depressed (i.e. pedal
at 40%). The fuel cut-off technique designed for the Maserati GranTurismo (see the image
that illustrates gear engagement from second to third gear at 7000RPM with accelerator
pedal depressed by 40%) permits reducing the time necessary to cut the torque to the
engine, shift gears and provide power once again. Normal driving style and reduced
consumption.
Maserati Academy
184
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo
When using Sport mode in normal driving conditions without high lateral acceleration, the
gearbox management software as a rule uses a lower gear than would be used in similar
conditions in Auto Normal mode. Without operating the accelerator/brake pedal,
downshifting is requested at about 1500 RPM. This makes the gearbox response much
more racing-like without significantly affecting driving comfort. When driving on a
motorway, 6th gear is engaged at a speed of 125 km/h.
Racing-style driving:
In order to achieve the best reactivity, the gearshift maps are set to very high engine
speeds. With reduced pressure on the pedal or with the pedal at 0%, upshifting occurs at
approximately 4000 RPM. Downshifting, following an action on the brake pedal, is
adjusted in such a way that the gear is engaged before going into a curve, so that the
driver has optimal control and an adequate reserve of power to come out of the curve.
This mode is therefore specifically designed for driving at high speeds or for very difficult
road conditions.
Maserati Academy
185
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo
The automatic electronically-controlled gearbox has 6 forward gears and one reverse
gear. In addition to automatic gear selection, the gears can also be selected manually.
The lever position is shown on the gear display by the
illumination of the corresponding letter. This letter is also
shown on the instrument panel display. The engine can
only be started when the gearshift lever is in P or N.
WARNING: After starting the engine and setting off, do not
depress the accelerator pedal before and while shifting the
gearshift lever. This is particularly important when the
engine is cold.
Shift-Lock
This safety system allows you to shift from P (PARK) to
another position only if the brake pedal is depressed. This
prevents the vehicle from involuntarily jumping forward or
backward.
Key-Lock
After turning off the engine with the gearshift lever in a
position different from “P”, the key can be extracted within a
maximum time of 30 seconds. When this time has elapsed,
the key can no longer be removed from the ignition block.
To remove the key, you must turn it to ON and then back to
OFF.
F
Lever
release
button
WARNING: In the case of an emergency, (e.g.,
breakdowns, dead battery etc.) the ignition key can be
removed even if the gearshift lever is not in P. To do this,
turn the key to STOP, press the button A on the gearshift
lever and at the same time remove the key.
Maserati Academy
186
Introduction to Maserati
CAUTION!
Maserati GranTurismo
When parking on steep slopes, it is recommended to shift the lever to
PARK before leaving the vehicle (whether the engine is running or not).
This is recommended since the EPB system installed in the vehicle is
capable of ensuring that the vehicle is properly parked and stationary when
fully laden only on a gradient up to 20%
Selecting automatic or sequential manual operating mode:
The gearbox can be used both in fully automatic (position D) and in sequential manual
(positions + or -) mode.
The operating modes can be activated through the following selections:
• D automatic gearshifting (AUTO)
• M (+ / -) Sequential manual gearshifting (MANUAL)
The lever can always be shifted between these two positions even if the vehicle is moving
and without depressing the brake pedal. The lever can continuously be shifted between D
and M.
If automatic gearshift mode is selected, the word AUTO and the letter D will be shown on
the instrument panel display, while for sequential manual gearshifting, the word MANUAL
and the gear engaged will be shown.
Automatic selection operating mode
Select the D (drive) position when you wish to use all the automatic gearshift functions.
With the vehicle stationary and the brake pedal depressed, shift the gearshift lever to D; if
the gearshift lever is in P or R, also press the button A on the lever knob. When the
function is set, the letter D illuminates on the gear display and on the instrument panel.
With this function active, the ECU controls automatic engagement of the six gears. The
gears will be engaged in relation to the travelling speed, engine RPM, accelerator position,
speed with which the pedal is depressed, as well as the travelling conditions (uphill,
downhill, curves).
The system is programmed to classify all driving styles related to the above mentioned
parameters, matching them to ten different vehicle settings which go from extremely
comfortable and fuel-economy driving to full racing-style driving. The setting is selected
automatically.
Kick-down strategy
This strategy is activated by rapidly and fully depressing the accelerator pedal, which
causes engagement of a lower gear than the current one; this function assists the driver
when maximum acceleration is required. When the pedal is released, the best gear in
relation to the vehicle speed and the position of the accelerator pedal is automatically
engaged. The kick-down strategy can be activated only when automatic operation has
been set, with the gearshift lever in position D.
Maserati Academy
187
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo
Manual selection operating mode
Push the gearschift lever to the left from the D position to select the manual mode. To
engage the gears, move the gearshift lever to the following two positions:
+ UP to engage a higher gear
- DOWN to engage a lower gear.
The Maserati GranTurismo has gearshift paddles behind the steering wheel as a standard
feature. In sequential manual operating mode, upshifting and downshifting can be
controlled not only with the gearshift lever but also with the two levers positioned behind
the steering wheel.
Also in automatic gearbox operation with the gearshift lever positioned in D (drive), you
can request a gear different from the current one by activating one of the levers. This
action will temporarily switch the system to sequential manual operation. If you then keep
to a constant driving style (low longitudinal and lateral acceleration), the gearbox
automatically switches back to automatic operation.
Up
Down
WARNING: Even if manual gearshifting mode has been activated, some functions are still
controlled automatically. When the engine is overrevving or underrevving, the system
automatically engages a higher or lower gear.
WARNING: If you request a gearshift in conditions where the engine is overrevving or
underrevving, the system will not accept the command.
WARNING: The electronic control unit is programmed to handle one gearshift at a time,
therefore, fast and repeated requests will not necessarily result in a gearshift. The higher
or lower gear is engaged only if the previous gearshift procedure has been completed.
Maserati Academy
188
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo
Parking
When parking the vehicle, shift the lever to the P position (park). A gear device inside the
gearbox will lock the driving wheels.
WARNING: To prevent accidental engagement, the gearshift lever can only be shifted
from P to any other position when the button on the gearshift lever and the brake pedal are
depressed.
WARNING: Shift the lever to position P only when the vehicle is stationary.
WARNING: Before getting out of the vehicle, check that the automatic parking brake is
engaged. Shift the gearshift lever to P even when you need to get out of the vehicle for
only a few seconds leaving the engine running.
WARNING: If you turn off the engine with the gearshift lever in a position different from P,
an acoustic signal will sound for a few seconds.
If you open the driver’s door with the gearshift lever in a position different from P, an
acoustic signal will sound for a few seconds.
Strategies for downhill driving
When the DRIVE mode is selected and the accelerator pedal is released, the gearbox
system detects that the vehicle is moving downhill and deactivates upshifting. When the
accelerator pedal is depressed, upshifting is reactivated, however, with a delay of a few
seconds.
When the brake pedal is depressed, the gearbox system downshifts to provide enhanced
engine braking power. In other words, when driving downhill, the gearbox system operates
so as to avoid upshifting and shifting gears when the accelerator pedal is released, and
delays gear engagement by a few seconds when the accelerator pedal is depressed. In
addition, when the brakes are applied, it engages the lowest gear in order to provide
enhanced engine braking power. This strategy is aimed at making downhill driving safer.
Strategies in curves
The gearbox system detects when the vehicle is in a curve through the lateral acceleration
and the steering angle. Detecting the DRIVE mode, the system deactivates both upshifting
and downshifting until the vehicle comes out of the curve. In particularly tight uphill curves
the system downshifts. Gearshifting is reactivated when the vehicle comes out of the
curve at a distance that varies depending on the vehicle speed.
Maserati Academy
189
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo
Hot-mode strategy
In the event that the engine oil or coolant temperature or both are too high, the gearbox
system reduces the maximum engine speed to 4000 RPM. For this reason, upshifting will
occur at this limit.
This strategy does not apply to downhill driving, so as to always have the efficiency of
engine braking together with the standard braking system.
Acoustic signals
If you turn off the engine with the gearshift lever in a position different from P, an acoustic
signal will sound for a few seconds.
If you open the driver’s door with the gearshift lever in a position different from P, an
acoustic signal will sound for a few seconds.
With the lever in R, the system emits an acoustic signal for a few seconds to warn anyone
in the vicinity that you are about to reverse.
Maserati Academy
190
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo
Gearshift lever release in emergency conditions
In the event of failure of the electrical power supply system with resulting dead battery, the
vehicle may only be moved after the gearshift lever has been released from the P position
and moved to the N position. When there is no power, the lever can only be released
using the emergency procedure.
• Remove the cover G in front of the gearshift lever.
• Using the screwdriver contained in the toolkit, push on the release mechanism working
through the hole and at the same time shift the gearshift lever to N.
• The gearshift lever has now been released.
NOTE: In order to tow the vehicle, the emergency release procedure of the EPB system
must be performed.
Low gearbox oil level
The red icon indicates that the gearbox oil level is too low. If the warning light
comes on, stop the vehicle. The gearbox oil level must be checked.
Note: the gearbox does not contain an oil level sensor or switch. The
gearbox oil level is a calculated estimation made by the electronic control
unit.
Automatic gearbox failure
Depending on the different related messages, the symbol may indicate:
- a gearbox failure (error code stored)
- a too high actual temperature of the gearbox oil (no error code)
Gearbox failure
This message, highlighted in red, indicates a gearbox system failure, therefore, if you are
travelling, the ECU that controls the device sets an emergency program. In these
conditions, we recommended that you stop the vehicle and turn off the engine for at least
one minute. When restarting the engine, the autodiagnostic system may cancel the
malfunction, which will in any case be recorded by the ECU.
In failure conditions, the gearshift lever can always be shifted to R, N, D and P. When
shifting to the latter position, only a few gears will be available, depending on the
malfunction found.
Maserati Academy
191
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo
4. Braking System
System components
•
Brake servo 8+9“Ø
•
Tandem brake master cylinder 15/16"
Stroke 18+18mm
•
Servo control ratio 13.5
•
Self-ventilated front discs 330x32mm
•
Self-ventilated rear discs 330x28mm
with new brake calipers
•
Parking brake with electric activation
•
ABS/ESP Bosch 8.0
The Brembo braking system of the Maserati GranTurismo is
equipped with 4 ventilated discs on the front and rear wheels
(front 330 mm Ø x 32 mm, rear 330 mm Ø x 28 mm) with 4-piston
calipers.
Brake performance:
Stopping distance: from 100 to km/h:
Maximum deceleration:
35 m
1.24 g
From a safety point of view, the vehicle is equipped with ABS, which prevents the wheels
from locking during braking, and EBD, which provides optimal brake force distribution
between the front and the rear; both are integrated in the MSP system (Maserati Stability
Program). MSP contains further electronic stability control (ESP), traction control (ASR)
and engine brake torque control (MSR).
To help the driver during uphill starting, the Maserati GranTurismo is fitted with the “Hill
Holder” device which, in the case of sloped roads, immobilises the vehicle for a few
seconds to allow the driver to move his foot from the brake pedal to the accelerator pedal
without the vehicle rolling back.
The standard brake calipers have black finishing; on request, they can be supplied in five
different colours: red, yellow, titanium, blue and silver. The Maserati name is black (for the
red, yellow and silver calipers), white (for the black and blue calipers) and red (for the
titanium calipers).
Maserati Academy
192
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo
Electric Parking Brake (EPB)
The Maserati GranTurismo is standard fitted with an electric parking brake (EPB). The
system is identical to the one used in the Quattroporte Automatic.
The EPB system is composed of:
• EPB actuator (cable puller) with integrated ECU
• Primary cable
• Equalizer / divider
• Secondary cables (LH + RH)
• Drum parking brakes, integrated in the rear brake discs.
• Parking brake command switch
• “Park off” button
• Emergency release tool (integrated in the toolkit)
System operation and various functions are identical to the Quattroporte Automatic
system. See Quattroporte for more details.
Note: Al GranTurismo vehicles are fitted with the PRE RELEASE function.
Maserati Academy
193
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo
Maserati Stability Programm (MSP)
The Maserati Quattroporte Automatic has a new stability control system integrated in the
Bosch ESP 8 ECU. The dynamic performance of the Maserati GranTurismo is supported
by the Maserati Stability Program (MSP), specifically developed by the Trident engineers
to provide greater safety and optimise the dynamic performance of the vehicle. The
system is based on a set of sensors capable of detecting any vehicle failure with respect
to ideal dynamic performance. It acts on the brakes and engine to stabilise their setup and
restore proper performance. The Maserati Stability Program (MSP) performs the following
functions:
− if the system detects a tendency to side skidding, it reduces the torque; it activates the
brakes and stabilises the vehicle in just a few milliseconds (ESP);
− it prevents the wheels from locking during braking (ABS);
− it distributes the brake force between the front and rear axle, preventing the rear wheels
from locking (EBD);
− it prevents slipping of the driving wheels, improving traction in low-grip conditions (ASR);
SPORT mode
Also for what concerns the MSP, the driver can choose Sport
mode: in normal conditions, the system acts both on the engine
torque and the brakes; when the SPORT button is pressed, the
stability program is less "invasive" and permits enhanced racingstyle driving without however affecting safety. In fact, the
operating threshold is raised and the system mainly operates on
the brakes without cutting power to the engine.
MSP OFF mode
Pressing the “MSP OFF” button you can deactivate all the driving
control systems (ESP, MSR and ASR), leaving only the ABS and
EBD systems active. In emergency conditions, depress the brake
pedal to reactivate all the driving control functions.
If The vehicle will perform without any safety system and the
driver will have to rely only on the vehicle and his driving skills for
particularly exciting driving. Of course, it is advisable to use the
“MSP OFF” mode only on dry roads and on tracks closed to
traffic. Even if the control system is deactivated, the Anti-LockBraking System (ABS) will remain active to prevent wheel locking
or skidding. In order to prevent unstable driving conditions, the
MSP system may request the gearbox system to disable
automatic gearshifting. This request is processed by the system
which, depending on the gear engaged and the engine RPM, will
evaluate the appropriate gearshift or temporarily deactivate this
feature.
Maserati Academy
194
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo
ICE mode
This mode can be used on particularly slippery road surfaces (e.g.,
snow, ice) and it is activated/deactivated by pressing the button on
the NIT. The word ICE will illuminate on the instrument panel display.
In “Low-grip" mode the system uses 2nd instead of 1st gear. This
means that when you start from a stationary position with the engine
running - both in automatic mode (gearshift lever in D) and manual
mode (gearshift lever in M) - the vehicle will start in 2nd gear. When
sequential manual mode is selected with 2nd gear engaged, a
downshift request will be ignored.
When sequential manual mode is selected with 2nd gear engaged, a
downshift request will be ignored. While driving, the system
automatically switches to the upper gear if the engine reaches the
pre-established speed rate (3,000 RPM). “Low-grip" mode has
priority over SPORT mode and assists the MSP system.
If “ICE” mode is activated when “SPORT” mode is active, during the
transition stage it may happen that both the “ICE” and the “SPORT”
messages are present on the CAN line. In this case, the system will
give priority to the “ICE” message, immediately showing it on the
display.
5. Driving Controls
The standard steering column has manual adjustment for height and depth. Instead of the
steering column with manual adjustment, you can request the version with electrical
adjustment in combination with the comfort pack for the seats (this includes storage of the
settings and heating).
The steering rack (TRW) and vehicle speed sensitive power steering are similar to the one
used in the Quattroporte. The steering ratio has been changed with respect to the
Quattroporte (more direct) to offer a more dynamic vehicle control.
Steering diameter (from pavement to pavement): 10.7 m
Maserati Academy
195
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo
6. Suspensions and Wheels
Wheels
In the standard configuration, the Maserati GranTurismo is
equipped with 19” aluminium wheel rims with different-sized
front and rear tyres: for better power discharge to the ground,
the rear tyres have a wider tread than the front ones.
The 19” wheel rims are in light alloy; front 8.5J x 19, profile H2;
rear 10.5J x 19, profile H2; Front tyres 245/40 R19, rear tyres
285/40 R19.
A racing-style 20” version is available, which, although slightly
reducing comfort, increases handling and response to steering
movements, thanks to the effect of the smaller drift angle. The
look is inspired by that of the Birdcage 75° wheels and further
underlines the power of its mechanics.
Optional: 20" light alloy wheel rims; front 8.5J x 20, profile H2;
rear 10.5J x 20, profile H2; Front tyres 245/35 R20, rear tyres
285/35 R20.
Both types are available with Ball-Polished treatment and in
mercury grey:
− The ball-polished treatment emphasises the mechanical
features at the same time gives a brilliant effect even if not as
eye-catching as the chrome-plated wheels.
− The dark mercury grey further highlights the racing-like
character of the GranTurismo.
Maserati Academy
196
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo
Tyre pressure monitoring system (optional)
TRIP button : displays the “Tyre pressure” information for 10 seconds
15-05-2002
-23°C
Tyre
Pressure
2,2
bar
2,2
bar
2,2
bar
2,2
bar
SPORT
km
3
km [A]
000999 998.9
Information displayed :
- System temporarily inactive (for example: external radio
interference)
- System not calibrated (for example: a tyre has been replaced )
- System failure
- System not active (if it is disabled by the diagnostic system)
- Low pressure or puncture of the LH front, RH front, LH rear and
RH rear tyres
- Low pressure or puncture in unidentified tyre
Note: If the system is not calibrated (for example: a tyre has
been replaced) calibrate the system by pressing the button on
the front ceiling light (from 4 to 10 sec.). The completion of the
calibration procedure is indicated on the instrument panel.
System calibration
After replacing or inflating one or more tyres, the system must be calibrated once again.
To calibrate the system, press and hold button A, located on the inside roof, for a time
ranging between 4 and 10 seconds. The system takes a maximum of 20 minutes to
complete the calibration procedure with the vehicle in motion. A green symbol will appear
on the display together with the message "Calibration started”. If the user recalls the
information page showing the pressure levels of each tyre, dashes “–.–” will be viewed in
the place of the values.
You can access the information screen page that shows the pressure values of each tyre
by repeatedly pressing the “Mode” button B.
Maserati Academy
197
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo
Suspensions
The chassis of the Maserati GranTurismo is fitted with overlapping-triangle front and rear
suspension with forged aluminium hub carrier and arms, with the aim of reducing the
unsprung weights of the vehicle.
As an optional, the Maserati GranTurismo can come equipped with aluminium gas shock
absorbers with Skyhook system for automatic and continuous damping adjustment. This
technology is used to assure optimal comfort levels with any road condition, without
affecting performance and the racing-style character of the vehicle.
The Skyhook system acts by means of acceleration sensors which record the movements
of each wheel and the bodywork. The ECU processes the information received, analyses
the driving style and the road conditions and immediately adjusts the shock absorbers by
acting on the proportional valve of each of them.
In the case of the fixed calibration system, the suspension set-up is optimised for handling:
•
The standard suspension has been designed for those customers who prefer good
handling over driving comfort.
•
The standard suspension provides a vehicle set-up which is quite similar to that used
with the Skyhook system in Sport mode.
•
The Skyhook suspension offers superior driving comfort with respect to the standard
suspension.
Skyhook layout
Maserati Academy
198
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo
Front suspensions
•
•
•
•
•
•
Articulated
quadrilateral
independent wheel suspension with
double oscillating triangle
Anti-dive and anti-squad geometry
Forged aluminium levers, aluminium
hub carrier
25 mm ø articulated stabilizer bar
on ball joints
Optional Skyhook variable-damping
aluminium
hydraulic
shock
absorbers
Suspension mounted on a new
separate frame rigidly connected to
the bodywork
Rear suspensions
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Maserati Academy
Articulated
quadrilateral
rear
independent wheel suspension with
double oscillating triangle
Anti-dive and anti-squat geometry
Forged aluminium levers, aluminium
hub carrier
24 mm ø articulated stabilizer bar
on ball joints
Optional Skyhook variable-damping
aluminium hydraulic shock absorbers
Suspension mounted on a new
separate frame rigidly connected to
the bodywork
199
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo
Wheel alignment
Front
Camber :
-0.30°±0°10’ on each wheel
Caster :
3.30°±0°10’ on each wheel
Total toe-in: -2,1 ±0.4mm (1,05 mm opening on each wheel)
Rear
Camber :
-1.30°±0°10’ on each wheel
Total toe-in: 4.2 ±0.4mm (2,1 mm closing on each wheel)
Caution
The characteristic angles must be adjusted during “static load”
configuration, that is, with all the fluid tanks filled, the fuel tank full (90
litres) and 75 kg on both front seats.
Maserati Academy
200
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo
7. Safety components
The vehicle is equipped with 6 airbags (2 front and 4 lateral ones) and electronicallyoperated pretensioners for all of the seat belts.
The system components are the following:
1) Electronic control unit
2) Passenger's front airbag
3) Air bag deactivation switch passenger's side
4) Passenger's front seat belt pretensioner
5)Passenger's side bag
6) Satellite crash sensor on passenger side
7) Passenger-side door-mounted airbag
8) Driver-side door-mounted airbag
9) Driver's side bag
10) Satellite collision sensor on driver side
11) Passenger's front seat belt pretensioner
12) Airbag system failure warning light
13) Passenger’s airbag deactivation warning light
14) Driver's front airbag
15) Clock Spring
Maserati Academy
16) Diagnostics socket
17) Rear left-hand pretensioner
18) Rear right-hand pretensioner
19) Front left-hand Crash Zone
pretensioner
20) Front left-hand Crash Zone Sensor.
201
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo
If replacing the NAB or a component of the airbag system, the initialisation procedure
must be performed on the new component. To perform the initialisation procedure, detach
the electrical connectors for the driver's airbag, passenger's airbag and side bags
positioned under the front seats.
CAUTION
Follow the instructions and relative safety regulations for removal and storage of
the airbag modules.
9Connect the SD3 diagnostics tester to the NBC diagnostic socket.
9Access "CYCLE ENVIRONMENT", select the airbag node configuration cycle and
continue. After entering the vehicle data, select "CONTINUE" and turn the key to ON.
9Wait for the checks to be completed and then follow the guided procedure, by means of
which the tester will check the information available in the ECU.
Continue with the cycle until the tester prompts you to connect the driver-side airbag
connectors, but without fitting the two secondary locks (safety devices for the connectors).
Connect the two secondary locks, first connecting the yellow one and then the green one.
Subsequently, the page "ATTACH THE CONNECTOR THAT KEEPS THE PASSENGER
AIRBAG LINE 1 IN SHORT-CIRCUIT" will be displayed.
The part number of the fake connector is 900027450. This can be ordered from the
Maserati Spare Parts Department. Connect the fake connector 900027450
Wait until the next screen pages prompt you to remove the fake connector 900027450 and
to attach the passenger-side airbag connector. Attach the passenger-side airbag
connector. Subsequently the screen page prompting you to attach the sidebag
connectors will be displayed. Connect the sidebag connectors.
The diagnostic tester will then perform a check of the switches for the front and rear
seat belts.
Buckle the seat belts in the following order:
- Front seat, driver's side
- Rear left-hand seat
- Rear seat, passenger's side
- Front seat, passenger's side
The buckled seat belts are displayed in red.
The diagnostic tester then asks the user if the manual deactivation device for the
passenger-side airbag is fitted. Reply "yes" and continue with the cycle.
Perform the requested operations to check that the manual airbag deactivation device is
properly functioning.
The diagnostic tester will then prompt you to check that the airbag warning light on the
instrument panel is off. Subsequently, the summary of the initialisation cycle progress
appears, which should be printed and filed.
Refit all the components previously removed to access the electrical connections of the
airbag system.
Maserati Academy
202
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo
8. Electrical Systems and Devices
Electronic vehicle architecture
The electronic and electric functions of the various ECUs and nodes are controlled by the
F.L.ORE.N.C.E system, a technology that Maserati introduced with the Quattroporte. The
use of this new system, designed for CAN communication, has allowed us to find
immediate solutions as to communication, dimension, weight and cost problems. Each
electronic control unit is positioned in the barycentre with respect to the functions it
controls, so that the system is fully optimised.
The F.L.ORE.N.C.E. system is made up of two CAN communication networks:
•
C-CAN network: dynamic control and management of the vehicle (high speed);
•
B-CAN network: control of the standard bodywork functions (low speed).
The C-CAN and B-CAN networks are connected to each other by the body computer unit
which is equipped with both the interfaces and hence performs the network
GATEWAY function for transferring information.
The system also provides a number of serial lines used for diagnostics and other specific
functions:
•
K-line diagnostics for NCM / NFR / CSG / NCS / CAF
•
Serial line w for immobilizer recovery
•
A-BUS serial line for alarm, windscreen wiper and twilight sensor control.
Maserati Academy
203
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo
Overview of controlling modules
Switch Matrix cable harness for diagnostics
For use of the cable harness, it is essential that the key is turned to OFF when the SD3 is
activated, until the ECU to be diagnosed has been selected. This is because in certain
conditions, some errors may occur on the CAN lines, which would cause the warning lights
on the instrument panel to flash.
EOBD socket connections
1:
2:
3:
4:
5:
6:
7:
8:
B-CAN B
Dedicated
Dedicated
GND
GND
C CAN-H
K-line (NCM – NFR)
Dedicated
Maserati Academy
9:
10:
11:
12:
13:
14:
15:
16:
B-CAN C
Dedicated
Dedicated
K-line
Not used
C CAN-L
Not used
+30 EOBD
204
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo
Central door locking system
Locking/unlocking the vehicle using the remote control:
Door lock button:
Button pressed once: If the alarm system fails, the siren will emit a long beep and the red
LEDs will start flashing quickly. If one of the doors has not been closed properly, the doors
do NOT lock and the alarm system is NOT activated. The direction indicators and the red
LEDs flash nine times (three seconds).
Button pressed at length: the windows close.
Releasing the button: the windows stop closing .
Door unlock button:
Button pressed twice: All the doors are unlocked (if enabled by the NIT, only the driver’s
door is unlocked), Low beams activated for 30 seconds
Button pressed at length: the windows open.
Releasing the button: the windows stop opening.
Locking/unlocking the vehicle using the internal buttons:
Luggage compartment opening button: button pressed at length: the luggage compartment
is opened (when the vehicle speed is below 4 Km/h or when the vehicle is off)
Locking/unlocking the vehicle using the button on the external revolving pawls:
Key turned anticlockwise in DRIVER’S door lock (Opening): all doors are unlocked (or
driver’s door only if set through the NIT)
If the alarm is enabled: the red LEDs will turn off for 4 seconds (when this time has
elapsed, they will start flashing again). When a door is opened the acoustic alarm is
activated.
Key turned clockwise in PASSENGER'S door lock (opening): all doors are unlocked.
If the alarm is enabled: the red LEDs will turn off for 4 seconds (when this time has
elapsed, they will start flashing again)
NOTE: When the vehicle is unlocked from the outside with the key, the alarm system is
not deactivated. To deactivate the alarm system, simply insert the key in the ignition block.
The immobilizer acknowledges the code automatically.
Maserati Academy
205
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo
Locking/unlocking the doors and the luggage compartment
Inertia switch: the activation of the inertial switch unlocks all the doors and the luggage
compartment and turns on the internal dome light and the four direction indicators. This is
located underneath the driver’s seat.
Vehicle speed over 20 Km/h : when the vehicle speed exceeds 20 Km/h the doors are
locked if this function has been previously set through the IT Info Node (NIT) user menu
Dead battery: vehicle closing. The two front doors must be locked.
Vehicle setup: From the NIT user menu, you may decide whether to unlock both the
doors or just the door on the driver’s side.
From the relative menu, you can choose whether the luggage compartment should be
connected to the door locking or whether it should be operated independently.
Alarm System
The alarm system of the Maserati GranTurismo is identical to the system used in the
Quattroporte.
Activation: the direction indicators will turn on permanently, and the alarm siren will
emit a synchronised beep. A red LED will now start flashing intermittently to indicate a
"surveillance" status.
Deactivation: the direction indicators will flash twice, the alarm siren will emit a
double beep. NOTE: The alarm system is also deactivated by inserting a key with an ID
code in the ignition key barrel, so that the immobilizer can recognise it.
Motion-sensing and anti-inclination alarm: when the alarm system is deactivated, the
motion-sensing and anti-inclination alarm can be turned off using the buttons provided on
the front dome lamp.
Luggage compartment opening: the luggage compartment can be opened using the
remote control; in this case, the motion and inclination sensors are temporarily
deactivated. If the luggage compartment is then closed, the sensors will be reactivated.
ECU self learning:
Every time the battery is removed, a self-learning cycle is required so that certain ECUs
can operate correctly.
• Motor-driven throttle: turn the ignition switch to the ON position (Key ON) and wait for at
least 30 seconds.
• Locking/unlocking the doors and luggage compartment: lock and then unlock the doors
using the remote control or the key.
• NIT (IT Info Node): reset the correct time using the specific NIT service menu
Maserati Academy
206
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo
External lights
(1) The side markers, provided as a
standard equipment for all the markets,
improve driving safety and are also an
attractive aesthetic element
(2) Front direction indicator repeater
(3) Position light
(4) Bi-xenon headlight – low-beam + highbeam
(5) Additional low-beam (Flash to Pass ) –
the bi-xenon lamps take some time to reach
maximum efficiency, therefore, while the bixenon headlights are off, the flashing
function is assured by a conventional light.
(6) Front headlight cleaning system
(7) Fog light
Adaptive light adjustment
The Maserati GranTurismo is fitted with a set of self-levelling bi-xenon headlights with fully
automatic adjustment system. The high performance of the bi-xenon headlights is
enhanced even further by the rotation function which, by improving the illumination of the
road and surrounding areas, contributes to increasing driving safety during night-time on
particularly twisty roads. The high-beam and low-beam control unit instantaneously
receives and processes the information on steering, camber and driving speed and acts
on special electric motors that turn the light cones in order to increase side illumination.
Operating strategy:
•
The system is activated at a speed of 5 km/h.
•
The maximum headlight rotation inside a curve
is 15° and for the headlight outside a curve 7.5°
(always half);
•
From 90 km/h to 120 km/h the rotation is less
•
Over 120 km/h and in reverse, the system is
deactivated for safety reasons.
Maserati Academy
207
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo
When replacing the left-hand headlight, perform the two calibration cycles on both NFA
ECU.
• Connect the diagnostic tester to the EOBD socket on the Body Computer Node and
calibrate the Self-adaptive Headlight Node (NFA). This cycle involves the calibration of the
left-hand headlight (MASTER) and subsequently of the right-hand one (SLAVE).
• The two cycles are independent, therefore you will have to launch first the MASTER
calibration cycle and then the SLAVE one.
• In the event of a collision involving the left-hand headlight, the signal connector for the
CAN line may be damaged. The damaged connector may interfere with proper vehicle
starting. Therefore, if the vehicle cannot be used after a collision and the headlight is
damaged, detach the CAN line connector and check engine starting.
If replacing the battery, the PROXY alignment procedure does not have to be performed;
when the key is next turned to on and with the headlights on, the node performs a selflearning process as calibration.
Q007:
Q002:
G001:
M002:
Rear potentiometer for headlight aiming adjustment
Front potentiometer for headlight aiming adjustment
Headlight cluster
Body Computer node (NBC)
Maserati Academy
208
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo
Lights managed by the twilight sensor (AUTO mode): the external lights are activated
automatically by the twilight sensor. From the NIT user menu, you can set the twilight
sensor’s sensing range (3 levels).
Follow me home
This control enables the position lights and low beams to switch on automatically for a
timed period, immediately after the vehicle is turned off (Key-OFF).
Activation: After turning the key to OFF, you must operate the control for flashing the
headlights, found on the steering column stalk. The instrument panel activates the ‘followme-home’ signal and displays the time (in seconds) during which the lights will remain on.
(Signal active for 20 sec.)
Activation time increase: When this function is active, every time you flash the
headlights, the time the lights remain on is extended for a further 30 seconds (max. 210
sec.)
Deactivation:
- keep the control for flashing the headlights active for over 2 seconds.
- turn the ignition key from OFF to ON.
Maserati Academy
209
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo
Tail lights
(1) Position light – LED technology (the
function of the rear side marker is
performed by the external section of the
lighting device)
(2) Rear fog light
(3) Reverse light
(4) Stop – LED technology
(5) Direction indicator – LED
technology
(6) Side reflector
(7) Reflector
Internal lights
Day/night condition. This is determined by:
- the light switch
-“night condition” detected by the vehicle’s twilight sensor. Therefore, the fact that the
position lights are on does not necessarily mean the internal lights will be turned on.
Timing:
3 minutes : Step lights under the door and and front dome light.
15 minutes : Glove compartment light, diver’s glove compartment light, sun visors' light,
spot light, front and rear central dome lights if activated using the specific control or by the
inertia switch.
20 minutes : Luggage compartment light.
Maserati Academy
210
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo
Multi Media System (MMS)
1) CD eject.
2) SOURCE Mode selection: Radio, CD or Jukebox.
3) BAND Radio mode: Frequency band selection FM1– FM2 – FMAST – AM.
Radio mode: Automatic storage of the stations in FMAST (Autostore).
4) Telephone mode activation. Send call. Answer call.
5) RPT Activates repetition of the navigation message.
6) ESC Exits from a selection list
7) Radio mode: Radio frequency shift in fixed steps to the next station
MP3 CD and Jukebox mode: album selection previous.
8) With basic HI Fi system: Radio, CD and Jukebox mode: audio adjustment (music
ambience, bass, treble, F-R balance, L-R balance, loudness, automatic volume
adjustment).
With Bose Hi-Fi system (optional): Radio, CD and Jukebox mode: audio adjustment
(bass, treble, F-R balance, L-R balance, Center Point ).
9) SIM card adapter eject button.
10) SIM card adapter 40
11) Radio mode: Automatic search of the next radio station.
CD and Jukebox mode: Goes to the next track.
Menu: scrolls through the menus.
CD audio mode: track fast forward
12) LIST Radio mode: displays the list of stations receivable in alphabetical order.
CD audio mode: displays the list of tracks.
CD, MP3 and Jukebox mode: displays the list of albums and tracks.
Radio mode: updates the list of stations
Maserati Academy
211
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo
13) Telephone, Navigation, Audio mode
(Radio, AUDIO CD, MP3 CD Jukebox) and Trip:
opens the function-related menu. Menu: turn the knob to select the function, the item and
the value, which are then confirmed by pressing the same knob.
14 Radio mode: radio frequency shift in fixed steps to the previous station starting from
the station you are currently tuned into.
MP3 CD and Jukebox mode: selects the next album.
15 MENU Access to main menu
16 Radio mode: Automatic search of previous radio station.
CD and Jukebox mode: goes to the previous track if pressed within the first 3 playing
seconds, otherwise restarts playing the track.
CD audio mode: track fast rewind.
17 Radio mode: recalls the stations stored (1– 6)
Telephone mode: Dial phone number: (1 – 12) or input text. Quick selection of a name in
the directory and on the SIM card that starts with the selected letter. Stores the station you
are listening to (1 – 6).
18 Telephone mode: Reject incoming call. Drop call.
19 TA/PTY TA (Traffic Announcements): enables automatic reception of
traffic
information. Functions available only in the countries where RDS is available.
20 With the key in position MAR or the engine on: Audio OFF/ON With the key in STOP
position or the gearshift lever in PARK position: activation / deactivation of the system.
Rotation: to adjust the volumes.
21 DARK 1st pulse: partial display darkening. 2nd pulse: total display darkening. 3rd
pulse: back to normal display brightness. System reinitialisation.
22 MODE Changes the current display on the right-hand side of the screen (radio, map,
onboard computer (TRIP), telephone).
Maserati Academy
212
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo
Audio adjustments
With the key in position MAR you can turn the audio section on and off by pressing the
switch. Depending on the system installed, the audio adjustments may be:
9 Basic: Radio, CD and Jukebox mode:
audio adjustment (music ambience, bass, treble, F-R balance, L-R balance, loudness,
automatic volume adjustment, automatic volume adjustment).
9 Bose: Radio, CD and Jukebox mode: audio adjustments (bass, treble, F-R balance,
L-R balance, Center point).
To adjust the audio, press the AUDIO button (8) repeatedly to adjust the bass tones
(BASS), treble tones (TREB), loudness (LOUD), fader (FAD), balance (BAL), automatic
volume and sound type (musical ambience). The system stores the data and deactivates
audio adjustment when the ESC button is pressed or after a few seconds if no adjustment
is made.
WARNING: Bass and treble tone adjustment is specific to each source, and they can
therefore be adjusted differently in the RADIO, CD or JUKEBOX modes.
Loudness function (LOUD)
This function is not available with the Bose® Surround Sound System (optional), since it is
automatically controlled by the system. This function automatically amplifies the bass and
treble tones when the volume is low. To activate or deactivate the function, turn the knob
(13).
Automatic volume correction
This function is not available with the Bose® Surround Sound System (optional), since it is
automatically controlled by the system. This function automatically adjusts the volume in
relation to the vehicle speed. To activate or deactivate the function, turn the knob (13).
Musical ambience
This function is not available with the Bose® Surround Sound System (optional), since it is
automatically controlled by the system. This function allows the user to set the various
types of sound desired (classic, jazz, pop, etc). Select the desired sound by turning the
knob (13). After setting the desired sound, select and confirm ("OK") by pressing the knob
and the system will automatically return to the previous menu.
Center point
This function is available only with the Bose® Surround Sound System (optional) and
when the CD source is active. Equalizing system that converts the stereo recordings into 8
separate channels, thus assuring absolute precision with any volume level. The automatic
output frequency balancing makes manual adjustments through switches or knobs
unnecessary. To activate or deactivate this function, select and confirm the corresponding
options by turning and pressing the knob (13).
Maserati Academy
213
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo
CD / Jukebox mode
To ensure optimal sound reproduction you are advised to use original CDs.
WARNING: Do not use AUDIO CD or MP3 CD mediums in 8 cm format, not even with a
specific adapter; using this format will damage the system. After inserting a CD with the
printed side facing up, it will automatically start playing. If you are listening to another
audio source and there is already a CD in the player, press the button SOURCE (2) or
SCR (27): the CD will automatically start playing.
Fast forward/backward
Press and hold down the button (11) or (16) to fast forward or backward to a track on the
AUDIO CD; release them to go back to the normal playing speed.
WARNING: This function is not available for MP3 CD and Jukebox.
CD / Jukebox mode menu
Repeatedly press the MODE button (22) until the AUDIO mode is displayed. Pressing the
knob (13) the display will show the following menu:
- Copy CD to Jukebox
- Activate Introscan
- Activate random mode
- Activate repeat
Confirming this function with the knob (13) you will access a submenu containing the
following options:
• Copy complete CD
• Multiple selection (allows copying a series of tracks selected by the user)
• Complete album (only with MP3 CD)
• Current track.
During copying in Audio mode only the Radio function is active.
Activate Introscan
Once selected and confirmed, this function allows you to listen to the beginning of all the
tracks on the CD or in the Jukebox in actual order. To deactivate this function, press the
knob (13) then select "Deactivate Introscan" and confirm.
Maserati Academy
214
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo
Configuration mode menu
To access the“Configuration” menu, press the MENU button (15), select the icon. the
display will show the following menu:
•
•
•
•
•
Display configuration: to select colour, brightness and used units
Sound: voice command, speech synthesis and buzzer settings
Define vehicle parameters: settings for speed limit, central door locking, twilight
sensor, instrument cluster display and parking sensors.
Set date and time: note: the analogue central dash panel watch is to set manually.
Select language
Maserati Academy
215
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo
Heating, Ventillation and Air Conditionning (HVAC)
The air conditioning/heating system of the GranTurismo provides enhanced air flow
obtained with new and suitably dimensioned air lines.
The system has been designed to assure comfort in all possible weather conditions.
Coolant
The coolant used is R134a. PAG RL - 897
This vehicle system is filled with: 600 ± 20 g of
fluid
Lubricant
The fluid used is Oil Ucon RL897
This vehicle system is filled with: 200 ml ± 10 ml
of fluid.
Compressor
The compressor (1) allows the system to vary
the flow rate of the coolant reaching the
evaporator gradually.
It draws the motion directly from the crankshaft
by means of the poly-V belt (2).
Maserati Academy
216
Introduction to Maserati
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Maserati GranTurismo
Front distribution unit: this is the housing inside which the external air, or
recirculating air, is conditioned and distributed to the vents selected by the user. The
distribution unit houses air flaps
Evaporator: this is a heat exchanger housed in the air distribution unit. It is designed
to draw heat and humidity from the air blown into the passenger compartment, by
exploiting the coolant transformation from the liquid to the gaseous state.
Radiator heater: this is a heat exchanger connected to the cooling circuit of the
engine by means of two lines: one draws the hot water from the engine, the other
allows the coolant to return to the engine. The heater is designed to provide the heat
required to heat up the air blown into the passenger compartment .
Air flap actuators
Air temperature sensors
Pollen filter: this is a combined air filter for the passenger compartment : particles
and active carbons. It is designed to filter the air coming into the passenger
compartment. The first layer (particles) prevents pollens and pollutant particles from
entering the passenger compartment; the second layer (active carbons) reduces bad
odours due to humidity that forms on the surface)
The electric fan is controlled by a 12 V brushless electric motor and is operated at
different speeds by a signal from the NCL (A.C. system node). It is located inside the
air conditioning/heating unit near the evaporator)
Anti-mist sensor: the anti-mist sensor is an electronic device which is designed to
send a control signal to the recirculation flap: When the windscreen mist index
exceeds the preset thresholds, the flap is forced open to allow intake of outside air
regardless of the recirculation mode set by the user. When the windscreen mist
index returns to the preset acceptable values, the recirculation flap resumes the
mode active before this operation. It is fitted on the internal rear-view mirror.
Sunlight sensor: the sunlight sensor measures the thermal energy generated by the
sun. It is positioned on the dashboard near the windscreen. It is a DUAL ZONE
sensor, which ensures optimal control over the air conditioning and heating system
temperatures.
Outside air temperature sensor: this sensor (1) is designed to read the outside air
temperature. It is an NTC sensor fitted inside the external rear view mirror, on the
driver's side. It has an operating range of -40°C / 80°C.
Maserati Academy
217
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo
HVAC node (NCL)
The HVAC node (NCL) (1), located on the right-hand side at the front passenger's feet, is
fitted on the air conditioning/heating unit. It is connected to the low-speed B-CAN network.
The air HVAC node (NCL) receives the following information from the Body Computer
node (NBC), through the CAN network:
•
outside air temperature
•
engine water temperature
•
engine RPM
•
vehicle speed (tachometric signal)
•
battery voltage (battery charge level)
•
heated rear window activation
•
compressor status
•
status of the vehicle lights.
Maserati Academy
218
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo
9. Body
The chassis of the Maserati GranTurismo derives from the Quattroporte, but has a smaller
wheelbase and rear overhang (wheelbase: - 125mm; rear overhang: - 66 mm). It is
composed of high-resistance boxed steel sheets and incorporates a tubular structure in
position with the rear section, which supports the suspension and the differential, and a
front section which supports the suspension and the engine.
Due to the reduced wheelbase, the torsional rigidity of the GranTurismo chassis has been
significantly improved with respect to the Quattroporte.
Different materials and technologies have been used in the construction of the new loadbearing body for optimal weight distribution. The structural component is made of steel,
the lid and the front reinforcement cross member of the bumper is made of aluminium, and
thermo-hardening plastic was used for the luggage compartment (a technology known as
Sheet Molding Compound - SMC)
The luggage compartment is made out of one single piece that incorporates the
aerodynamic lip. As well as offering greater resistance to light impacts and corrosion, the
SMC technology has allowed reducing the weight of the
components and has given the designer the possibility to best express his creative spirit.
The high rigidity values allow the suspension to operate with extreme precision, to the
advantage of dynamic handling, at the same time reducing vibrations and undesired
movements of the internal components. All this amounts to greater driving comfort on any
road surface.
Maserati Academy
219
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati Academy – March 2009
Maserati reserves the right to make any modification to the vehicles described in this manual, at any
time, for either technical or commercial reasons. All rights reserved. This document must not be
reproduced, even partially, without the written consent of Maserati S.p.A.
Maserati Academy
220
Introduction to Maserati
Volume 2
2009 Edition
English version
Training Documentation for Maserati Service Network
Introduction to Maserati
Index
Index
Volume 1
Introduction
2
1.
Introduction to Maserati
•
Historic overview of Maserati
•
The Maserati Company today
•
Maserati road cars
•
Prototypes and Concept cars
•
The Maserati Connection
4
5
17
22
44
48
2.
Maserati models – technical introductions
•
Coupé, Spider & Gransport (M138)
•
Quattroporte (M139)
•
Quattroporte MY09 (M139)
•
GranTurismo (M145)
49
50
60
160
173
Volume 2
•
GranTurismo S (M145)
223
3.
Mechanical components – technical introductions
•
4200 Dry sump engine
•
4200 Wet sump engine
•
4700 Wet sump engine
•
Robotized gearbox
•
ZF automatic gearbox
•
Modular transmission shaft
•
Graziano differential
258
259
279
302
309
347
361
369
4.
Electric and electronic systems
377
5.
Diagnostics
412
Maserati Academy
222
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo S
Maserati GranTurismo S (M145)
Technical Introduction
0.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
General Information
Engine
Clutch
Transmission
Braking System
Driving Controls
Suspensions and Wheels
Safety Components
Electrical Systems and Devices
Body
Maserati Academy
224
230
234
235
241
242
243
245
245
-
223
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo S
0. General Information
The new GranTurismo S (M145GL) is a natural evolution of the Maserati GranTurismo
automatic and incorporates numerous innovative features, including the new 4700 cc
engine and gearbox with super fast MC-Shift strategy.
One year after the launch of the GranTurismo in March 2007, Maserati returns to the
International Motorshow in Geneva with yet another world first, the GranTurismo S, the
ultimate expression of the Trident coupé’s sporting pedigree. This new interpretation of the
perfect balance between sportiness and comfort shifts the emphasis onto performance
and driving enjoyment.
The new 440 hp V8 4.7 engine, electro-actuated gearbox with super fast MC-Shift,
Transaxle layout, sporty exhaust and brakes made with dual-cast technology make the
GranTurismo S the new flagship for Maserati sporting flair, with acceleration from 0 to 100
km/h in just 4.9 seconds and a maximum speed of 295 km/h, the highest ever reached by
a production Maserati.
The compact and lightweight 4.7 litre V8 engine develops maximum power output of 440
HP at 7,000 rpm and peak torque of 490 Nm at 4,750 rpm. It also ensures high specific
power output as well as more torque at lower speeds, without affecting the capacity to up
the revs quickly, a feature typical of racing engines.
The increase in power output and torque has not affected the versatility of the power unit,
which continues to be readily harnessed even during everyday use. It sounds deep and
throaty, but the exhaust valve pneumatic control can also be activated to make it discrete
and subdued.
An electro-actuated 6-speed gearbox is paired with the 4.7 litre V8 engine, and has MCShift software which harnesses the new engine’s power output, ensuring gearshift
performance that is unbeatable within the sports car segment.
Maserati Academy
224
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo S
The engine and gearbox on the Maserati GranTurismo S are arranged in the Transaxle
layout, typical of high-performance sports cars and representing the Maserati
technological DNA. The front-mounted engine and the gearbox, which is located to the
rear, are rigidly connected by a tubular element containing the propshaft. This solution
gives excellent weight distribution, 47% over the front axle and 53% over the rear axle,
which translates into excellent dynamics and top performance. At the wheel, the Maserati
GranTurismo S is more rigid and compact, thanks to the suspension layout developed
specifically to support the new weight distribution. Vehicle roll has been reduced
significantly as a result of the modified springs, dampers and rear torsion bar, and this has
benefited handling and performance.
Maserati Academy
225
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo S
Exterior overview
On the outside, the Maserati GranTurismo S is distinguished by a number of aesthetic
modifications which, although discrete, are highly effective and make the car body appear
sportier without abandoning the sleekness of the lines masterfully designed by Pininfarina.
The spoiler integrated into the boot lid and the new-design side skirts help to improve the
air flows around the car. On top of that, the Maserati GranTurismo S boasts special new
20” rims, which are designed to resemble the Trident, Maserati’s symbol.
The sporty look is complemented by the generously proportioned oval-section exhaust
tailpipes. The radiator grille and headlight casings are black, while the Trident on the grille
and the Saetta logo on the C pillar are decorated with red prongs, in true Maserati racing
tradition.
Maserati Academy
226
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo S
Interior overview
The interior upholstered in Poltrona Frau leather and Alcantara (used for the steering
wheel and centre of the seat with the option to extend to the whole of the headlining)
reflect the sporty flair of the Maserati GranTurismo S; the front and rear seats are
distinguished by their new dynamic design with horizontal piping on the seats and
seatbacks.
As an alternative to the standard leather/Alcantara, classic trim interiors are available in all
Poltrona Frau leather, or in full-grain Pekary leather with a sporty and more refined look.
The Maserati GranTurismo S is available in the same vast range of materials and colours
as the GranTurismo: the standard version is available in Alu Grey or Smoked Quartz,
while upon request it is possible to choose from among three types of wood (Rosewood,
Walnut and Tanganyika wood) and five varnished hues (Piano Black, Sigillo Red, Laque
Blue, Ice White and Decoro Yellow).
This is in addition to a new upholstery option named AluTex, an aluminium-coated
fibreglass fabric with a hi-tech, modern look. What makes AluTex so special is the
autoclave process it undergoes during manufacturing - a fine powder of pure metal is
applied to the surface which gives the fibres an unusual brilliance and three-dimensional
effect.
Maserati Academy
227
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo S
Dimensions and Weights
Dimensions
Length
mm
4,881
Width
mm
1,915
Width (incl. mirrors)
mm
2,056
Height
mm
1,353
Wheelbase
mm
2,942
Front overhang
mm
873
Rear overhang
mm
1066
Front track
mm
1586
Rear track
mm
1590
Dry weight
kg
1780
Kerb weight
kg
1880
Maximum permitted technical weight
kg
2250
Weight distribution
%
47/53
Weights
Maserati Academy
228
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo S
Capacities, performance, fuel consumption and emissions
Capacities
Boot capacity
litres
260
Fuel tank capacity
litres
86 (incl. 14 L reserve)
km/h
295
Acceleration 0 - 100 km/h
s
4.9
Acceleration to 400m from standstill
s
13
km/h
180
s
23
km/h
233
s
8.65
m
35
Vehicle performance
Top speed
Exit speed
Acceleration 0-1000 m
Exit speed
Pickup 80-120 km/h in 6th gear
Stopping distance from 100-0 km/h
Fuel consumption and CO2 emissions
Urban driving cycle
L/100 km / g/km
25.21 / 567
Extra-urban driving cycle
L/100 km / g/km
11.36 / 270
Combined driving cycle
L/100 km / g/km
15.8 / 377
Maserati Academy
229
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo S
1. Engine
The main technical innovation on the Maserati GranTurismo S lives under the bonnet,
where the latest version of the new family of wet-sump power units is fitted (F136YE).
The new and more powerful 4.7 litre V8 engine is capable of developing power output of
440 HP at 7,000 rpm and peak torque of 490 Nm at 4,750 rpm.
In keeping with the philosophy of the most recent Maserati engines, the 4.7 litre power unit
adopts a lubrication system with wet sump, first introduced with the launch of the
Quattroporte Automatica, and also adopted on the GranTurismo with automatic
transmission and now applied for the first time on a model fitted with an electro-actuated
gearbox.
Compared with the previous dry sump solution, the wet sump uses fewer pumps to
recover the oil and reduces operating noise considerably, to the benefit of driving comfort
and improved balance between comfort and performance.
Recognisable on the outside by the red cylinder head covers, the new 4.7 L engine was
developed specifically to increase the car's performance and provide the driver of the
Maserati GranTurismo S with an even more exhilarating driving experience.
The new engine is ready to comply with future Euro-5 regulations for Europe and LEV2
regulations for the USA.
Maserati Academy
230
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo S
Engine control system:
The GranTurismo uses the same Motronic ME7.1.1 engine control system as used on the
GranTurismo with automatic transmission. Mapping is however specific to obtain an
increased power output.
On the GranTurismo S, a new plug-in type air flow meter is used: the Bosch HFM7. The
HFM7 air flow meter can be easily identified from the HFM5 type meter due to the new
connector design.
Mounting plate
Plug-in type mass air flow
meter with integrated intake
air temperature sensor
Pin-out HFM7 air flow meter:
1. Ground
2. 5V reference voltage
3. 12V power supply
4. Intake air temperature analogue signal
5. Mass air flow analogue signal
Maserati Academy
231
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo S
Except from the new sensor design, the air flow meter used on F136YE engine is
characterised by the absence of an air flow strainer. The task of an air flow strainer is to
ensure a regular and laminar air flow inside the sensor duct. At the same time the strainer
also forms an obstruction to the incoming air flow.
By eliminating the strainer, a power advantage of 7-8 hp is obtained thanks to a more free
air flow.
The absence of the strainer will cause turbulences in the sensor duct which translates into
an unreliable mass air flow signal. For this reason the mass air flow is no longer the main
parameter to calculate the injection quantity, but will only be used to apply corrections on
the fuel quantity. Instead, throttle position and engine speed are used as main
parameters. This modification implicates a specific calibration of the engine control
software.
Exhaust
The Maserati GranTurismo S gives a voice to its 440 HP with a special sporty exhaust
system, designed to emphasise the deep throaty growl of the new V8 engine, but also
provide the level of on-board comfort expected from a GranTurismo.
The steel exhaust system consists of two exhaust lines, one for each bank of cylinders,
compensated with a central silencer. Two pneumatic valves, controlled electronically by
the engine control unit and operated by the driver through the "Sport" button on the centre
dashboard, are fitted close to the two rear silencers.
Maserati Academy
232
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo S
In aesthetic terms, the modified design
of the two exhausts with dual oval
chrome tailpipes make the new system
instantly recognisable.
As on all Maserati models, the Maserati
GranTurismo S adopts an exhaust
system with metallic rather than ceramic
catalytic converters. This solution
reduces the density of the cells inside
the catalytic converters and as a result
lessens the section resistant to exhaust
gas flow.
In normal conditions the valves are closed, forcing the exhaust gases along a long and
tortuous route so that they lose their energy and are emitted outwards with very little
noise. This all changes when the "Sport" button is pressed: the valves which were initially
closed, open up through a pneumatic control and the flow of exhaust gases is channelled
down a route that leads directly to the outside. This provides enthusiasts with a distinctive
resonance.
BY-PASS VALVE
CLOSED
BY-PASS VALVE
OPEN
Maserati Academy
233
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo S
2. Clutch
For the GranTurismo S, the clutch has been modified with respect to the clutch as used
on the latest Maserati variant with robotized transmission (M139 MY06 Duoselect).
This new cluch, indicated as “Ribbed Finger”, has a newly designed diaphragm spring and
new friction material in order to reduce noise and wear.
The main characteristics of the clutch have remained unchanged: dry twin-plate, 215 mm
disc with hydraulic control. The PIS value has remained unchanged at 4,2 mm (327 bit).
The clutch position sensor is new with improved thermal isolation for the wiring harnas.
The clutch housing has been redesigned and contains now a clutch support shaft with
double support bearing. This solution reduces bearing noise and wear.
Maserati Academy
234
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo S
3. Transmission
The GranTurismo S has a robotized manual transmission with an innovative super fast
gearshift strategy (MC-SuperFast). The system layout is of the transaxle type with the
longitudinal engine front-mounted behind the front axle, rigidly connected by means of a
steel tube to the longitudinal gearbox, which is rear-mounted in unit with the differential.
This gearbox is an evolution of the Quattroporte Duoselect gearbox. See chapter 3
“Mechanical Components” for more details.
•
•
•
•
Robotized gearbox electro-actuated 6-speed transmission, with hydraulic
management operated electronically using the paddles mounted behind the steering
wheel, integral with the steering column. Triple-cone synchronisers on 1st and 2nd,
and double cone on 3rd, 4th, 5th and 6th.
Steel 20 mm propshaft flexibly supported on four bearings inside an engine-gearbox
connection pipe.
Segmented limited-slip differential with asymmetrical lock factor (25% in traction,
45% in release).
Maserati Stability Program (MSP), integrating traction control (ASR), release torque
regulation (MSR), anti-lock braking (ABS) and electronic brake force distribution
(EBD).
Transmission gear ratios:
Gear
Ratio
1
3.21
2
2.05
3
1.43
4
1.1
5
0.9
6
0.76
R
3.29
Final drive ratio: 4.18
Maserati Academy
235
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo S
Electronic gearbox control GranTurismo S:
The transmission of the GranTurismo S is equipped with the Sofast 4 electronic control
system (CFC 301). The gearbox has two main operating modes: MANUAL and AUTO.
Both modes can be overlapped with the SPORT function, which makes gear changes
quicker. In particular, in MANUAL+SPORT mode the Maserati GranTurismo S activates
the innovative MC-SuperFast gearshift function.
The Maserati GranTurismo S Robotized gearbox system has a total of six operating
modes:
•
Manual Normal
•
Manual Sport
•
Manual Sport with MC-SuperFast shift
•
Auto Normal
•
Auto Sport
•
Ice
MC_S
Superprestazionale
r
p
m
SPORT Prestazionale
NORMAL
Comfort
Pedale acceleratore
Manual-Normal mode:
In MANUAL NORMAL mode the choice of gear lies solely with the driver. To ensure
greater driving enjoyment the system holds the gear when the limiter is reached; the
control unit merely checks that the gear requested matches engine speed, so as to avoid
taking it beyond the limiter when shifting down, or below the minimum speed when shifting
up.
With engine speed above 4,000 rpm and the accelerator depressed through more than
80% of its travel, the fuel cut-off strategy is activated on each gear change: during the
gearshift this function shortens the time taken to discharge torque and limits engine speed
reduction, enabling quicker gearshifts.
Maserati Academy
236
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo S
Manual-Sport mode:
In MANUAL mode, pressing the SPORT button causes the transmission control system to
adopt a more performance-oriented gearshift strategy, with much shorter times to change
between one ratio and another.
When moving down to lower gears, each shift is accompanied by a more pronounced
double de-clutching effect.
MC-SuperFast Shift:
The MC-SuperFast gearshift function is the most recent innovation of the electro-actuated
Robotized gearbox system: this mode exploits the elastic energy of the transmission parts
and delivers top performance in terms of gearshift times. This means that the shift time
(calculated as the break in acceleration) drops to 100 ms, ensuring maximum sports
characteristics and exhilarating driving.
Gearshift time
MC -SuperFAST
Break in acceleration
drops to 100ms
t1
t2
t3
time
Gear engagement time: 40ms
The Robotized gearbox management software enables gear engagement/ disengagement
to take place in parallel with the opening/closing of the clutch. In this way the gearshift
time, which is calculated according to the acceleration gap (and not just the time it takes to
engage the gear) is reduced by activating the various operations at overlapping times:
1.
Torque interruption and clutch disengagement (t1)
2.
Gear disengagement, selection and engagement (t2)
3.
Clutch engagement and torque recovery (t3)
Maserati Academy
237
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo S
SuperFast shift is available only when shifting up and in Sport mode. With regard to
gearbox hardware, in order to support SuperFast shift the hydraulic pump has been
oversized to be able to deliver the increased pressure of the system, which under extreme
conditions is twice as high compared to conventional use. A direct wire connection has
been installed between the transmission control unit and the engine control unit, to
increase the communication speed with respect to the conventional CAN communication
line.
When is MC-SuperFast shift available?
SuperFast shift is only available in MANUAL SPORT mode.
With the vehicle in a steady state with hydraulic circuit oil and engine coolant at operating
temperature and the clutch at normal operating temperature, in Manual Sport mode the
letters MC-S light up on the dashboard display.
Moreover, the following conditions must are present:
•
Engine speed > 5500 rpm
•
Accelerator pedal fully depressed (>80%)
•
Lateral acceleration <0.9g
•
ASR inactive
•
No wheel slip present
If one or more of the conditions above are not met, a normal gearshift occurs instead of a
superfast gearshift.
Note: there is no Superfast shift for downshifting
Maserati Academy
238
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo S
Auto-Normal mode:
In Auto mode the gear change is managed completely automatically by the transmission
electronic control system. The control unit determines engine speed and moment of the
shift as well as its speed, based on parameters such as vehicle speed, engine speed and
the driver's request for torque and power. In AUTO mode a gear can also be requested
manually through the paddles behind the steering wheel (gear suggestion).
The system recognises the type of driver by means of functions that assess the driver's
style of driving through lateral and longitudinal acceleration and accelerator pedal
movement. If a sportier driving style is recognised, the "UP" shifts are moved to a higher
number of engine revs. The control system also recognises the type of road, adapting
gear changes when the road climbs or falls, on a bend, in town and on motorways.
AUTO NORMAL mode is the mode most designed for comfort: changing to a higher gear
is required as soon as possible in order to obtain the lowest level of vibrations and
acoustic return from the engine. Shifting is managed in such a way as to ensure that gear
changes are ultra-smooth. This mode also ensures lower fuel consumption when
combined with a normal and non-aggressive driving style.
This does not mean, however, having to give up on the car's sporty nature: during sports
driving, with frequent opening of the throttle, gearshift speeds approach those of the
AUTO SPORT mode.
In AUTO mode, the engaged gear will be indicated on the info display on the instrument
cluster.
Auto-Sport mode:
AUTO SPORT mode is activated with the transmission in auto mode and by pressing the
SPORT button located on the centre dashboard: gear changing is still managed
automatically by the transmission control unit, but by varying the speed of the operations
to open up and reduce torque, disengage, select and engage gear, close the clutch and
restore engine torque. The result is a faster gear change and a more sporty driving feel.
Compared to AUTO NORMAL mode, shifting up takes place at higher engine speeds,
whereas moving down a gear is accompanied by a more pronounced double de-clutching
effect.
Maserati Academy
239
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo S
Ice mode:
This mode can be used on particularly slippery road surfaces (snow, ice), or more
generally in low-grip conditions. It is activated through the ICE button located on the
centre tunnel. When switched on, the system avoids having to run the engine at more than
3,000 rpm.
ICE mode takes priority over SPORT and MSP OFF modes: this means that when the
driver requests the ICE mode, Sport mode is deactivated automatically (if it was on) and
the stability control (MSP) restored (if previously deactivated).
Automatic mode with Easy-exit:
The default configuration of the gearbox is Automatic mode. If requested, the Auto mode
can be switched off (and Manual mode activated) by pushing the “Auto” button on the
centre console.
If the engine is switched of with the gearbox in Manual mode, at the next engine start the
system will activate the “Automatic with Easy-exit” configuration. This configuration will
last for two minutes during which the “Auto” indication on the info display will flash.
If during this period while the car is driving a gear is selected manually, the gearbox will
exit the Auto mode en go to Manual mode. If during this time no gearchange request is
made, the gearbox will go to Auto mode.
Note: for what concerns the “Sport” and “Ice” modes, at engine restart the robotized
gearbox configuration is the same as when the engine was switched off.
Maserati Academy
240
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo S
4. Braking System
The Maserati GranTurismo S is fitted with a high-performance brake system, which uses
dual-cast technology for the front brake discs, developed in collaboration with Brembo and
used for the first time in the automotive field on the Maserati Quattroporte Sport GT S.
In contrast to conventional cast-iron discs, the dual-cast disc consists of a cast-iron
braking ring and an aluminium hub, making it possible to combine the advantages offered
by cast iron's performance at temperature with the aluminium's light weight.
At the front, the dual-cast discs (360 x 32 mm) are combined with six-piston aluminium
monobloc brake calipers of differentiated diameter (30/34/36 mm), with Ferodo HP1000
pads. The monobloc calipers are more resistant to deformation than calipers made of two
parts; this means that lighter materials, in this case aluminium, can be used and
component weight minimised even further. The caliper is also more efficient at any
operating pressure and this translates into lighter use of the pedal use when braking.
At the rear, 330 x 28 mm discs are fitted with 4-piston calipers of differentiated diameter
(32/36 mm), and Jurid 673 GG pads.
The brake calipers fitted as standard on the Maserati GranTurismo S are red. The
customer may personalise the colour of the calipers by selecting from one of a further 5
alternative shades: Titanium and Yellow for a more sporty look, Silver and Blue for a more
elegant configuration, or the classic Black.
The braking system in the Maserati GranTurismo S also features ABS, which prevents the
wheels from locking up when braking, and EBD for better distribution of braking force
between the front and rear wheels, both integrated with MSP Bosch version 8.0.
Maserati Academy
241
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo S
MSP system:
The GranTurismo S is fitted with the Bosch ESP 8.0 system which incorporates the
following functions: ABS, EBD, TCS, ASR, ESP and Hill Holder.
Functionality is identical to the system used in other Maserati vehicles.
Electric Parking Brake (EPB)
The Maserati GranTurismo S is equipped with Electric Parking Brake (EPB)
5. Driving Controls
Steering
Rack and pinion steering box with speedsensitive hydraulic power steering, on-road
steering ratio of 64 mm per turn.
Steering diameter (from pavement to
pavement): 10.7 m.
Gearshift paddles behind the steering wheel
are longer as those on the standard
GranTurismo model to improve the control
during cornering.
Maserati Academy
242
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo S
6. Suspensions and Wheels
Single-rating sports suspension to enhance the sporty driving feel
The Maserati GranTurismo S offers the same suspension layout as the 4.2 L engine
version. However, it also features a special development designed to really exploit the
greater power output of the 4.7 V8 and harness the capabilities offered by the Transaxle
system.
The Maserati GranTurismo S is fitted as standard with fixed-rating steel dampers modified
with the introduction of new springs and dampers, which offer 10% more damping force
and are repositioned in terms of compression/extension ratio so as to match the car's
different specification. The diameter of the rear torsion bar has also been increased to
make it more rigid.
These modifications have resulted in a 10% reduction in body roll which, combined with
the excellent weight distribution, makes the Maserati GranTurismo S particularly agile and
responsive to driver instructions: in a succession of bends it appears quick and intuitive
when entering and finding the centre of the bend and speedy when negotiating the bend.
Furthermore, the driver can accelerate earlier when coming out of the bend due to the
reduced load transfers.
As an alternative to the standard fixed-rating suspension, the Maserati GranTurismo S
may be provided, upon request, with Skyhook electronic control suspensions featuring
aluminium body dampers with continuous damping variation; in this case the hardware
modifications are accompanied by special management software.
Maserati Academy
243
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo S
Optional Skyhook suspension:
The Skyhook electronic suspension management system is able to continuously monitor
the suspension damping: the system acts through acceleration sensors which record the
movements of each wheel and thus ensure that any surface unevenness is absorbed and
the highest level of comfort guaranteed.
A further advantage of the Skyhook electronic suspension control system is that the driver
can choose from two different settings: Normal, which allows travel with the highest level
of driving comfort, and Sport, which gives a harder ride setting with more reduced roll
angles and load transfers, thereby enhancing the agility and stability of the car body. In
the Sport configuration the handling of the Maserati GranTurismo S is comparable with
that guaranteed by fixed-rating dampers.
Wheels and tyres
20" diameter wheels in light alloy fitted as standard.
-
Front wheels 8.5J x 20" H2 profile with 245/35
R20 front tyres.
-
Rear wheels 10.5J x 20” H2 profile with 285/35
R20 rear tyres.
Vehicle alignment
CONFIGURATION
FRONT
REAR
Tyres
245/40 ZR19 (opt)
245/35 ZR20
285/40 ZR19 (opt)
285/35 ZR20
Pressure
2.2 bar
2.2 bar
Wheels
8.5 J x 19” (opt)
8.5 J x 20”
10.5 J x 19” (opt)
10.5 J x 20”
Camber
-0°30’ +/- 0°10’
-1°30’ +/- 0°10’
Toe
-2.1 +/- 0.4 mm
+4.2 +/- 0.4 mm
Caster
+4°03'36"+-0°10'
Overall height
165 +/- 5 mm
152 +/- 5 mm
Track
1585.2 mm
1589.8 mm
Wheelbase
2940.2 mm
Steering angle
Int. 34.15°/ext.40.2°
Static load configuration: full fluid levels (including fuel) plus 75+75 kg on the front seats.
Maserati Academy
244
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo S
7. Safety Components
In analogy with the MY09 Quattroporte model, also the GranTurismo will introduce the
new “intelligent LRD”-type front passenger airbag.
This new type of airbag is fitted on the new GranTurismo S 4.7L Automatic and will shortly
after be introduced on the existing GranTurismo 4.2L Automatic and GranTurismo S
models. See the part of the MY09 Quattroporte for more detailed information.
Note: all airbags are specific for each model, as they are tailored on the interior design.
8. Electrical systems and Devices
Parking sensors
With the ignition key in the ON position, the front and rear parking sensors are activated
automatically when reverse gear is engaged.
If the car is equipped with front sensors, these sensors can be activated by pressing
button A; when the front sensors are active, the button is backlit with an amber light. To
switch off the front sensors, press A once again. All the sensors remain active when
reverse gear is disengaged. The rear sensors remain active for 60 seconds until the
vehicle speed reaches around 18 km/h. The front sensors remain active until the vehicle
speed reaches around 18 km/h (11 mph). On activation of the front or rear sensors, a
beeper warns the driver that the system is active. When the sensors are on, the system
begins emitting beeps as soon as an obstacle is detected. The beep frequency increases
as the vehicle approaches the obstacle. The beeps are emitted from two beepers, one
located under the dashboard (if the vehicle is equipped with front sensors) and one near to
the luggage space (if the vehicle is equipped with rear sensors). When the obstacle is less
than 35 cm from the bumper, a continuous beep is emitted. The beep stops immediately if
the distance from the obstacle increases.
The tone cycles remain constant if the distance measured by the central sensors remains
unchanged. However if the same situation occurs with the side sensors, the beep is
interrupted after 7 seconds, to avoid continuous beeping when manoeuvring along a wall,
for example.
Maserati Academy
245
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo S
The distance from the obstacles can also be viewed on the instrument panel by means of
a graphic display, which shows the vehicle surrounded by symbols indicating the detected
obstacle's distance (maximum, medium and minimum distance) and position (front/rear,
central/side). The colour represents the distance, the field represents the position. The
maximum detected distance is displayed in green, the medium in yellow and the minimum
in red. If the vehicle is only equipped with rear sensors, the front sensors are omitted from
the graphic display. If the vehicle is equipped with front and rear sensors and only the
front sensors are active, the rear sensors are omitted from the graphic display.
Stop &Go function
The car is equipped with a Stop &Go function, which can be activated by means of the
Multimedia System. The Stop &Go function can be enabled/disabled from the “Setup”
menu, by selecting the option “Define vehicle parameters”, selecting the Stop&Go parking
option and changing the setting to "ON". With the Stop &Go function active, the front
sensors are automatically activated whenever the vehicle speed drops below 18 km/h (11
mph).
WARNING: The Stop&Go function is only available when front parking sensors are
installed.
The sensors enable the system to monitor the front and back of the vehicle; their position
covers the median and side zones of the vehicle, both at the front and rear ends. If an
obstacle is located in the median zone, it is detected at distances of less than 0.9 m to the
front and 1.5 m to the rear, according to the type of obstacle and in proportion to its
dimensions. If the obstacle is positioned in the side zone, it is detected at distances of less
than 0.8 m.
Maserati Academy
246
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo S
Maserati Multimedia system: Bluetooth technology
The MMS uses Bluetooth technology, which means that the system can be connected to a
Bluetooth-enabled mobile phone. The connection enables the MMS to be used for making
or receiving calls (by means of the hands-free function), and for managing the mobile
phone address book. The connection can be established in two ways:
1. By pairing a mobile phone with the MMS.
2. By linking a stored mobile phone to the MMS.
The mobile phone only has to be paired with the MMS on the first connection.
Pairing can only be done from the mobile phone; it cannot be done from the MMS
interface, since the system is not configured to search for Bluetooth devices. Linking a
stored mobile phone connects the MMS to a phone which has already been paired with
the system. A link must be established each time that the user wishes to operate the
Bluetooth mobile phone via the MMS. Unlike pairing, this operation can be performed
either from the mobile phone or from the MMS.
Pairing a mobile phone
WARNING: Before proceeding with the connection, consult the user guide of the mobile
phone to be paired with the MMS system.
To pair a phone with the system, the Bluetooth function must be activated on both
devices. To prepare the MMS for pairing with a mobile phone, proceed as follows:
- switch on the mobile phone; - turn the ignition key to ON without starting the engine;
- switch on the MMS by pressing the rotary knob 20; to activate the Bluetooth pairing
function on the mobile phone, refer to the instructions in the user guide supplied with the
phone. During the pairing operation, the phone requests a PIN code from the user, see
page 5 “Authentication code”. If the code is entered correctly, the connection between the
two devices is established. Depending on which address book synchronisation mode is
set, see page 5 “Address book synchronisation mode”, address book contacts stored in
the mobile phone can be browsed directly from the MMS. Once the connection is
established, a message appears on the MMS display informing the user that the pairing
operation is complete.
The MMS can be paired with up to 10 devices. If 10 paired devices are already stored in
the system, to store a new one simply select a listed device, which will be deleted in
favour of the new device.
Maserati Academy
247
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo S
Bluetooth main screen
Press the MODE button, or press the MENU button and select Telematic mode, to access
the Bluetooth screen, see Fig. 1. The screen indicates the following parameters:
A) connection status
B) network operator
C) name of the paired device
D) battery charge level
E) roaming indicator (if enabled)
Disconnection
The Bluetooth connection may be interrupted in one of three ways:
1. By interrupting the connection from the mobile phone, following the steps described
in the corresponding user guide, or by switching the mobile phone off;
2. By means of the MMS interface.
4
“List of connected devices”;
3. By moving the Bluetooth-enabled phone away from the MMS so that the signal
leaves the MMS reception area. Disconnection is indicated by the pop-up message
shown in Fig. 2.
Maserati Academy
248
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo S
Disconnecting the telephone does not delete the list of calls stored in the call log. To
delete the list, proceed as follows:
- press the MENU button
- select icon A and confirm by pressing the rotary knob
- select and confirm, by pressing the rotary knob, the “Telephone Functions" option;
- select and confirm, by pressing the rotary knob, the “Delete call log”, option,
see Fig. 3. The log will not be deleted until the operation has been confirmed a second
time.
Icon A
Switching on the MMS
Each time that the MMS is switched on and provided that Bluetooth mode is active, the
system searches for previously paired devices (stored in the memory). The search begins
with the last paired device and moves on to previous devices in chronological order.
The search ends when the MMS detects a paired phone and establishes the connection,
or when it detects an unpaired phone. In the latter case, to establish a connection, first
pair the telephone by selecting ”PAIR TELEPHONE”. If the system fails to find a device,
the search ends and the Bluetooth function is disabled.
Making and receiving calls
Calls can be managed either from the mobile telephone or from the MMS. The MMS
display indicates the status of the active call, whether incoming and outgoing. To make an
outgoing call from the MMS, open the Call menu as follows:
- press button (4) or
- in Telematic mode press the RH rotary knob (13)
-in Telematic mode, select and confirm the "Call" function using the RH rotary knob (13).
The display shows the following functions:
- Call list
- Dial
- Directory
Maserati Academy
249
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo S
Functions linked to Bluetooth mode
In the Telematic mode menu you will find “Bluetooth functions”
Bluetooth functions
Select “Bluetooth functions” by rotating the knob (13), then press to confirm and access
the following functions (see Fig. below)
- Bluetooth activation modes
- List of connected devices
- Change the system Bluetooth name
- Authentication code
- Address book synchronisation mode
Maserati Academy
250
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo S
Bluetooth activation modes
Use this menu to select the Bluetooth operation mode from the following options:
-Off
- On and visible
-On and hidden
Off
When this function is selected, Bluetooth is disabled and therefore the system cannot
detect any devices.
On and visible.
The MMS is configured to connect with previously stored devices or to pair with new
devices. Note that the MMS only permits new pairings when no link is established with a
previously stored device. The MMS can only be linked with one mobile phone at a time;
further linkup requests will be ignored.
On and hidden
The MMS is configured to connect with previously stored devices, but not to pair with new
devices.
Maserati Academy
251
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo S
List of connected devices
This menu displays the list of paired devices. The devices are listed in chronological order,
starting with the most recently connected device. If a listed device is paired with the
system, the corresponding item will be highlighted. If an active link is established with a
listed device, this will be indicated by means of an icon on the display. At the bottom of the
screen (see Fig. 7), the following four buttons are displayed:
- Connect/disconnect.
- Delete.
- Delete all.
- OK.
Connect/disconnect:
Use the rotary knob (13) to select the item corresponding to the telephone that you wish to
connect/disconnect. This function is used to connect or disconnect the telephone from the
MMS.
Delete :
Select this option to delete the selected telephone from the list of stored devices.
Delete all :
Select this option to delete the entire list of stored devices.
Ok :
Select this option to close the window without making any changes.
Maserati Academy
252
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo S
Change the system Bluetooth name
Select this function by rotating and pressing the rotary knob (13), to change the name that
the MMS assigns to the mobile phone during and after pairing. The buttons at the bottom
of the screen control the operations relating to this function. The screen corresponding to
this function is shown in Fig. 8. To exit the function and save the new name, confirm the
selection by pressing “OK"
Authentication code
Select this function by rotating and pressing the rotary knob (13), to change the PIN code
which must be inputted on the mobile phone during connection to the MMS. If you need to
correct the code during input, select the "Correct" button located at the bottom of the
screen. To exit this function and save the new code, confirm the selection by pressing
“OK”.
Address book synchronisation mode
Use this function to download address book contacts so that they can also be browsed
from the MMS.
Maserati Academy
253
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo S
The options available on the corresponding screen are:
- No synchronisation
-View address book
-View address book on SIM card
-View all address books
Depending on which function is enabled, contacts stored in the mobile phone address
book will be downloaded onto the MMS during the pairing operation. Downloaded contacts
may then also be consulted from the MMS.
Successful/failed download operations are indicated by the relevant pop-up message on
the display.
Address Book Menu
In the Address Book menu you will find an “Exchange using Bluetooth” function, see Fig.
10, which enables contacts in the mobile phone address book to be downloaded to the
MMS address book. Use the rotary knob (13) to select and confirm this function. The
display then lists the following options:
-Get all elements
-Get one element
Get all elements :
Select this option to copy all the addresses and numbers in the mobile phone address
book. During the operation, a message indicates that copying is in progress.
To interrupt the operation, press ESC.
Get one element :
Select this option to copy a specific entry from the mobile phone address book to the MMS
address book. When this function is opened, the display lists all entries stored in the
mobile phone address book. Use the right-hand knob (13) to select and confirm the entry
that you wish to copy. During the operation, a message indicates that copying is in
progress.
Maserati Academy
254
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo S
USB port full
The USB port is located inside the glove box. It allows for the exchange of data and the
recharging of connected sources. If the connected memory stick contains MP3 files, these
files are played automatically. This does not occur if another music source is currently
selected. In this case, select the USB function by repeatedly pressing the Source button
(2). In any case, playback always begins after the memory stick has been read by the
system. The time taken for the read operation depends on the type of content stored in the
USB device.
The USB screen shows the following information:
A - name of the folder containing the file being played;
B - status of the Introscan/Random/Repeat functions;
C - number of the file being played and total number of files;
D - elapsed playing time of the current track;
E - track title and album title (if available).
Maserati Academy
255
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo S
Select album
With USB mode active, press button (14) to select the next album. Press the button again
to move forward by one album. Alternatively, press button (7) to select the previous album
Select track
To select a track, proceed as follows:
Next track:
-briefly press button (11).
Previous track:
-briefly press button (16).
To replay the current track; press again to select the previous track.
USB mode menu
Repeatedly press the MODE button (22) until USB mode is displayed. Press the rotary
knob (13) to display the following menu:
- Copy USB to Jukebox
- Remove USB
- Introscan ON
- Random ON
- Repeat ON
Copy USB to Jukebox
Confirm this function by pressing the rotary knob (13), to display a submenu containing
the following options:
-All content
- Select multiple
- Current album
- Current track
Maserati Academy
256
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati GranTurismo S
During the copy operation, the REC icon appears on the display and the only functioning
source in Audio mode is the Radio. This menu may be opened from the main menu (press
the MENU button 15), by selecting the “Audio functions” mode and then “USB” from
among the listed options.
Remove USB
This function enables the USB stick to be removed from the port. It generates a pop-up
message authorising the user to proceed. Do not remove the USB stick without first
enabling this disconnect function. Failure to do so may result in data loss.
Introscan ON
Select and confirm this function to listen to a preview of all the tracks contained in the USB
stick, in their listed order. To disable this function, press the rotary knob (13) then select
“Introscan OFF” and confirm.
Random ON
Select and confirm this function to listen to tracks from the USB stick in random order;
when this mode is active, the letters RDM are shown on the display. To turn this function
off, press the rotary knob (13) then select “Random OFF” and confirm.
Repeat ON
Select this function using the rotary knob (13) to play a folder / album repeatedly. To
disable this function, press the rotary knob (13), then select “Repeat OFF” and confirm.
LIST function
Displays a list of albums stored in the memory stick which is currently plugged into the
USB port. To activate this function, press the LIST button (12) during playback in USB
mode. To access a particular track list, select the desired album using the rotary knob (13)
and press to confirm. To play a track from the list, select the desired track using the rotary
knob (13) and press to confirm.
Maserati Academy
257
Introduction to Maserati
3
Mechanical Components
Technical introductions
Maserati Academy
258
Introduction to Maserati
4200 Dry Sump Engine
4200 Dry Sump Engine
Maserati Academy
259
Introduction to Maserati
4200 Dry Sump Engine
INTRODUCTION
With the introduction of the F136 engine family in 2001, a new technical area started for
Maserati. After a period of more than 10 years in which only turbocharged engines were
produced, Maserati returned to normally aspirated engines.
This was also the first Maserati engine which was not produced in-house. Assembly of this
engine was carried out by group partner Ferrari in Maranello, at about 20 km from the
Maserati factory. This new engine was the result of a close technical collaboration
between Maserati engineers and their colleagues from Maranello and is technically an
absolute masterpiece.
Compact and light design; four overhead camshafts and 48 valves with a small valve
angle; dry sump lubrication system to lower the center of gravity and allow sufficient
lubrication in even the most extrem conditions; nicasil-coated aluminium cylinder liners…
all aspects which are usually reserved for racing engines.
This engine is found in the complete M138 model range (F136R) and in a slightly modified
version (F136S) also in the M139 model with Duoselect transmission.
Maserati Academy
260
Introduction to Maserati
4200 Dry Sump Engine
ENGINE CHARACTERISTICS:
•
All-alloy 90° V8 over-bore engine with competition pedigree, compact and light
construction.
•
Stepless variable valve timing with timing variators on both intake camshafts. This
system is operated by means of a high pressure hydraulic system (12-14 bar). A
dedicated high pressure pump is driven by the camshaft and a hydraulic pressure
accumulator is located underneath the intake manifold.
•
Hardened aluminium/silicon alloy cylinder heads with high volumetric and
thermodynamic efficiency combustion chamber.
•
Hardened aluminium/silicon alloy crankcase with pressed-in nikasil cylinder liners.
•
Single-cast crankshaft in hardened steel, individually balanced, resting on five main
journals.
•
Four overhead camshafts (two per bank) and four valves per cylinder, driven by
hydraulic tappets.
•
Chain-driven timing system, with hydraulic tensioners.
•
Lubrication system with dry sump, oil/water exchanger incorporated into the upper
crankcase (inside the V-angle).
•
Aluminium intake manifold for F136R version.
•
Plastic intake manifold, with optimised line lengths for F136S version.
•
Integrated Bosch Motronic ME7 ignition-injection with motor drive throttle.
Maserati Academy
261
Introduction to Maserati
4200 Dry Sump Engine
SPECIFICATIONS F136R:
Vehicle ID code
M138
Cycle
Otto
Cylinder number and position
8-90° V
Number of valves per cylinder
4
Bore and stroke
92x79.8 mm
Total displacement
4244 cm3
Compression ratio
11.058 ± 0.2:1
Max power (EEC)
287 kW – 390 HP
Corresponding speed
7000 rpm
Max Torque (EEC)
451 Nm - 45.9 Kgm
Corresponding speed
4500 rpm
Valve diameter
Intake
37.8 mm
Exhaust
31.0 mm
Engine timing
Intake
-15°/66° ± 1°
Exhaust
-35°/ 6° ± 1°
Crank angle
90°
Engine RPM in idle (95°C)
800 rpm
Normal lubrication pressure
at 100°C/6000 rpm
5-6 bar
Engine control system
Bosch Motronic ME7.1.1
Ignition
static ignition
Ignition sequence:
1-8-6-2-7-3-4-5
Ignition coil:
Bosch ZS-K-1X1E
Spark plugs
NGK PMR8A
Alternator
Denso 12 V - 150 A
Battery
FIAM 12V 100Ah - 850A
Maserati Academy
262
Introduction to Maserati
4200 Dry Sump Engine
SPECIFICATIONS F136S:
Vehicle ID code
M139
Cycle
Otto
Cylinder number and position
8-90° V
Number of valves per cylinder
4
Bore and stroke
92 x 79.8 mm
Total displacement
4244 cm3
Compression ratio
11.058 ± 0.2:1
Max power (EEC)
295 kW – 400 hp
Corresponding speed
7250 rpm
Max Torque (EEC)
442 Nm - 45 Kgm
Corresponding RPM
4750 rpm
Valve diameter
Intake
37.8 mm
Exhaust
31.0 mm
Valve upstroke without play
Intake
10.5 ± 0.05 mm
Exhaust
9.3 ± 0.05 mm
Engine timing
Intake
-15°/66°± 1°
Exhaust
-41°/ 0°± 1°
Crank angle
90°
Engine RPM in idle (95°C)
800 RPM
Normal lubrication pressure
at 100°C/6000 RPM
5-6 bar
Engine control system
Bosch Motronic ME7
Ignition
static ignition
Ignition sequence:
1-8-6-2-7-3-4-5
Ignition coil:
Bosch ZS-K-1X1E
Spark plugs
NGK PMR8A
Alternator
Denso 12 v - 150 A
Battery
FIAM 12V 100Ah - 850A
Maserati Academy
263
Introduction to Maserati
4200 Dry Sump Engine
ENGINE PERFORMANCE CURVES
Maserati Academy
264
Introduction to Maserati
4200 Dry Sump Engine
ENGINE VIEWS (F136)
Maserati Academy
265
Introduction to Maserati
4200 Dry Sump Engine
ENGINE VIEWS (F136S)
Maserati Academy
266
Introduction to Maserati
4200 Dry Sump Engine
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
The lubrication system is made up an external
oil tank (dry sump) and external, multiple oil
pump. The oil pump is driven by the crackshaft
my means of a chain the water pump is
incorporated in the oil pump and forms a single
unit. This construction allows a low engine
position in the vehicle chassis and guarantees
adequate lubrication, even in case of very high
lateral acceleration forces.
1. Engine oil tank
2. Oil/water heat exchanger
3. Water/oil pump
4. Oil filter
5. Line from oil tank to water/oil pump
6. Line from heat exchanger to oil tank
Pump unit: this geared unit is composed of three purge pumps and one intake pump.
Cooling system: the water/oil heat exchanger (2) is incorporated into the engine
assembly.
Oil tank: the engine oil tank (1) is made of aluminium sheet and is located on the righthand side of the engine compartment. It isequipped with dipstick and filler neck.
Oil level check procedure:
•
Make sure the vehicle is on a flat surface.
•
Start up the engine and wait until it reaches the correct operating temperature (water
temperature: 90°C)
•
Check the oil level with engine idling by using the dipstick on the filling tap.
•
The oil level should reach the MAX. reference on the dipstick. Top up if necessary.
Maserati Academy
267
Introduction to Maserati
4200 Dry Sump Engine
COOLING SYSTEM
1. Water/oil pump
2. Thermostatic valve
3. Radiator
4. Electric fans
5. Expansion tank
Circulation of the coolant is activated by a centrifugal pump, which is chain-driven,
together with the oil pumps, by the crankshaft.
Pump
Centrifugal water pump (1) with by-pass built in with the thermostatic valve (2).
Circuit
Max. circuit pressure: 6 Bar
Radiator
The water radiator (3) is positioned on the front of the engine compartment.
The electric intake fans (4) are located on the hood and are shared by the water radiator,
the AC condenser and the power steering oil cooler.
Expansion tank
Located on the right-hand side (5)
Maserati Academy
268
Introduction to Maserati
4200 Dry Sump Engine
CRANKCASE VAPOUR RECIRCULATION SYSTEM
1.
Heads
2.
Outlet line
3.
Oil tank
4.
Plenum chamber
5.
Line
The device for oil gas and vapour recirculation is of the closed circuit type.
The oil vapours and the gases coming from the heads (1) pass through the breather line
(2) and a portion of them condenses and flows back into the oil tank (3) while the other
portion is taken in by the plenum chamber (4) via the line (5).
CYLINDER NUMERATION
Bank 2
left
Bank 1
right
8
1
5
4
Maserati Academy
269
Introduction to Maserati
4200 Dry Sump Engine
SECONDARY AIR SYSTEM
1.
Solenoid valve
5.
Pneumatic valves duct
2.
Pneumatic valves
6.
Exhaust manifold line
3.
Vacuum tank
7.
Exhaust maniforls
4.
Tank-solenoid valve line
8.
Secundary air pump
This system supplies additional air to the exhaust manifolds to allow the catalytic
converter to reach their operating temperature quickly.
By means of the solenoid valve (1), the Motronic ECU, drives the opening/closing of the
two pneumatic valves (2) which actuate the injection of secondary air into the exhaust
manifolds (7). The vacuum tank (3) which creates the vacuum required to open the
pneumatic valves is located in the engine compartment, underneath the secondary air
pump. The secondary air pump (8), managed by the engine ECU, sends air to the exhaust
lines.
The pump and the secondary air solenoid valve are activated, after engine ignition, when
the coolant temperature is in the range -5 °C to - 99°C.
The function is active for around 80 seconds, deactivates for around 60 seconds and
then reactivates for a further 10 seconds. In the latter period the secondary air valve seal
is monitored.
The Lambda sensors are disabled for the entire duration of the cycle.
Maserati Academy
270
Introduction to Maserati
4200 Dry Sump Engine
ENGINE TIMING:
The engine timing data for for M138 and M139 vehicles
are not the same. Refer to the respective timing values
for each engine version.
CAUTION!
ENGINE VERSION F136R
ENGINE VERSION F136S
Intake
Beginning before TDC
End after TDC
15°± 1°
66°± 1°
Intake
Beginning before TDC
End after TDC
15°± 1°
66°± 1°
35°± 1°
6° ±1°
Exhaust
Beginning before BDC
End
41°± 1°
0° ±1°
Exhaust
Beginning before BDC
End
The engine timing procedure is identical for both versions, but the values will, of course,
be different. The procedure below refers to F136R engines. The different tactics to adopt
for F136S engines are described at the end of this timing procedure.
INTAKE TIMING ADJUSTMENT PROCEDURE (F136R)
•
Turn the engine anticlockwise and position the first piston at the TDC. Make sure
that the dial gauge is on zero.
•
Place a support for the magnetic base of the dial gauge holder on the right-hand
engine head.
Maserati Academy
271
Introduction to Maserati
4200 Dry Sump Engine
•
Position a magnetic base with a long-rod centesimal dial gauge.
•
Turn the engine clockwise positioning the intake cam immediately before the opening
ramp.
•
In this condition, the hydraulic tappet is still in the rest position.
•
Position the dial gauge plunger above the tappet of an intake valve. The dial gauge
rod must be as perpendicular as possible to the tappet surface.
•
Reset the dial gauge that measures the movement of the intake tappet.
•
Again, position at the TDC and check the dial gauge previously reset. In this position
(TDC), the intake valves of the first cylinder have already started their travel.
Therefore, carefully check the position on the dial gauge positioned on the tappet.
•
Turn the crankshaft 15° beyond the TDC. This corresponds to a piston stroke of 1.75
mm beyond the TDC.
•
Check that the tappet downstroke (begun before the TDC) and hence the intake
valve upstroke is 0.59±0.08 mm.
•
Should the values measured in these conditions be out of tolerance, hold the
crankshaft still, loosen the Allen screws on the timing variator and turn the intake
camshaft until obtaining the desired intake valve upstroke. For this reason, as
described earlier, it is advisable to get ready for the timing procedure by positioning
the variator adjustment slots in the centre of the angular adjustment.
•
Check the timing again.
•
Use a torque wrench to tighten the previously loosened Allen screws that secure the
variator to a torque of 15 Nm, after applying Loctite 242.
Maserati Academy
272
Introduction to Maserati
4200 Dry Sump Engine
EXHAUST TIMING ADJUSTMENT PROCEDURE (F136R)
•
Turn the engine clockwise and position the first piston at the TDC with the camshafts
balanced (exhaust closed and intake open). Make sure that the dial gauge is on zero.
•
Position the dial gauge plunger above the tappet of an exhaust valve. The dial gauge
rod must be as perpendicular as possible to the tappet surface.
•
Reset the dial gauge that measures the movement of the exhaust tappet.
•
Turn the crankshaft clockwise until an exhaust valve is closed.
•
Check that the closing stroke of the exhaust valve is 1.09±0.08 mm.
•
Should the values measured in these conditions be out of tolerance, hold the
crankshaft still, move the centering dowel anticlockwise or clockwise (depending on
whether you want to delay or anticipate the shaft) until obtaining the desired timing
value.
•
Insert the fixing dowel into the hole immediately after or before the centering dowel,
whichever is easier.
CAUTION!
The tightening action of the
exhaust gearwheel considerably
affects the exhaust timing
adjustment. Take this into
account when adjusting the
exhaust timing to the indicated
value.
Maserati Academy
273
Introduction to Maserati
4200 Dry Sump Engine
•
Use a torque wrench to tighten the M20x32 mm hex-head screw of the exhaust
camshaft (with relevant washer) to a torque of 200 Nm after applying Loctite 242.
•
Check the timing again.
CAUTION!
Tighten the M20x32 screw to the
indicated torque taking care to lock
the exhaust camshaft so that the
timing chain is not loaded.
•
Carry out the same procedure for the left-hand cylinder bank, positioning the dial
gauge holder on cylinder number 8.
Maserati Academy
274
Introduction to Maserati
4200 Dry Sump Engine
INTAKE TIMING ADJUSTMENT PROCEDURE (F136S)
•
Turn the engine anticlockwise and position the first piston at the TDC. Make sure that
the dial gauge is on zero.
•
Place a support for the magnetic base of the dial gauge holder on the right-hand
engine head.
•
Position a magnetic base with a long-rod centesimal dial gauge.
•
Turn the engine clockwise and position the intake cam immediately before the
opening ramp. In this condition, the hydraulic tappet is still in rest position.
•
Position the dial gauge plunger above the tappet of an intake valve.
•
The dial gauge rod must be as perpendicular as possible to the tappet surface.
•
Reset the dial gauge that measures the movement of the intake tappet.
Maserati Academy
275
Introduction to Maserati
4200 Dry Sump Engine
•
Again, position at the TDC and check the dial gauge previously reset. In this position
(TDC), the intake valves of the first cylinder have already started their travel.
Therefore, carefully check the position on the dial gauge positioned on the tappet.
•
Turn the crankshaft 15° beyond the TDC. This corresponds to a piston stroke of 1.75
mm beyond the TDC.
•
Check that the downstroke of the tappet (begun before the TDC) and hence the
valve upstroke is 0.59±0.08 mm.
•
Should the values measured in these conditions be out of tolerance, hold the
crankshaft still, loosen the Allen screws of the timing variator and turn the intake
camshaft until obtaining the desired intake valve upstroke. For this reason, as
described earlier, it is advisable to get ready for the timing procedure by positioning
the variator adjustment slots in the centre of the angular adjustment.
•
Check the timing again.
•
Use a torque wrench to tighten the previously loosened Allen screws that secure the
variator to
•
a torque of 15 Nm after applying Loctite 242.
Maserati Academy
276
Introduction to Maserati
4200 Dry Sump Engine
EXHAUST TIMING ADJUSTMENT PROCEDURE (F136S)
•
Turn the engine clockwise and position the first piston at the TDC with the
camshafts balanced (exhaust closed and intake open). Make sure that the dial
gauge is on zero.
•
Position the dial gauge plunger above the tappet of an exhaust valve. The dial
gauge rod must be as perpendicular as possible to the tappet surface.
•
Reset the dial gauge that measures the movement of the exhaust tappet.
•
Turn the crankshaft clockwise until an exhaust valve is closed.
•
Check that the tappet downstroke and hence the exhaust valve upstroke is
0.57±0.08 mm.
•
Should the values measured in these conditions be out of tolerance, hold the
crankshaft still, move the centring dowel anticlockwise or clockwise (depending on
whether you want to delay or anticipate the shaft) until obtaining the desired timing
value.
Maserati Academy
277
Introduction to Maserati
•
4200 Dry Sump Engine
Insert the fixing dowel into the hole immediately after or before the centering dowel.
CAUTION!
The tightening action of the
exhaust
gearwheel
considerably affects the
exhaust timing adjustment.
Take this into account when
adjusting the exhaust timing
to the indicated value.
•
Use a torque wrench to tighten the M20x32 mm hex-head screw of the exhaust
camshaft (with relevant washer) to a torque of 200 Nm after applying Loctite 242.
•
Check the timing again.
CAUTION!
Tighten the M20x32 screw to the
indicated torque taking care to lock
the exhaust camshaft so that the
timing chain is not loaded.
•
Carry out the same procedure for the left-hand cylinder bank, positioning the dial
gauge holder on cylinder number 8.
Maserati Academy
278
Introduction to Maserati
4200 Wet Sump Engine
4200 Wet Sump Engine
Maserati Academy
279
Introduction to Maserati
4200 Wet Sump Engine
INTRODUCTION
This new 4.2L wet sump engine (F136UC – F136UD) is derived from the F136S engine
but has been deeply re-engineered and characterized by technical contents that
substantially differentiate it from the previous version.
The most important technical innovation is the adoption of a wet sump lubrication system.
High torque and power values have been maintained and are assured by the well known
technical contents of the “Dry sump” engine. They have been optimised and reengineered for reliability.
This is a unit that forms part of the new generation of Maserati engines, designed for the
debut at the beginning of 2007 on Quattroporte models with automatic gearbox. Little later
this new engine also found its way under the bonnet of the all-new GranTurismo model.
Both engine versions (F136UC for Quattroporte Automatic, F136UD for GranTursimo) are
technically identical. The only difference lies in the engine control software with a specific
engine mapping. This results in a more alert response to accelerator commands and a
slightly higher power output for the GranTurismo.
Maserati Academy
280
Introduction to Maserati
4200 Wet Sump Engine
ENGINE CHARACTERISTICS:
•
Compact and lightweight construction (180kg)
•
Short-stroke engine (bore: 92mm, stroke: 79,8mm)
•
Cylinder heads in hardened aluminium/silicon alloy with high volumetric and
thermodynamic efficiency combustion chamber.
•
Crankcase in aluminium alloy and hardened silicon, completely redesigned with cast
iron cylinder liners.
•
All the conduits (water, oil, secondary air) are made directly in the engine castings to
create a highly rigid, space-saving system and provide a strong guarantee of quality
during assembly, and hence high reliability.
•
Single-cast crankshaft in hardened steel, individually balanced, resting on five main
journals
•
Wet-sump lubrication system with oil pump integrated in the engine and oil-water
exchanger integrated in the upper part of the crankcase.
•
Cooling circuits operating by circulation of an antifreeze mixture, and water
circulation pump driven by the engine pulley.
•
Incorporating the auxillary systems (water pump) with the engine's main castings and
the highly rigid design of all the wide-wall elements results in low engine noise levels
and high component reliability.
•
Plastic intake manifold, with optimised line lengths.
•
Stepless variable valve timing system for the intake camshafts. It is activated by
means of a low-pressure hydraulic system.
•
Four overhead camshafts (two per bank) and four valves per cylinder, driven by
hydraulic tappets.
•
Timing controlled by chains whose tension is guaranteed by two hydraulic
tensioners.
•
Bosch Motronic ME7.1.1 integrated ignition/injection system with motor driven throttle
Maserati Academy
281
Introduction to Maserati
4200 Wet Sump Engine
ENGINE VIEWS
Maserati Academy
282
Introduction to Maserati
4200 Wet Sump Engine
SPECIFICATIONS:
Engine type
F136UC - F136UD
Cycle
Otto
Number and position of cylinders
8 - V90°
Number of valves per cylinder
4
Bore
92 mm
Stroke
79,8 mm
Capacity per cylinder
530,479 cc
Total capacity
4243,83 cc
Combustion chamber volume
52,74 cc
Compression ratio
11,058 ± 0,2 :1
Valve tappets
Hydraulic, 35 mm
Intake valves
37,8 mm
Exhaust valves
31,0 mm
Intake valve lift
9,5 mm ± 0,05 mm
Exhaust valve lift
9,3 mm ± 0,03 mm
Intake timing variation
50°
Timing variator inactive
- 15°
Timing variator fully advanced
35°
Firing order
1-8-6-2-7-3-4-5
Maximum power F136UC
295 Kw (400 hp) @ 7000 rpm
Maximum power F136UD
298 Kw (405 hp) @ 7100 rpm
Maximum torque F136UC
460 Nm @ 4250 rpm
Maximum torque F136UD
460 Nm @ 4750 rpm
Engine control system
Bosch Motronic ME 7.1.1
Fuel pressure
3,5 - 3,8 bar
Fuel Type
95 Research Octane Number
Ignition type
Static ignition
Ignition coils
Eldor
Spark plugs
NGK PMR8B
Alternator
Nippondenso 12V - 150°
Idle speed
700 rpm (1200 rpm when cold)
Maximum engine speed
7200 rpm
Maserati Academy
283
Introduction to Maserati
4200 Wet Sump Engine
ENGINE PERFORMANCE CURVES:
500
310
490
300
480
290
470
280
460
270
450
440
260
430
250
420
240
410
230
400
220
390
TORQUE (Nm)
370
200
360
190
350
180
340
170
330
160
320
POWER (Kw)
210
380
150
310
140
300
290
130
280
120
270
110
260
100
250
90
240
80
230
220
70
210
60
200
50
80
75
70
65
60
55
50
45
40
35
30
25
20
15
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
00
0
10
50
rpm
Maserati Academy
284
Introduction to Maserati
4200 Wet Sump Engine
CYLINDER NUMERATION
Bank 2
left
ENGINE CODE AND NUMBER
Bank 1
right
8
1
5
4
Maserati Academy
285
Introduction to Maserati
4200 Wet Sump Engine
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
The lubrication system is of the wet sump type; the engine lubrication oil is collected in a
sump, integral with the crankcase, and is circulated by means of a single oil-bath pump.
This solution replaces the dry-sump system that equipped the previous engines. This
solution is technically much less complex, allowing to improve reliability. Other advantages
of the wet sump lubrication system are improved fuel economy and significant noise
reduction improving comfort on board.
Maserati Academy
286
Introduction to Maserati
4200 Wet Sump Engine
Oil tank
The engine oil tank is incorporated in the
engine sump.
Nominal lubrication pressure
4 bar with oil temperature at 100°C at
6000 rpm
Amount of oil in sump
9L (corresponding to max. level)
Difference between min and max level on
dipstick : 1,5L
Cooling of the engine oil
A water/oil heat exchanger is located inside
the V of the engine block.
Oil level check procedure:
The level must be checked when the engine is warm, following the procedure below:
1.
start the vehicle and warm it up until the temperature stabilises;
2.
stop the engine, remove the filler cap and wait 5 minutes to allow the oil to flow into
the sump;
3.
measure the level and top up if necessary. The oil level must be between the MIN
and MAX reference notches on the dipstick.
Maserati Academy
287
Introduction to Maserati
4200 Wet Sump Engine
COOLING SYSTEM
The engine coolant circulation is enforced by a centrifugal pump which is driven by the
engine crankshaft by means of a poly-V belt without tensioner.
Coolant pump
Centrifugal water pump is integrated in the front engine
cover and incorporates the thermostatic valve.
Circuit pressure
Maximum pump exit pressure: 3,4 bar
Coolant expansion tank
Located at the right hand side of the engine bay.
Thermostatic valve
Begin of valve opening: 85°C±2
Valve closing: 95°C±2
Maximum operating temperature: 130°C
Maserati Academy
288
Introduction to Maserati
4200 Wet Sump Engine
Radiator
The water radiator is located in the
frontal part of the engine compartment,
together with the A/C condenser and
power steering oil cooler.
Two electric cooling fans are used.
Caution
The water pump drive belt is of the
stretchy belt type (no tensioner is used).
The belt must be replaced every time it is
removed. A special tool is used for the
installing of the belt.
Maserati Academy
289
Introduction to Maserati
4200 Wet Sump Engine
CRANKCASE VAPOUR RECIRCULATION SYSTEM
The device for oil gas and vapour recirculation is of the closed circuit type. The engine
heads are connected by means of a pipe that balances and stabilises the vapours coming
from the crankcase. A degasser on the left-hand engine head ensures oil vapour
separation allowing recirculation directly in the intake manifold.
Maserati Academy
290
Introduction to Maserati
4200 Wet Sump Engine
SECONDARY AIR SYSTEM
2
2
4
3
1.
Solenoid valve
2.
Pneumatic valves
3.
Vacuum tank
4.
Secondary air pump
1
The secondary air system used on the wet sump engine is modified with respect to the dry
sump engine. The secondary air is now inserted in the specific ducts in the cylinder heads
to improve warming up of the catalityc converters and reduce further emissions.
Through the solenoid valve (1) the Motronic ECU controls opening/closing of the two
pneumatic valves (2) that activate injection of secondary air directly into a channel
machined into the engine head casting. The flow continues along its path through the
communication holes between the channel and the exhaust duct to reach the exhaust
manifold. The vacuum tank (3) that accumulates the vacuum necessary to open the
pneumatic valves is positioned in the engine compartment underneath the secondary air
pump. The secondary air pump (4), controlled by the engine ECU, sends air to the exhaust
ducts. The pump and the secondary air solenoid valve are activated, after engine ignition,
when the coolant temperature is in the range -7 °C and +40°C. The temperature threshold
of 40°C disables the operating of the system. During the system operating cycle, the seal
of the secondary air valves is checked. Throughout the cycle, the oxygen sensors are in
“open loop” configuration and therefore do not activate the feedback for A/F ratio
correction.
Maserati Academy
291
Introduction to Maserati
4200 Wet Sump Engine
VARIABLE VALVE TIMING
The Variable Valve Timing (VVT) system is modified with respect to the F136 R/S engine.
The system uses a hydraulic VVT-actuator on each intake camshaft which is operated by
engine oil pressure (low pressure type). The VVT-actuator consists of a external part
(stator), which is fixed to the timing gear, and an internal part (rotor), which is fitted on the
intake camshaft. The mutual shape of rotor and stator internally create different chambers:
four advancing chambers and four retarding chambers. The division of oil pressure in the
advancing chambers and retarding chambers determines the position of the VVT-actuator.
Inside the VVT-actuator, a clock spring is installed. The applying force of the spring is
assisting the oil pressure when moving the rotor in the forward (advancing) direction. This
is necessary because of the high valve operating reaction forces, tending to move the
rotor in its backward position.
Inside the rotor of the VVT-actuator, a locking pin is installed. When the VVT-actuator is in
its rest position, the locking pin is pushed into the stator by the force of a spring. In this
condition the VVT-actuator is mechanically locked in its maximum retarded position. When
the VVT-actuator is operated, the locking pin is lifted by oil pressure and the rotor is
unlocked.
Advancing channel
Retarding channel
Locking pin
Maserati Academy
292
Introduction to Maserati
4200 Wet Sump Engine
Note: when removing/installing
the VVT-actuator, always make
sure the actuator is locked in its
rest position. This can be verified
by means of reference marks on
the actuator housing (see
picture). Engine timing procedure
can only be performed correctly
when the VVT-actuators are in
their rest position.
Each VVT-actuator is regulated by a solenoid valve which controls the oil supply
towards the advancing chambers and retarding chambers. The solenoid valves are
directly controlled by the engine control module (NCM) by means of a pulse width
modulation signal (PWM) and on the basis of a pre-programmed map (function of
engine load and engine speed). The engine control module constantly monitors the
actual position of the VVT-actuators by comparing the signals from the crankshaft
position sensor and the camshaft position sensors. When the oil control solenoid
valve is in its rest position, the oil supply is connected to the retarding channel,
while the advancing side circuit is drained towards the sump.
Advancing
Retarding
To sump
Oil supply
Maserati Academy
293
Introduction to Maserati
4200 Wet Sump Engine
The timing of the intake camshafts can be modified continuously between
maximum retarded and maximum advanced position. The VVT-actuator has an
operating range of 25 degrees, corresponding to 50 crankshaft degrees.
•
•
VVT-actuator in rest position (retarded): intake valves open at 15° atdc
(corresponding to 0,59 mm valve lift)
VVT-actuator fully operated (advanced):
intake valves open at 35° btdc (corresponding to 0,59 mm valve lift)
50°
EXHAUST
INTAKE
Engine idling: intake timing is retarded. Late opening of the intake valves
minimizes valve overlap. This guarantees stable combustion and smooth idling.
Low and middle revs, medium to high load: intake timing is advanced. Early
opening of the intake valves creates high valve overlap. Exhaust gasses are
partially re-burned which lowers combustion temperature and reduces emissions
of NOx. Early closing of the intake valves at low revs improves volumetric
efficiency.
High revs, full load: intake timing is retarded. Late closing of the intake valves
improves volumetric efficiency as a result of the high inertia of the incoming air.
Note: when switching off the engine, the solenoid valve is brought back to the
retarded position, this to make sure the VVT-actuator returns to its rest position,
against the force of the internal spring.
Maserati Academy
294
Introduction to Maserati
4200 Wet Sump Engine
ENGINE TIMING:
Intake
Opening after TDC
15°± 1°
Colsing after BDC
66°± 1°
(reference valve lift: 0,59 +-0,08 mm)
Exhaust
Opening before BDC
41°± 1°
Closing at TDC
0° ± 1°
(reference valve lift: 0,57 +-0,08 mm)
Intake timing adjustment:
•
Turn the crankshaft by 15° beyond the TDC. This corresponds to a piston stroke of
1.75 mm beyond the TDC
•
Check that the tappet downstroke (begun before the TDC) and hence the intake
valve opening is 0.59±0.08 mm
Exhaust timing adjustment:
•
Turn the engine clockwise and position the first piston at the TDC with the camshafts
balanced (exhaust closed and intake open). Make sure that the dial gauge is on zero.
•
Position the dial gauge plunger on the tappet of an exhaust valve. The dial gauge rod
must be as perpendicular as possible to the tappet surface.
•
Reset the dial gauge that measures the movement of the exhaust tappet.
•
Turn the crankshaft clockwise until an exhaust valve is closed.
•
Check that the tappet downstroke and hence the exhaust valve opening is 0.57±0.08
mm.
Note: the given values are with the VVT-actuator in it’s rest position, this
corresponds with the intake camshaft in the position of maximum retarding, always
check if the VVT-actuator is returned in its rest position.
Maserati Academy
295
Introduction to Maserati
4200 Wet Sump Engine
INTAKE TIMING ADJUSTMENT PROCEDURE
Note: The timing adjustment procedure on the next pages uses an engine with
complete disassambled timing mechanism as a starting point. Follow the different
indicated steps carefully to obtain correct engine timing and to prevent mechanical
damage.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Turn the crankshaft until the crankshaft tab is in the 9.00 o’ clock position.
Rotate the intake and exhaust camshafts on both banks until the reference
marks at the ends of the camshafts match the reference marks on the
camshaft caps.
Lock the camshafts so they cannot rotate.
Position a centesimal dial gauge and rotate the crankshaft clockwise until
reaching TDC.
Make sure that the coupling surfaces between timing variators and camshafts
are perfectly clean.
Before fitting the timing chains, position the timing variators on the camshafts
by loosely tightening the fastening bolts by a few millimetres.
Note: each time the timing variator is removed, the fastening bolt should be
replaced by a new one!
Maserati Academy
296
Introduction to Maserati
7.
8.
9.
4200 Wet Sump Engine
Position the camshaft driving chain on the right hand side bank.
Position the exhaust side gear by making sure that the corresponding slots are
placed in the centre of the adjustment area.
Position the right hand side hydraulic chain tensioner.
10. Tighten at least two fastening screws of the right hand exhaust gear.
11. Tighten the fastening bolt of the right hand side variator with a torque of 40
Nm.
12. Position the camshaft driving chain and gears on the left hand side bank by
making sure that the corresponding slots of the exhaust side gear are placed
in the centre of the adjustment area.
Maserati Academy
297
Introduction to Maserati
13.
14.
15.
16.
4200 Wet Sump Engine
Position the left hand side hydraulic chain tensioner.
Tighten at least two fastening screws of the left hand exhaust gear.
Tighten the fastening bolt of the left hand side variator with a torque of 40 Nm.
Fit the hydraulic chain tensioners by tightening them to 40 Nm torque by using
a torque wrench.
17. Unlock the camshafts.
18. Rotate the engine in clockwise direction by making sure there is no jamming.
19. Position piston No. 1 at TDC and make sure that the corresponding dial gauge
is set to zero.
20. Position a magnetic base with its own centesimal dial gauge and long stem.
The dial gauge stem must be placed in a position which is as perpendicular as
possible with respect to the intake tappet surface.
Maserati Academy
298
Introduction to Maserati
4200 Wet Sump Engine
21. Rotate the engine in clockwise direction by positioning the intake cam just
before the opening position. The hydraulic tappet is still in the rest position.
Reset the dial gauge measuring the shift of the intake tappet in this position.
22. Rotate the crankshaft clockwise until 15° beyond the TDC; this corresponds to
a 1.75 mm piston stroke.
23. Check if the downstroke of the tappet (which began before the TDC),
consequently the opening of the intake valve, is 0.59 ± 0.08 mm.
24. If under such circumstances the measured values do not fall within the
tolerance range, make sure that the crankshaft is locked into place and then
slacken the timing variator fastening bolt and rotate the intake camshaft until
the preset valve upstroke intake value is met.
25. Double check the timing values.
26. Tighten the timing variator fastening bolt to a torque of 50 ± 1.5 Nm followed
by an angle of + 85°±1° by using a torque wrench and goniometer.
27. Double check again the timing values.
Maserati Academy
299
Introduction to Maserati
4200 Wet Sump Engine
EXHAUST TIMING ADJUSTMENT PROCEDURE
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Rotate the engine in clockwise direction and position the first piston at TDC
with the camshafts in the overlap position.
Make sure that the corresponding dial gauge is set to zero.
Position a magnetic base with its own centesimal dial gauge and long stem.
The dial gauge stem has to be placed in a position which is as perpendicular
as possible with respect to the exhaust tappet surface.
Reset the dial gauge measuring the shift of the exhaust tappet.
Rotate the crankshaft in clockwise direction until the exhaust valves are fully
closed.
Maserati Academy
300
Introduction to Maserati
6.
7.
8.
9.
4200 Wet Sump Engine
Check the tappet downstroke (exhaust valve lift) and make sure that it
measures 0.57 ± 0.08 mm.
If under such circumstances the measured values do not fall within the
tolerance range, rotate the crankshaft and reach the TDC position.
While locking the camshaft into place, slacken the M6 screws and carry out
the timing procedure by using the adjustment slots.
Double check the timing values.
10. Tighten the hexagonal head M6 screw to the prescribed torque of 5Nm
followed by an angle of 50° after applying some Loctite 242.
11. Double check again the timing values.
12. Carry out the same procedure for the left-hand cylinder bank, positioning the
dial gauge holder on cylinder number 8.
Maserati Academy
301
Introduction to Maserati
4700 Wet Sump Engine
4700 Wet Sump Engine
Maserati Academy
302
Introduction to Maserati
4700 Wet Sump Engine
INTRODUCTION
The new 4.7L engine is a technical evolution of the 4.2L engine, and also adopts the wet
sump lubrication system for improved fuel economy, noise comfort and reliability.
The increase in capacity from 4.2L to 4.7L has been obtained by an increase of both
engine bore and engine stroke. For this purpose various engine components have been
redesigned and the cylinder liners, now made from steel, use Nikasil technology.
Nikasil is an electrodeposited nickel matrix silicon carbide coating with oleophilic
characteristics. It reduces friction and wear and allows large cylinder bores with very small
piston-cylinder liner tolerances. The 4.7L engine was designed to increase both engine
power and torque in order to further improve the vehicle’s overall performances. They can
be distinguished by the red painted valve covers.
The 4.7L engine comes in different versions. The differences between them lies in the
intake and exhaust system, the variable valve timing system, specific engine mapping and
whether the engine is combined with an automatic or a robotized transmission.
Engine
Vehicle
F136YC
Alfa Romeo 8C
F136YE
GranTurismo S MC-shift
F136YG
Quattroporte S (MY09)
F136YH
Quattroporte Sport GT S (MY09)
GranTurismo S Automatic*
(*): to be launched in 2009
Maserati Academy
303
Introduction to Maserati
4700 Wet Sump Engine
ENGINE CHARACTERISTICS:
The 4.7L engine (F136Y) is derived from the 4.2L wet sump engine (F136UC/UD) and has
the following characteristics:
Short engine
•
New crankcase in hardened aluminium/silicion alloy with new Nikasil coated steel
cilinder liners (the main dimensions of the crankcase have remained unchanged)
•
Bore increased by 2mm to 94 mm
•
stroke increased by 4,7 mm to 84,5 mm.
•
New single-cast crankshaft in hardened steel, individually balanced, resting on five
main bearings.
•
New auxiliary drive belt crankshaft pulley with reduced diameter (same as F136S
engine) to match higher engine speed.
•
Newly designed connecting rods with specific big end bearings
•
Newly designed pistons with specific piston rings
•
Also the flywheel, lower crankcase, engine timing cover and numerous smaller
components are specific for the F136Y engines.
Maserati Academy
304
Introduction to Maserati
4700 Wet Sump Engine
Cylinder heads / timing mechanism
The cylinder heads are made in hardened aluminium/ silicon alloy and have high
volumetric and thermodynamic efficiency combustion chambers.
The cylinder heads and the engine timing mechanism have the same characteristics as on
the F136UC/UD engines. The intake camshaft is however specific with a specific cam
design to increase the maximum intake valve lift. (10,5 mm instead of 9,5 mm)
Lubrication system
The lubrication system has the same characteristics as on the F136UC/UD engines, with
exception of:
•
Specific oil jets for piston bottom cooling
•
Nominal oil pressure: 4-5 bar @ 6000 rpm (100°C)
•
Cancellation of the oil level switch on the F136YC engine
•
Installation of an oil temperature sensor on the F136YC engine (located at the rear
end of the heat exchanger)
Cooling system
The cooling system has the same characteristics as the system on the F136UC/UD
engines.
Crankcase vapour recirculation system
The crankcase vapour recirculation system has the same characteristics as the system on
the F136UC/UD engines
Secondary air system
The secondary air system has the same characteristics as the system on the F136UC/UD
engines.
Variable valve timing system
The variable valve timing system of the F136YC and F136YE engines has the same
characteristics as the system on the F136UC/UD engines.
The variable valve timing system of the F136YG and F136YH engines has the same
characteristics as the system on the F136UC/UD engines, with exception of the application
of a new type of VVT-actuator. The VVT-actuator on the F136YG and F136YH engines
has an extended adjustment range (60° instead of 50°). The basic intake timing has
therefore been retarded with 10° (range: -25° - 35°)
Maserati Academy
305
Introduction to Maserati
4700 Wet Sump Engine
SPECIFICATIONS:
Engine type
F136YC - F136YE – F136YG – F136YH
Cycle
Otto
Number and position of cylinders
8 - V90°
Number of valves per cylinder
4
Bore
94 mm
Stroke
84,5 mm
Capacity per cylinder
586,411 cc
Total capacity
4691,29 cc
Combustion chamber volume
57,74 cc
Compression ratio
11,01 :1 (±0,2 :1)
Valve tappets
Hydraulic, 35 mm
Intake valves
37,8 mm
Exhaust valves
31,0 mm
Intake valve lift
10,5 mm ± 0,015mm
Exhaust valve lift
9,3 mm ± 0,015mm
Intake timing variation
50° (60° YG & YH)
Timing variator inactive
- 15° (-25° YG & YH)
Timing variator fully advanced
35°
Firing order
1-8-6-2-7-3-4-5
Maximum power F136YC
331 Kw (450 hp) @ 7000 rpm
Maximum power F136YE & F136YH
323 Kw (440 hp) @ 7000 rpm
Maximum power F136YG
316 Kw (430 hp) @ 7000 rpm
Maximum torque
490 Nm @ 4750 rpm
Engine control system (YC & YE)
Bosch Motronic ME 7.1.1
Engine control system (YG & YH)
Bosch Motronic ME 9.1.1
Fuel pressure
3,5 bar
Fuel Type
95 Research Octane Number
Ignition type
Static ignition
Ignition coils
Eldor
Spark plugs
NGK PMR8C-H
Alternator
Nippondenso 12V – 150 A
Idle speed
800 rpm (1200 rpm when cold)
Maximum engine speed
7600 rpm
Maserati Academy
306
Introduction to Maserati
4700 Wet Sump Engine
ENGINE PERFORMANCE CURVES (F136YE)
Maserati Academy
307
Introduction to Maserati
4700 Wet Sump Engine
ENGINE TIMING
The engine timing adjustment procedure of the F136Y engines is similar to the
procedure used for the F136UC/UD engine. The timing values however are
specific.
Intake timing adjustment F136YC
and F136YE engine:
Turn the engine to 15° after Top Dead
Center, corresponding with a piston
stroke of 1,86 mm. The intake tappet
downstroke should measure 0,60 ±
0,08 mm
Intake timing adjustment F136YG
and F136YH engine:
Turn the engine to 25° after Top Dead
Center, corresponding with a piston
stroke of 5,09 mm. The intake tappet
downstroke should measure 0,60 ±
0,08 mm
Exhaust
timing adjustment (all
F136Y engines):
With the cranckshaft in Top Dead
Center with the engine in overlap
position,
the
exhaust
tappet
downstroke should measure 0,60 ±
0,08mm
Caution
Note: the engine timing values are specific for the different
evolutions of the wet sump engine family!
Note (2): the given values are with the VVT-actuator in it’s
rest position, this corresponds with the intake camshaft in the
position of maximum retarding. Always check if the VVTactuator is returned to its rest position.
Maserati Academy
308
Introduction to Maserati
Robotized Gearbox
Robotized Gearbox
Maserati Academy
309
Introduction to Maserati
Robotized Gearbox
ROBOTIZED GEARBOX CONTROL SYSTEM
The robotized gearbox control system is composed of an electro-hydraulic servo system
which manages the gearchange and clutch operation.
A specific ECU (NCR) controls the complete system by using a strategy which is based on
driver inputs and various vehicle parameters. Therefore the NCR interacts with other
vehicle systems (NCM, NFR,…) and uses a driver interface (gearshift paddles and control
buttons). A specific characteristic of the system is that it can be integrated on a
mechanical transmission without requiring any specific modifications.
1
Robotized gearbox layout
2
4
3
6
5
4
1.
Clutch Pressure Sensor on
Clutch Housing (Sofast III
onward)
2.
Gearbox Unit
3.
Hydraulic actuator
4.
Accumulator
5.
Reservoir
6.
Power Unit Assy
2
Robotized gearbox layout
3
1
Display
w
Hydraulic actuator
w
Solenoid valves
w
Power unit
w
Accumulator
Driver controls:
Steering
wheel
gearshift
paddles assy.
Reverse
button
•
Display
•
Steering wheel gearshift paddles
•
Reverse gear selection
•
Auto/manual mode selection
"Race" button
Maserati Academy
310
Introduction to Maserati
Robotized Gearbox
EVOLUTION OF TRANSMISSION CONTROL SYSTEMS
The robotized gearbox control system went through a number of significant modifications
that have also involved the introduction and modification of specific components. Various
software and hardware evolutions have been applied during the years with the aim to
improve driving comfort, reduce gearshift times, reduce clutch wear and simplify service
operations.
•
PRE-SOFAST and SOFAST transmission control system (CFC201): this is the first
generation of transmission control system as introduced in 2001 on the M138 model.
The name SOFAST (soft + fast) was introduced little later when a new control software
was applied with the aim to improve operating comfort. Management of gearchanges is
not influenced by information concerning vehicle dynamics.
•
SOFAST II transmission control system (CFC231): a new control unit with new
software was introduced to optimise gearchange comfort and reduce noise levels. An
improved operating management of the clutch was obtained by the introduction of the
Kisspoint self-learning procedure. Management of gearchanges is not influenced by
information concerning vehicle dynamics.
•
SOFAST III transmission control system (CFC301): the introduction of Sofast III
involves a new control unit and the introduction of a longitudinal acceleration sensor
and a clutch pressure sensor. The longitudinal acceleration information allows a
gearchange and clutch management influenced by the vehicle dynamics. The clutch
pressure information allows the ECU to calibrate the clutch diaphragm spring
characteristic. These modifications resulted in a much improved cluch management.
•
SOFAST III+ transmission control system (CFC301): identical to SOFAST III but with
modified clutch and new operating software for further improved cluch management.
•
SOFAST IV transmission control system (CFC301): new operating software and
various hardware modifications are applied. The introduction of the Superfast gearshift
operating strategy reduces gearshift times to 100 ms.
Maserati Academy
311
Introduction to Maserati
Robotized Gearbox
MASERATI M138 Cambiocorsa
HW CFC 201 (SOFAST) up to assembly 12203
HW CFC 231 (SOFAST II) from assembly 12204
MASERATI M139 Duoselect, EUROPE version
HW CFC 231 (SOFAST II) up to assembly 18821
HW CFC 301 (SOFAST III) from assembly 18822
HW CFC 301 (SOFAST III+) from assembly 21925
MASERATI M139 Duoselect, US version
HW CFC 301 (SOFAST III) up to assembly 21925
HW CFC 301 (SOFAST III+) from assembly 21926
MASERATI M145 MC-Shift
HW CFC 301 (SOFAST IV)
MASERATI M144
HW CFC 201 (SOFAST)
ALFA ROMEO 8C Competizione & 8C Spider
HW CFC 301 (SOFAST III+)
Maserati Academy
312
Introduction to Maserati
Robotized Gearbox
COMPONENT DESCRIPTION
Hydraulic actuator
The function of this subsystem is that of directly activating the gearshift forks in order to
drive the gear engagement and selection movements.
The hydraulic actuator is equipped with two sensors designed to monitor the actual
position of the gear engagement finger. One sensor monitors the selection stroke while the
other checks the gear engagement stroke. Both sensors are of the contactless type (Hall
effect). The integrated electronic circuit in the sensor converts the output signal of the Hall
ceramic element into an 0-5V DC signal. A failure of the sensors will enable a safety
strategy that prevents engine starting.
Actuator unit position detection Hall effect type contactless sensors
Maserati Academy
313
Introduction to Maserati
Robotized Gearbox
SELECTION
The hydraulic actuator converts the hydraulic pressure supplied by the gear selection
solenoid valves (EV3, EV4, EV5) into a rotary movement of the gearshift command shaft.
The gearshift command shaft has 4 possible positions separated by 15° angles.
Gear
EV3
EV4
EV5
1-2
ON
OFF
ON
3-4
ON
ON
ON
5-6
OFF
ON
ON
REV
ON
OFF
OFF
ENGAGEMENT
The hydraulic actuator converts the hydraulic pressure deriving from both the gear
engagement solenoid valves (EV1 for odd number gears and EV2 for even number gears)
into travel of the gearhift finger to three possible positions: Even number gears and
reverse gear / Neutral / Odd number gears.
Maserati Academy
Gear
EV1
EV2
2- 4- 6- R
OFF
ON
Neutral
ON
ON
1- 3- 5
ON
OFF
314
Introduction to Maserati
Robotized Gearbox
Power Unit
The Power Unit is heart of the system. The function of this subsystem is that of managing
the actuation of the hydraulic actuator and the clutch release bearing. Therefore it
provides hydraulic energy by using various solenoid valves. The power unit contains the
following components:
•
•
•
•
•
6 solenoid valves
Pressure sensor
Check valve
Pressure relief valve
Bypass screw
Pressure
sensor
EV3
EV4
Pressure sensor:
Working range: 0 - 80 bar
Power supply: 5V DC.
Output signal: 0.5 - 4.5 V DC.
EV
EV1
EV5
EV2
Solenoid valves:
EV:
Clutch solenoid valve (PFV)
EV 1-2:
Gear engagement solenoid valves (PPV)
EV 3-4-5: Gear selection solenoid valves (PFV)
Check valve
The check valve is located downstream from the electric pump inside the Power Unit and
serves to prevent the oil from flowing backwards. The presence of the check valve makes
it possible to maintain hydraulic pressure in the Power Unit when the electric pump is not
running so that operating pressure is immediately available when the ignition switched to
ON.
2
1
1.
Pressure relief valve
2.
Bypass screw
Maserati Academy
Pressure relief valve
The pressure relief valve prevents damage to F1
system components potentially resulting from
excess oil pressure in the event of anomalous
operation of the oil pump. The pressure relief valve
opens at approximately 90 bar and dumps the oil to
the low pressure side of the circuit.
Bypass screw
The bypass screw makes it possible to connect the
high pressure circuit to the low pressure circuit to
relieve system hydraulic pressure. This operation is
required, for example, when renewing hydraulic
system components.
315
Introduction to Maserati
Robotized Gearbox
Pressure (bar)
Proportional Pressure Valve (PPV):
The two gear engagement solenoid valves (EV1, EV2) responsible for meshing and
disengaging the gears, are of the proportional pressure type (PPV). The solenoid valves
are controlled by a PWM signal and they modulate hydraulic pressure in accordance with
the input current
Current I
Proportional Flow Valve (PFV):
The 3 gear selection solenoid valves (EV3, EV4, EV5) and the clutch solenoid valve (EV)
are of the proportional flow type (PFV). The clutch solenoid valve is controlled by a PWM
signal and modulates hydraulic pressure in accordance with the input current. The three
selection solenoid valves are used as On/Off type valves.
Clutch solenoid valve flow curve
Discharge
Charge
Flow
Holding
Current I
Maserati Academy
316
Introduction to Maserati
1.
2.
3.
4.
Selection actuator
Hydraulic accumulator
Engagement actuator
Clutch
Maserati Academy
Robotized Gearbox
5.
6.
7.
8.
Oil reservoir
Electric pump
Filter
Check valve
Pressure
Return
Neutral
317
Introduction to Maserati
Robotized Gearbox
Electric pump
The electric pump brings the oil from the hydraulic reservoir to the operational pressure for
the power unit.
The pump is driven by an electric DC motor and is managed by an ON/OFF control
strategy (the pump does not run continuously). The pump is activated when hydraulic
pressure drops below 40 bar and is switched off when the pressure reaches 50 bar.
When the driver's side door is opened and the ignition key is not inserted, the transmission
control module (NCR) runs the pump briefly to build up hydraulic pressure before starting
the engine.
In case of replacement of the
electric pump, the pump must
be replaced together with its
activation relay!
pump
electric motor
Sofast 4:
For the Sofast 4 system (GranTurismo S) with Superfast shift strategy, a higher operating
pressure is obtained when the superfast shift mode is active (range 50 - 70 bar).
Therefore, a new, more powerful electric pump is used. Further, an air conveyor is
installed to provide fresh air to the pump for heat removal.
The temperature of the electric pump motor is monitored by the NCR by means of a
mathematical model. In base of certain temperature thresholds, specific recovery
strategies can be activated to prevent overheating of the pump.
Pressure accumulator
The system is equipped with a piston type pressure
accumulator located on top of the gearbox. The
function of this device is to accumulate hydraulic
pressure during the electric pump running time and
deliver high pressure oil to the power unit when the
pump is stopped.
Maserati Academy
318
Introduction to Maserati
Robotized Gearbox
Solenoid valves internal leakage
Leakage past the spool of the control valve, which is estimated by the NCR and can be
read out by the diagnostic system, constitutes a valuable diagnostic aid in the event of an
electrohydraulic system fault. The value shown is periodically acquired by the NCR in a
self-learning procedure.
Solenoid valve internal leakage in excess of 30 cc/min, combined with problems of
engagement and/or selection, offers an excellent point of reference to understand the
nature of the problem. In this case the solenoid valve must be renewed.
In the case of hydraulic problems use the following procedure in order to isolate the
offending component:
Key ON, Engine Off: the interval time between two pump activations must be no less
than 2 minutes. This makes it possible to check the solenoid valves - accumulator electric pump assy.
Key On, Engine running: the interval time between two pump activations must be no
less than 60 seconds. This makes it possible to check the clutch solenoid valve and, by
acquiring the pump restart times, the condition of the accumulator.
The conditions of the electric pump can be assessed by acquisition of its activation time:
an activation ramp with an increasingly gradual slope and activation time in excess of 5
seconds are clear symptoms of deterioration of the pump.
Up / down paddles
Selection of gear engagement by means of steering wheel paddles
The NCR checks the activation status of the paddles by means of voltage values
generated by activation of the gearshift paddles.
Maserati Academy
319
Introduction to Maserati
Robotized Gearbox
Clutch position sensor
A contactless type sensor is used to measure in real time the position of the clutch release
bearing. This sensor uses LVDT (Linear Variable Differential Transformer) technology. The
movement of a magnet, fitted on the release bearing, will affect the voltage induced in the
coils integrated in the sensor element.
Note: failure of the clutch position sensor may lead non-starting of the engine.
Clutch Actuator
The clutch actuator is responsible for activating the clutch thrust bearing; the actuator is
composed of a hydraulically operated circular ring. Attention must be payed to the correct
direction of installation of the position sensor magnet with reference to the clutch thrust
bearing position.
Magnet
(facing gearbox side)
Pressure plate
Gearbox side
Maserati Academy
320
Introduction to Maserati
Robotized Gearbox
Hydraulic pressure sensor on clutch housing (Sofast III onward)
An analogue pressure sensor measures the hydraulic pressure in the clutch actuator,
which is in direct relation to the application force of the diaphragm spring. By this way the
exact clutch characteristic can be identified. This component is installed starting from
sofast III.
Measuring range:
Response voltage:
0 - 80 bar
0.5 - 4.5V
Longitudinal acceleration sensor (Sofast III)
A longitudinal acceleration sensor was
introduced on the Sofast III system to allow to
calculate the road gradient (flat surface, uphill,
downhill). This information is used by the NCR
to adapt the clutch activation during driving away
and the gearshift strategy in automatic driving
mode in base of the road gradient.
Starting from assembly 24275, the sensor has
been dropped and longitudinal acceleration
ionformation is received from the ABS / ESP
system (NFR) over the C-CAN line.
Gearbox input shaft speed sensor
The rotation speed of the gearbox primary shaft
is monitored by a magnetic induction type speed
sensor located on the right-hand side of the
gearbox.
Maserati Academy
321
Introduction to Maserati
Robotized Gearbox
Sofast 4:
For the GranTurismo S model (Sofast 4), the following hardware modifications have been
made:
•
Reinforced gearbox housing (new differential lid)
•
Reinforced, three-pad gearshift forks made of a new material
•
New clutch “Ribbed finger” (PIS value still 4,2mm – 327 bit)
•
New clutch housing with double support bearing
•
New electric pump with increased capacity and air conveyor
•
Clutch position sensor with improved thermal isolation for wiring
•
New hydraulic circuit oil: Shell Donax TX (0,5L)
•
High pressure leads without restrictors: on previous generations, restrictors were fitted
in the high pressure leads to reduce operating noise. For Sofast 4 they have been
removed to allow the increase of gearshift times.
•
Direct connection between NCR (pin 80 CFC301) and NCM (pin 81 Motronic ME7.1.1)
for engine cut-off in Superfast shift mode: When Superfast shift mode is active, the fuel
cut-off command during gearshift to the engine control system is not given over the CCAN line but by a direct connection by an “active low” signal. This allows a faster
command and improved synchronisation between gearbox control and engine control
during gearshift phase.
Note: in case of failure of the line (interruption, short circuit) a specific error code will
be stored (DTC P1761) and the Superfast shift mode will be disabled.
•
•
Activation of reverse lights via CAN: pin 41 of the CFC301 unit is no longer used to
operate the reverse lights relay. Instead, it operates the LED behind the Reverse
button on the control panel located on the central console.
•
Improved driver interface with longer gearshift paddles at the steering wheel and a new
control panel to select the driving direction (1st gear or Reverse).
The various modifications result in a modified pin-out for the
CFC301 ECU with respect to Sofast III and Sofast III+
Maserati Academy
322
Introduction to Maserati
Robotized Gearbox
OPERATING PRINCIPLE CHART
Pilot
Pilot
Motronic
Motronic
Up/Down levers
Sport - Ice buttons
Brake Pedal Switch
Engine Speed (rpm) - CAN
Required torque - CAN
Selection position sensor
Engagement position sensor
Clutch position sensor
Gearbox primary RPM sensor
Door and Hood Switch
Pressure Sensor
Sensors
Sensors
ASR/MSR
ASR/MSR
Speed (km/h) - CAN
Single wheel speed - CAN
TCU
Gear Shifting
Clutch Position Control
Fault Warning
Light
Gear Indication
Actuators
Actuators
Dashboard
Dashboard
Input signals
The transmission control module (NCR) uses the following input signals for operation of
the gearbox and clutch:
Analogue input signals:
Input signals from different sensors:
•
Shift up selector
•
Shift actuator position sensor
•
Shift down selector
•
Selection actuator position sensor
•
Vehicle speed signal
•
Clutch actuator position sensor
•
"Ice" switch signal
•
Clutch pressure sensor (Sofast III onward)
(low grip)
•
Primary shaft speed sensor
•
"Auto" switch signal
•
Oil pressure sensor power unit
•
"Reverse" switch signal
CAN input signals:
•
Brake pedal switch
•
Engine speed signal
•
Driver's door switch
•
Engine torque signal
•
"KEY ON" signal
•
"Sport" activation signal (from NFR)
•
Hood switch signal
•
Brake pedal switch signal
Maserati Academy
323
Introduction to Maserati
Robotized Gearbox
CLUTCH OPERATION MANAGEMENT
Clutch operation management, and all strategies related thereto, is based on control of
the clutch position calculated in real time.
The clutch control strategies are based on absolute references:
•
clutch position
•
transmissible torque
Calculation and control of the torque transmissibility curve depends on two
positions:
1.
KISS POINT (PIS position)
2.
CLOSED CLUTCH POSITION
The kiss point – also referred to as the PIS (Punto Incipiente Slittamento or slip beginning
point) – is a parameter that defines the nominal value of the clutch engagement point in
the gearbox control module (NCR). The kiss point is the actual thrust bearing position at
the moment of clutch engaging, expressed in millimetres and in relation to the closed
clutch position. The kiss point depends on various factors such as the clutch disc surface
condition and clutch temperature. It does not depend on clutch wear
Transmitted
TORQUE TRANSMISSIBILITY CURVE
torque
10 Nm
Thrust bearing
stroke
P.I.S.
100% transmitted
(1020 ÷ 1040 RPM) torque (1800 RPM)
The kiss point is reached at between 1020 - 1040 RPM. The clutch “closes” and therefore
full torque transmission is attained at 1800 RPM. When driving at below 1800 RPM and
especially when travelling uphill, the temperature of the clutch disc tends to rise due to the
clutch not being fully closed causing clutch slip. This results in disc wear and drastically
reduces the lifespan of the clutch.
Maserati Academy
324
Introduction to Maserati
Robotized Gearbox
The kiss point can be set into the NCR module by means of a calibration procedure with
the SD3 diagnostic tester. This procedure should be carried out after replacement of the
clutch or the transmission control module. Since the temperature is an important factor for
the determination of the kiss point, the calibration procedure should only be carried out at
the correct clutch operating temperature. Correct calibration of the actual kiss point is
crucial for correct clutch performance.
The closed clutch position: this is a value in mm which defines the thrust bearing
position when the clutch is fully closed. This value depends on the clutch wear and is autocalibrated after each gearshift.
OPEN CLUTCH
Maserati Academy
325
Introduction to Maserati
Robotized Gearbox
START OF TORQUE
TRANSMISSION
CLOSED CLUTCH
PIS
Closed clutch
position
PIS value = CC position – PIS position
Calculation of wear:
Autocalibrated closed clutch value – NEW closed clutch value
Clutch thickness (5.6 mm)
Δx
X 100 =
% Wear on
clutch
Δx
NEW CLUTCH
0
0
T = New clutch disc thickness
16.6
21.6
WORN CLUTCH
t = Worn clutch disc thickness
t
T
Δx = offset = T - t
offset = T - t
The kiss point does not depend on
clutch wear
Maserati Academy
= 21.6 - 16.6 = 5 mm
326
Introduction to Maserati
Robotized Gearbox
CLUTCH POSITION CONTROL
Real-time clutch open/close control by means of the position sensor, is calculated using
the PIS value and the closed clutch position. During gearshifts, the NCR transmission
control module becomes MASTER, while the NCM becomes SLAVE and sets a target
torque value. Once the target torque value is reached, the NCM module reverts to the
MASTER condition.
The three gear engagement phases
a
c
b
a = Torque Reduction
b = RPM Control
c = Torque Transmission
The target torque is
decided by the TCU
(master)
The target torque is
managed by the TCU
(master) (120 ms)
The TCU is now slave
and MOTRONIC decides
on the target torque
value
Flow control by means of I0 CURRENT management. Phase b control involves
management of the EVF that controls the hydraulic flow, in function of in the controlling
current. All Maserati electro-actuated control systems up to sofast II use this type of
parameter, which must be calibrated in the event of malfunction or maintenance on the
Power Unit.
Calibration is carried out as follows:
• Engine running with the gearbox in neutral for approx. 5 min.
• Engine running with the gearbox in 1st gear and foot on the brake for approx. 5 min.
SOFAST III onward systems execute this procedure using the “DEIS” function.
RPM
a
Downshift
request
Maserati Academy
b
100% accelerator
pedal
c
Acceleration
Gearshift phase
t
327
Introduction to Maserati
Robotized Gearbox
CLUTCH WEAR INDEX (Sofast II onward)
The clutch wear index (also referred to as “clutch wear degree” or “clutch degradation
index”) is a self-learned parameter which is used by the NCR to adjust the clutch
management in function of the degradation of the torque transmissibility capacity of the
clutch.
The clutch wear index can be found in the SD3 parameter menu and provides usefull
information about degradation of the transmissibility of the clutch. The wear index is selflearnt by the NCR each time the clutch is in the closing phase.
0
4000
Clutch biting
brusquely
10000
Clutch tending to slip
The clutch wear index is a value between 0 (100% torque transfer) and 10000 (no torque
transfer, constant slipping of the clutch). The default value is 4000. A clutch that is
operating correctly will have a wear index of around 3000/4000. If the clutch has not been
replaced and the wear index is high, after performing the resetting and subsequent Kiss
point procedures, the value of the parameter should fall.
Transmitted
torque
10 Nm
P.I.S.
Closed clutch
position
On Sofast II and Sofast III systems, the clutch wear index is used by the NCR to “move
up” the torque transmissibility curve which is used as a reference for clutch control. A
clutch wear index of higher than 4000, will move the curve to the right, a lower to the left.
Maserati Academy
328
Introduction to Maserati
Robotized Gearbox
For Sofast III+, the calculation of the clutch wear index has been refined. The clutch wear
index is no longer one single value, but 5 different points which together will define a new
torque transmissibility curve.
700
600
ID 0
500
ID 4000
Torque (Nm)
ID 10000
ID calculated
400
300
200
100
0
0
100
200
300
400
500
600
700
800
900
1000
position (thousands)
Note: the clutch wear index must be reset (= bring back to the default value of 4000) after
replacement of the clutch and before performing the Kisspoint procedure.
Note (2): from Sofast III+ onward, the clutch wear index is no longer present in the
parameter environment of the SD3 tester unit. The reset command (in the Active
diagnoses menu) is still present and will reset all 5 values.
Maserati Academy
329
Introduction to Maserati
Robotized Gearbox
GEAR ENGAGEMENT STRATEGY
The gear engagement and selection values are self-learnt and stored in the NCR by
means of two position sensors which must be within strictly defined ranges. By means of
this procedure, the NCR builds a grid and checks 2 engagement and 2 selection
thresholds (MIN and MAX). The calculation grid spreadsheet can be used to check the
correct centring and movement of the actuator. It is advisable to execute a calculation grid
when the vehicle is new and after each maintenance operation on the gearbox, and to
keep documentation archived for future reference.
Engagement
shift
rotation
rotation
shift
Selection
Actuator centring delta of the "finger":
Min
Min 0º
0º -- nom
nom +/+/- 1.5º
1.5º -- max
max +/+/- 3.0º
3.0º
(0
(0 bit
bit -- +/+/- 15
15 bits
bits -- +/+/- 30
30 bits)
bits)
(10
(10 bit
bit == 1°)
1°)
900
RM
1/2
3/4
5/6
800
Gear [bit]
700
600
500
400
300
200
100
100
200
300
400
500
600
700
800
Shift [bit]
Maserati Academy
330
Introduction to Maserati
Robotized Gearbox
SERVICE OPERATIONS ON THE ROBOTIZED GEARBOX SYSTEM
Depending on the type of operation performed on robotized gearbox system components
managed by the NCR module, it is necessary to perform the following operations, which
are divided into the relative areas of intervention.
SELF CALIBRATION OF DEIS PARAMETERS (Sofast III onward):
The DEIS parameter calibration function is a self-learning function which relates to a
number of clutch operation functions, e.g. self-learning of the clutch solenoid valve and
clutch diaphragm spring.
By means of the DEIS self-learning procedure, the transmission control module (NCR)
uses a specific algorithm to calculate the spring characteristic of the clutch diaphragm.
This function can be activated by the SD3 diagnostic tester and should be carried out after
replacement of clutch-related components or the transmission control module (NCR).
To activate the function, connect the SD3 tester and select the single ECU menu to enter
the transmission control module (NCR). Then select the active diagnostics menu where
the DEIS self-learning function can be found.
The procedure has a duration of between 3 minutes 30 seconds and 9 minutes. In case
the procedure has not been completed entirely, it is been considered as failed and has to
be repeated.
After the procedure has been concluded positively, turn off the ignition key and wait for 25
seconds. This time is needed for the module to memorize the different parameters.
If the procedure has a negative result, try to find the cause by checking the correct
operating of the clutch.
Also check if the hydraulic circuit has been correctly bled. Repeat the procedure.
The aim of the DEIS procedure is to obtain a fine-tuned control of 2 parameters:
1.
2.
Clutch position
Clutch solenoid valve pressure
The procedure comprises the following steps:
1.
autocalibration of closed centre current for the clutch solenoid valve I0
2.
autocalibration of optimal Dither current
3.
autocalibaration of the dead band of the clutch solenoid valve
4.
autocalibration of the current/capacity of the clutch valve
5.
autocalibration of the clutch Belleville spring
(*)DEIS: Dipartimento di Elettronica, Informatica e Sistematica (Department of Electronics, Computer
Sciences and Systems), University of Bologna, which has collaborated with Maserati on the development of
the procedure carrying its name.
Maserati Academy
331
Introduction to Maserati
Robotized Gearbox
RESET CLUTCH WEAR INDEX (Sofast II onward):
The clutch wear index provides information about degradation of the torque transmissibility
of the clutch. The clutch wear index is a self-learned parameter which will influence the
management of the clutch and which is specific for each clutch. Therefore the clutch wear
index must be reset after replacement of the clutch and before carrying out the Kiss Point
procedure.
The reset command for the clutch wear index can be found in the Active diagnosis menu
of the SD3 tester.
Note: with recent diagnostic software, the clutch wear index reset is integrated in the
Kisspoint procedure.
CLUTCH CONFIGURATION:
The “clutch configuration”, which is a command in the “Active diagnostic” menu of SD3, is
used to store the actual “closed clutch position”, as measured by the clutch position
sensor in real time, as the “closed clutch position of new clutch”. Therefore, this operation
must only be performed after the installing of a new clutch. The clutch configuration is
crucial for the correct calculation of the clutch wear %.
Note: it is advised to perform the clutch configuration after a brief bedding in of the new
clutch.
Note (2): with recent diagnostic software, the clutch configuration is integrated in the
Kisspoint procedure.
KISS POINT ADJUSTMENT PROCEDURE (Pre-Sofast and Sofast):
For cars fitted with transmission control systems prior to Sofast II (Pre-Sofast and Sofast)
the Kisspoint value must be entered manualy with the diagnostic tester (SD2). The Kiss
point base value depends on the vehicle type and Model Year. After entering the base
value, the value can be adjusted after an assessment of the clutch in order to obtain an
optimal clutch behaviour.
Maserati Academy
332
Introduction to Maserati
Robotized Gearbox
KISS POINT SELF LEARNING PROCEDURE (Sofast II onward):
On vehicles fitted with Sofast II or later, the ideal Kiss point can be found by means of a
self-learning procedure which is activated by the diagnostic tester.
Before starting the kiss point procedure, it is first necessary to bed in the clutch:
•
•
•
•
•
•
For the first few miles, follow the guidelines below in order to allow the clutch to bed
in sufficiently:
avoid using sport mode
change gear at a maximum of 4000 rpm and a maximum of 50% pedal
avoid releasing the clutch sharply
avoid prolonged use of the clutch (traffic jams, maneuvers)
make frequent gear changes while driving
Keep the engine idling for 5 minutes to calibrate the solenoid valves while hot. With the
vehicle in motion, engage 1-2-1 in sequence, and keep the engine idling in first and the
brake pedal pressed for 1 minute. Repeat the sequence three times to allow correct
estimation of clutch solenoid valve internal leakage.
•
•
•
•
Stop the engine, make certain that the ignition switch is in the OFF position
Connect SD3 (95970312) to the EOBD diagnosis connector (1).
Connect the C-Can connector (2a) to the SD3 cable (95979568)
Connect the C-Can connector (2c) with the SD3 cable (95979568) (2d).
Maserati Academy
333
Introduction to Maserati
Robotized Gearbox
First reset the CLUTCH DEGRADATION INDEX in the NCR active diagnosis
environment.
ATTENTION!
Before adjusting the gear engage/select actuator, make the following checks:
•
If the car has been parked for more than 8 hours, drive it for 15 minutes in Free
Drive, changing gear repeatedly.
•
If the car has been parked for more than 30 minutes after the bedding-in phase,
make 10 consecutive breakaways up to an engine speed of 1500 rpm.
•
If the car has been parked for less than 30 minutes after the bedding-in phase,
make 5 consecutive breakaways up to an engine speed of 1500 rpm.
Switch on the SD3 and select the KISS-POINT NCR application from the list of diagnosis
programs. Select the KISS POINT ENVIRONMENT function from the M138 software list.
The subsequent phases are guided by the chosen diagnosis system.
Enter the serial number of the car:
Note: for Sofast 4 (GranTurismo S), the Kiss point procedure can be performed by
connecting the diagnostic tester to the vehicle EOBD connector (by using the Switch
Matrix cable). It is therefore not necessary to use the C-CAN connector cable.
Maserati Academy
334
Introduction to Maserati
Robotized Gearbox
Use the TAB key to select "CONTINUOUS", then press "ENTER" to confirm. The system
will display a warning message for the operator, reminding him what conditions the car
must meet in order for the calibration procedure to be executed correctly.
If the car meets the necessary conditions to proceed, press "ENTER".
Put the gearbox in neutral, turn the ignition switch to the OFF position, wait for about 15
seconds, then start the engine and select "ENTER" on SD3.
Select “START PROCEDURE”.
The next screen tells the operator to keep the accelerator pedal pressed for the full
duration of data acquisition.
The system will automatically run 10 clutch open/close cycles, with the gearbox in neutral,
during which the SD3 will acquire the necessary data for calculating the kiss point
correctly.
Wait for the "end of data acquisition procedure" message to appear on the display and for
the instrument panel node to give an audible alert signal.
The SD3 display will show the "TRANSMISSIBILITY" graph, i.e. the torque value as a
function of clutch position (red) and the two reference curves (black), which indicate the
tolerance range within which the torque ransmissibility curve must be positioned.
Reference curves
Transmissibility curve
Maserati Academy
335
Introduction to Maserati
Robotized Gearbox
The system will automatically check that the torque transmissibility curve falls within the
two tolerance curves.
Depending on the result of processing, there can be two different outcomes:
•
The data are correct, and the system will thus continue with the next phases of data
acquisition.
•
The data are incorrect, the procedure is canceled and an error message is
displayed, showing how to correct the error.
At the end of each sequence of data acquisition and processing, the following parameters
will be displayed:
•
Number of breakways
•
Kiss point value (bit,mm)
•
Value of dispersal of points (bit)
If completed correctly, the procedure will be repeated twice more.
On completion of the three phases, the average kiss point value will be calculated, and
this value will be saved by the gearbox control unit.
The SD3 display will show the message "KISS POINT SAVED CORRECTLY".
SELF LEARNING OF ACCELERATION SENSOR OFFSET (Sofast III onward):
After replacement or disconnection/reconnection of the accelerometer or replacement of
the transmission control module (NCR), it is necessary to run the accelerometer
autocalibration procedure.
Therefore the vehicle must be positionned on a level surface, with the tyres at their correct
pressure and with correct wheel alignment.
The procedure can be found in the “Active diagnosis” menu of the SD3 tester.
This procedure should take about 30 seconds, with a checking time of 40 seconds. Once
this time is up, if the procedure has not finished, it has failed.
If the procedure has been completed successfully, and no further adjustments are
necessary, turn the ignition key to “OFF” and wait for at least 25 seconds. Minimum time
for allowing the control unit to save the parameters read.
Note: for vehicles without dedicated longitudinal acceleration sensor (assembly 24275
onward), the longitudinal acceleration data is received from the ABS/ESP unit by the CAN
line. Also in this case the sensor self-learning procedure must be performed in the same
way, as the CAN received data is a raw value.
Maserati Academy
336
Introduction to Maserati
Robotized Gearbox
SELF-LEARNING OF THE GEARCHANGE GRID:
The Self-learning of the gearchange grid (simply indicated by “self learning”) is activated
by means of an instruction from the tester with the car stationary and the ignition switched
to On. This operation teaches the ECU the areas of engagement and selection for the
gearbox with which it is associated. On completion of the procedure, the system
automatically checks whether learning has taken place correctly. Make sure that the
battery is charged, the handbrake is released and the car is moving slightly (by pushing) in
the event that self-learning is blocked due to sticking when engaging gears.
Note: In case the self learning does not end successfully, check if the hydraulic actuator
bleeding has been correctly performed.
Note (2): Self learning values are stored inside the NCR at the successive “Key Off”.
SELF LEARNING OF THE SUPERFAST SHIFT (Sofast 4 onward):
Where the self learning of the gearchange grid has for purpose to calibrate the travel of
the gear selection and gear engagement movement, the Superfast shift self learning has
been created to optimize the synchronization of the various gearshift related actions.
MC-SuperFAST
Break in acceleration
drops to 100ms
t1
t2
t3
time
Gear shift time: 40ms
To obtain the shortest possible total gearshift time, it is of upmost importance that the
different phases of a complete gearchange operation (power cut-off and clutch opening,
gear disengagement, gear selection, gear engagement, clutch closing and power restore)
are perfectly synchronised. During the Superfast shift self-learning procedure, the NCR
will calibrate the duration of the solenoid valve activation and the actual gearshift for every
gear.
This procedure can be activated with the diagnostic tester and needs to follow after
completion of the self-learning of the gearchange grid.
Note: in case the Superfast shift self learning procedure has not been performed, a
specific DTC will be stored by the NCR (P1768) and the Superfast gearshift mode will be
disabled.
Maserati Academy
337
Introduction to Maserati
Robotized Gearbox
CALCULATION OF THE GEARBOX GRID:
The gearchange grid, as recorded by the NCR by means of the selection and engagement
position sensors, is presented in a field of 1024 x 1024 bits.
The grid is made up by the secure engagement thresholds (min / max) and secure
selection thresholds (min / max) for all gears + neutral. These thresholds are calibrated
during the self-learning of the gearchange grid.
ENGAGEMENT (bit)
1024
637
635
6
723
713
713
700
46
7
430
326
55
3
320
100
100
0
3
512
643
645
1
527
529
382
310
5
950
N
714
590
32
6
512
2 4
518
520
R
950
950
950
950
396
398
100
950
100
1024
SELECTION (bit)
The threshold values listed can be found in the parameter environment in SD3. All these
values subsequently simply transferred to a spreadsheet to illustrate what they represent
on the vehicle.
The thresholds will define the field of each gear + neutral.
Subsequently, the actual finger position (engagement + selection) for each gear + neutral
must be entered in the spreadsheet. Therefore each gear mus be selected after which the
actual position can be read out with SD3 (parameter environment).
Once the engagement and selection values have been transcribed by means of the
spreadsheet, we can generate the gearbox grid to check for correct centering of the
actuator. This operation is useful if gear engagement problems persist after the selflearning process has been completed correctly. To check that the finger is properly
centered and nowhere near “limit conditions”, we check the gear engagement grid.
Maserati Academy
338
Introduction to Maserati
Robotized Gearbox
Engagement:
MINIMUM SECURE ENGAGEMENT THRESHOLD - NEUTRAL
430
MINIMUM SECURE ENGAGEMENT THRESHOLD - FIRST
100
MINIMUM SECURE ENGAGEMENT THRESHOLD - SECOND
700
MINIMUM SECURE ENGAGEMENT THRESHOLD - THIRD
100
MINIMUM SECURE ENGAGEMENT THRESHOLD - FOURTH
723
MINIMUM SECURE ENGAGEMENT THRESHOLD - FIFTH
100
MINIMUM SECURE ENGAGEMENT THRESHOLD - SIXTH
713
MINIMUM SECURE ENGAGEMENT THRESHOLD - REVERSE
713
MAXIMUM SECURE ENGAGEMENT THRESHOLD - NEUTRAL
590
MAXIMUM SECURE ENGAGEMENT THRESHOLD - FIRST
326
MAXIMUM SECURE ENGAGEMENT THRESHOLD - SECOND
950
MAXIMUM SECURE ENGAGEMENT THRESHOLD - THIRD
310
MAXIMUM SECURE ENGAGEMENT THRESHOLD - FOURTH
950
MAXIMUM SECURE ENGAGEMENT THRESHOLD - FIFTH
320
MAXIMUM SECURE ENGAGEMENT THRESHOLD - SIXTH
950
MAXIMUM SECURE ENGAGEMENT THRESHOLD - REVERSE
950
These values are purely guideline and cannot be used for
comparison purposes during diagnosis
The SECURE ENGAGEMENT thresholds indicate the MINIMUM/MAXIMUM value of the
engagement stroke expressed in bits, below which diagnosis is activated, with the result
that secure engagement of the gear is not recognized (gear indicator flashing further to
retry).
Maserati Academy
339
Introduction to Maserati
Robotized Gearbox
Selection:
MINIMUM SELECTION THRESHOLD - NEUTRAL
326
MINIMUM SELECTION THRESHOLD - FIRST
382
MINIMUM SELECTION THRESHOLD - SECOND
398
MINIMUM SELECTION THRESHOLD - THIRD
529
MINIMUM SELECTION THRESHOLD - FOURTH
520
MINIMUM SELECTION THRESHOLD - FIFTH
645
MINIMUM SELECTION THRESHOLD - SIXTH
637
MINIMUM SELECTION THRESHOLD - REVERSE
100
MAXIMUM SELECTION THRESHOLD - NEUTRAL
714
MAXIMUM SELECTION THRESHOLD - FIRST
527
MAXIMUM SELECTION THRESHOLD - SECOND
518
MAXIMUM SELECTION THRESHOLD - THIRD
643
MAXIMUM SELECTION THRESHOLD - FOURTH
635
MAXIMUM SELECTION THRESHOLD - FIFTH
950
MAXIMUM SELECTION THRESHOLD - SIXTH
950
MAXIMUM SELECTION THRESHOLD - REVERSE
396
These values are purely
guideline and cannot be
used for comparison
purposes during
diagnosis
Outside of these thresholds, diagnosis of the recognition of the selected position is
activated (gear indicator flashing further to retry).
The selection thresholds defined by the MIN/MAX values (expressed in bits) in the
following gearshift ranges:
1st – 2nd
2nd – 3rd
3rd – 4th
4th – 5th
5th – 6th
REVERSE
Maserati Academy
340
Introduction to Maserati
Robotized Gearbox
CLUTCH ACTUATOR BLEEDING:
The procedure becomes necessary if air bubbles need to be eliminated or following
disassembly of a component of the hydraulic clutch circuit. Bleeding is done by using the
bleed screw on the clutch housing.
The procedure involves bleeding the system
first through the bleed screw located next to
the connection block with the clutch housing
and subsequently through its counterpart on
the side (up to assembly 14804) or underneath
the clutch housing.
The clutch bleed valve is located on the clutch housing. There are two different versions:
up to assembly 14803
Assembly 14804 onward
With the SD3, start the clutch bleeding procedure while adding oil continuously into the
electro-actuated gearbox oil reservoir, in such a way that there can be no infiltration of air.
The bleeding procedure ends when the oil coming out of the bleed screw no longer
contains any air.
Use the SD3 to run the gearbox through a sequence of gear changes to check that the
pump is working correctly.
At the end of the cycle, check the level of the oil in the reservoir. Top up if necessary.
Maserati Academy
341
Introduction to Maserati
Robotized Gearbox
HYDRAULIC ACTUATOR BLEEDING:
To access the actuator bleed screws, it is necessary to remove the actuator, while leaving
it connected to the electrical and hydraulic system.
Remove the actuator and support it correctly so as to ensure safe working conditions.
Important:
During bleeding, support the actuator in such a way that the sensor cables are not too taut
and the hoses are not bent to excessively tight angles. Keep your hands away from the
actuator while bleeding is in progress.
•
Connect the SD3 diagnosis tester to the diagnosis socket.
•
From the main menu, go to “Active diagnosis".
•
Check and top up the oil in the reservoir if necessary.
•
Loosen the three actuator bleed screws (1) by two complete turns.
On completion of the procedure, execute self-learning of the engagement and selection
thresholds by choosing the “self-learning" function from the “Active diagnosis" menu.
Maserati Academy
342
Introduction to Maserati
Robotized Gearbox
SERVICING OPERATIONS FOR CARS EQUIPPED WITH A GEARBOX
MANAGEMENT SYSTEM PRIOR TO SOFAST II
MASERATI M138
MASERATI M144
HW CFC 201 (SOFAST) up to assembly
12203
HW CFC 201(SOFAST)
Action
Required servicing operation for
PRE - SOFAST II
Clutch replacement *
Clutch bleeding procedure
(clutch balancing for M138)
Kiss point adjustment
Gearbox replacement
Self-learning
Hydraulic actuator replacement
Hydraulic actuator bleeding
Self-learning
Replacement of solenoid valves EV1-23-4-5
Gearbox actuator bleeding
Self-learning
Replacement of clutch solenoid valve
EVF
Clutch actuator bleeding
Pump replacement
Hydraulic actuator bleeding
NCR replacement
Remote loading of software
Reading of closed clutch value from new on
the replaced NCR and setting the value on
the new NCR
Self-learning
Kiss point adjustment
* Clutch replacement for pre-SOFAST cars: in this case the CLOSED CLUTCH VALUE
FROM NEW is fundamental. Before saving/confirming, it is imperative to allow the clutch
to bed in briefly by running in the disc.
Maserati Academy
343
Introduction to Maserati
Robotized Gearbox
SERVICING OPERATIONS FOR CARS EQUIPPED WITH SOFAST II GEARBOX
MANAGEMENT SYSTEM
MASERATI M138
MASERATI M139 EUROPE version
HW CFC 231 (SOFAST II) from assembly
12204
HW CFC 231 (SOFAST II) up to
assembly 18821
Action
Required servicing operation for
SOFAST II
Clutch replacement
Clutch bleeding procedure
Kiss Point (includes resetting the clutch
degradation index and configuring the clutch)
Gearbox replacement
Self-learning
Check gear change grid
Hydraulic actuator replacement
Hydraulic actuator bleeding
Self-learning
Replacement of solenoid valves EV12-3-4-5
Gearbox actuator bleeding
Self-learning
Replacement of clutch solenoid valve
EVF
Clutch actuator bleeding
Kiss Point (includes resetting the clutch
degradation index and configuring the clutch)
Pump replacement
Hydraulic actuator bleeding
NCR replacement
Remote loading of software
Reading of closed clutch value from new on
the replaced NCR and setting the value on the
new NCR
Self-learning
Kiss point
Maserati Academy
344
Introduction to Maserati
Robotized Gearbox
SERVICING OPERATIONS FOR CARS EQUIPPED WITH SOFAST III AND
SOFAST III+ GEARBOX MANAGEMENT SYSTEMS
MASERATI M139 EUROPE version
MASERATI M139 US version
HW CFC 301(SOFAST III) from assembly
18822
HW CFC 301 (SOFAST III) up to
assembly 21925
HW CFC 301(SOFAST III+) from assembly
21925
HW CFC 301 (SOFAST III+) from
assembly 21926
Action
Required servicing operation for
SOFAST III and SOFAST III+
Clutch replacement
Clutch bleeding procedure
Calibration of DEIS parameters
Kiss Point (includes resetting the clutch
degradation index and configuring the clutch)
Gearbox replacement
Self-learning
Hydraulic actuator replacement
Hydraulic actuator bleeding
Self-learning
Replacement of solenoid valves EV12-3-4-5
Gearbox actuator bleeding
Self-learning
Replacement of clutch solenoid valve
EVF
Clutch actuator bleeding
Calibration of DEIS parameters
Kiss Point (includes resetting the clutch
degradation index and configuring the clutch)
Pump replacement
Hydraulic actuator bleeding
NCR replacement
Remote loading of software
Calibration of DEIS parameters
Self-learning
Reading of closed clutch value from new on
the replaced NCR and setting the value on the
new NCR
Autocalibration of acceleration sensor offset
Kiss point
Acceleration sensor replacement
or ABS unit replacement
Autocalibration of acceleration sensor offset
Maserati Academy
345
Introduction to Maserati
Robotized Gearbox
SERVICING OPERATIONS FOR CARS EQUIPPED WITH SOFAST 4 GEARBOX
MANAGEMENT SYSTEM
MASERATI M145 All markets
HW CFC 301 (hardware ECU is identical to SOFAST III)
Action
Required servicing operation for
SOFAST IV
Clutch replacement
Clutch bleeding procedure
Calibration of DEIS parameters
Kiss point (includes resetting the clutch
degradation index and configuring the clutch)
Gearbox replacement
Self-learning
SuperFast Shift self-learning
Hydraulic actuator replacement
Hydraulic actuator bleeding
Self-learning
SuperFast Shift self-learning
Replacement of solenoid valves EV12-3-4-5
Gearbox actuator bleeding
Self-learning
SuperFast Shift self-learning
Replacement of clutch solenoid valve
EVF
Clutch actuator bleeding
Calibration of DEIS parameters
Kiss Point (includes resetting the clutch
degradation index and configuring the clutch)
Pump replacement
Hydraulic actuator bleeding
NCR replacement
Remote loading of software
Calibration of DEIS parameters
Self-learning
SuperFast Shift self-learning
Reading of closed clutch value from new on
the replaced NCR and setting of this value on
the new NCR
Autocalibration of acceleration sensor offset
Kiss point
Acceleration sensor replacement
or ABS unit replacement
Autocalibration of acceleration sensor offset
Note: In any event, it is advisable to perform the self-learning procedures (DEIS; SelfLearning, SuperFast Shift, Accelerometer) during each servicing operation.
Maserati Academy
346
Introduction to Maserati
ZF automatic 6-speed gearbox
ZF Automatic 6-speed gearbox
Maserati Academy
347
Introduction to Maserati
ZF automatic 6-speed gearbox
Introduction
A completely new automatic six speed gearbox (ZF 6HP26) was introduced for the
Maserati Quattroporte with automatic transmission, presented in January 2007. Also the
Maserati GranTurismo uses the same gearbox for the automatic transmission version.
The Gearbox is built by ZF and has been developed in cooperation with Maserati and
Bosch (electronic control) to offer the best possible compromise between driving
dynamics, fuel economy and comfort. The gearbox contains 6 electro-hydraulically
controlled gears and a torque converter with lock-up clutch and anti-slip function.
The automatic gearbox has a self-adaptive control system that adjusts the type of
gearshift strategy, selecting the gear most suited to the driving conditions and driving
style. The driver can choose from four different driving modes: Auto Normal, Auto Sport
(selectable by pressing the SPORT button), Low-grip /Auto ICE (selectable by pressing
the ICE button) and Manual (selectable by shifting the gearshift lever from "D" to the left).
For the Auto Normal and Auto Sport driving modes there are two different types of
gearshifting, automatically selected by the gearbox/engine control system based on the
driving style (detected through the accelerator pedal and the intensity of lateral and
longitudinal acceleration) and the gradient of the road.
Electronic control:
The electronic control of the gearbox is the “MECHATRONIC” type, meaning that both the
hydraulic and the electronic control unit are integrated in a single unit inside the gearbox.
This ECU provides dynamic gear ratio selection and has a sequential gear selection
program. The adaptive shift strategy memory can be reset by performing the Cycle
function with SD3 diagnostic tester. By doing this the gearshift strategy will return to its
default settings.
Maserati Academy
348
Introduction to Maserati
ZF automatic 6-speed gearbox
Technical specifications
Maximum torque:
Torque converter:
Cooling system:
Gearbox oil:
max 600 Nm
Hydrodynamic converter with regulated clutch
Oil/water exchanger positioned underneath the engine
intake manifold
Shell M1375.4 ATF (no oil change or refilling required)
Oil quantity:
•
Gearbox without converter and oil radiator: 5.8 l
•
Torque converter:
3.7 L
•
Oil radiator with relative pipes:
0,525 L
Total weight:
Gear ratios:
1°:
2°:
3°:
4°:
5°:
6°:
4.171
2.340
1.521
1.143
0.867
0.691
142 kg (including oil and gearbox oil radiator)
Reverse:
3.403
Parts available for servicing:
•
Torque converter (complete unit)
•
Mechatronic (complete unit)
•
Oil sump
•
Oil sump sealing
•
Oil filter
•
Rubber oil sleeves (4 pieces)
•
Rubber oil supply sealing Mechatronic
•
Input shaft oil sealing
•
Output shaft oil sealing
•
Output shaft flange and locking nut
•
Oil sealing behind output shaft flange locking nut
Maserati Academy
349
Introduction to Maserati
ZF automatic 6-speed gearbox
Gearbox mechanical
The mechanical transmission devices are made up of planetary gears. The components
are driven by an electro-hydraulic system which incorporates the hydraulic and electronic
control units in a singe control unit (Mechatronic) fitted on the gearbox.
Engine power reaches the transmission by means of a hydrodynamic torque converter
with integrated lock-up type clutch (WK).
The 6 forward gears and the reverse gear are obtained by means of a double planetary
gear (Ravigneaux) and a front-mounted simple planetary gear. The integrated operating
modes of the planetary gears are patented (Lepelletier). The individual gear ratios are
obtained by deviating the incoming torque flow through the various planetary gear
components and by braking others. For this purpose various couplings and brakes are
used.
Tightening torque of output flange locking nut: 60Nm
Maserati Academy
350
Introduction to Maserati
ZF automatic 6-speed gearbox
Gear disengagement control logic
A further innovation is the option of automatic disengagement when the vehicle is
stationary. This means that the gearbox is disconnected from the kinematic mechanisms
when it is in standby (clutch A open). This results in a further reduction of fuel
consumption.
With the engine idling, the vehicle stationary and the gearshift lever in “D”, the torque
converter transmits a specific torque value that slightly moves the vehicle forward if the
brake pedal is not applied. If the brake pedal is applied, the converter is forced to dissipate
the power by slowing down the engine RPM, which must be compensated by increasing
the minimum torque (by further opening the throttle) until obtaining the correct idling RPM.
This results in higher fuel consumption and greater force required on the pedal (for
example, to hold the vehicle stationary when stopping at traffic lights or stop signs) which
clearly negatively affects driving comfort and handling. Disengagement therefore occurs if
a gear is engaged when the vehicle is stationary, depending on different parameters
monitored by the gearbox node.
Torque converter
1.
2.
3.
Turbine
Stator
Pump
The torque converter is composed of a toroidal-shaped chamber containing two elements:
a centrifugal pump connected to the crankshaft and a hydraulic or turbine motor
positioned in front of the pump and connected to the gearbox input shaft. The two parts
face but do not touch each other and the chamber is filled with low-viscosity oil. The pump
is basically a wheel with radially arranged blades. When turning, it pushes the fluid
towards the outside by effect of the centrifugal force. The fluid also acquires angular
momentum. The motor is likewise composed of a bladed wheel. The liquid that the pump
pushes to the outside of the device is forced to return to the centre through the turbine
blades, driving it so that it rotates.
Maserati Academy
351
Introduction to Maserati
ZF automatic 6-speed gearbox
Pump
Coated collar
(converter with lock-up clutch)
Turbine
Stator
Piston
(converter with lock-up clutch)
One way clutch
Converter cover
Convertor hub
Stator hub
Turbine hub
Converter stub axle
Flywheel fastening
Once the fluid has returned to the centre, it is again ejected by the turbine thus completing
the cycle. Even if the motor section is off, the spiral movement of the fluid produces a
twisting moment at the output. The torque converter has, by nature, a slipping feature
which causes a loss of energy in the form of heat dispersed by the fluid. To improve
energy efficiency, modern converters are equipped with an integrated clutch system
which mechanically joins the pump and the motor when the onboard computer detects a
constant cruising speed. The torque converter (“Trilok" converter) is composed of a pump
wheel or impeller, a turbine and a flow reaction component (stator) which multiplies the
torque delivered.Another important element for converter operation is the oil used for
torque delivery.
Maserati Academy
352
Introduction to Maserati
ZF automatic 6-speed gearbox
Lock-up clutch
Clutch closed
Clutch open
A torque converter lock-up clutch (WK) is a device that makes it possible to eliminate the
slipping typical of the torque converter and contributes to optimise fuel consumption.
The torque converter with lock-up clutch has a controlled activation and release system.
During the adjustment stage, there is a minimal difference between the RPM of the pump
and that of the turbine. This has allowed us to reduce the vibrations transmitted by the
engine before they reach the transmission: this process can be further boosted by the
torsion vibration damper. This principle provides smoother gearshifting and noise
reduction.
The lock-up clutch can be activated in any gear, but only in conditions of constant driving
speed. The lock-up clutch will be disengaged during acceleration or braking.
Maserati Academy
353
Introduction to Maserati
ZF automatic 6-speed gearbox
Parking Lock mechanism
Gear
Parking lock pawl
Locking cone
Compression spring
Connecting rod
Release spring
Pin
Engagement collar
Leg spring
Drive collar
Selection
lever
Selection shaft
The parking lock mechanism is a device that stops the vehicle from moving. It is activated
by a spring when the vehicle is stationary. A pawl wedges into the parking lock gear teeth,
thus preventing the transmission output shaft from rotating. Rear axle torque lock is
obtained by means of the output shaft.
Warning: only put the selector lever in the Park position when the vehicle is stationary.
Maserati Academy
354
Introduction to Maserati
ZF automatic 6-speed gearbox
Gear engagement
The coupling elements are used for
gearshifting under load without cutting
the power flow.
The clutches A, B and E deliver the
engine power to the planetary gears.
The brakes C and D buck the movement
of other transmission devices in order to
obtain the required resistance.
As engagement components, in addition to the torque converter with lock-up clutch (WK),
there are three rotary multidisc clutches (A, B and E) and two fixed multidisc brakes (C
and D).
Gear
Clutch
A,
1
*
2
*
3
*
4
*
Brake
B
E
C
Gear
D
*
4,171
*
2.34
*
5
1,521
*
6
*
1,143
*
0,867
*
R
*
0,691
*
*
-3,403
6HP26
Maserati Academy
Clutch logic
B
Brake
E
WK
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
C
•
•
•
•
•
C e n tra l g e a r 1 ,
d o u b le p la n e ta ry
gear
•
•
•
C e n tra l g e a r 1 ,
d o u b le p la n e ta ry
gear
x
x
x
x
x
x
P la n e ta ry h o ld e r,
s in g le p la n e ta ry
gear
•
D
•
•
•
•
S a te llite h o ld e r,
d o u b le p la n e ta ry
gear
A
C lu tc h c o n tro l o n
c o n v e rte r
6
S a te llite h o ld e r,
d o u b le p la n e ta ry
gear
Clutch
C lu tc h c o n tro l
o n g e a r lo g ic
M a in p re s s u re
B ra k e D C lu tc h
E
x
x
x
x
B ra k e C
x
x
x
S e le c tio n v a lv e
1
Parking
reverse
neutral
1st gear
2nd gear
3rd gear
4th gear
5th gear
6th gear
1
C lu tc h A
Solenoid valve
1
Solenoid valve logic
Pressure - electronic pressure control valve
2
3
4
5
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
x
C lu tc h B
Pos/gear
355
Introduction to Maserati
ZF automatic 6-speed gearbox
Mechatronic
The Mechatronic module is composed of a hydraulic selection control unit and an
electronic control unit. The hydraulic, electrical and electronic components are
incorporated in a single unit. The Mechatronic module is positioned near the gearbox oil
sump. The main advantages of this module are: fewer electrical connections (which are
subject to faults) and automatic calibration of the hardware by the software.
This involves: very accurate tolerances, improved gearshift response, enhanced driving
comfort, gearshift quality optimisation, improved reliability thanks to the fewer electrical
connections and interfaces.
Electrostatic discharge
For any operations on the Mechatronic module, take the appropriate precautions in terms
of safety, especially to prevent electrostatic discharge (ESD).
The human body, if electrically charged but not properly earthed, becomes an electrostatic
“cloud” and may cause damage to the electronic components. It is therefore extremely
important to take appropriate precautions, like conductive shoes and ESD protective
gloves. To prevent any damage from electrostatic discharge, appropriate precautions
must always be taken in the following cases:
•
•
•
•
•
•
When receiving goods
In the inspection area of the goods received
In the workshops, and in the spare parts warehouse even if staying there for only
short periods of time
In the shipping/delivery area
In the maritime transport or shipping area
During handling, fitting and removal of the Mechatronic module
Keep the packaging material and the ESD protective film so that they can be used when
returning the parts removed from the transmission.
Maserati Academy
356
Introduction to Maserati
ZF automatic 6-speed gearbox
Mechatronic unit removal
In order to remove the mechatronic module, carry out the following steps:
•
Drain the automatic gearbox oil
•
Disconnect the wiring harnass connector from the adapter (1)
•
Undo the 21 Torx screws that secure the oil sump on the gearbox and then remove
the oil sump and the sealing strip.
•
Pull down the adapter locking lever (2).
•
Remove the connector adapter (3) which is pressure-fitted with two O-rings by pulling
it out.
•
Undo the 10 torx screws which attach the Mechatronic unit to the gearbox housing to
remove the Mechatronic.
1
3
2
CAUTION!
To remove the mechatronic, undo only the screws marked in red
Maserati Academy
357
Introduction to Maserati
ZF automatic 6-speed gearbox
Mechatronic unit refitment
Position sensor
Electronic module
Hydraulic module
Position selector
CAUTION!
When the Mechatronic module is been
refitted, be extremely careful that you
correctly fit the gear position selector whit
respect to the position sensor.
CAUTION!
Before fitting the Mechatronic
module, check that the oil
delivery duct is properly
positioned.
Maserati Academy
358
Introduction to Maserati
ZF automatic 6-speed gearbox
When refitting, follow the removal procedures in reverse order and tighten the
Mechatronic control unit screws to a torque of 8.0 ± 0.8 Nm following the sequence shown
in the figure below.
Gearbox oil topping up and level check procedure
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Position the vehicle as level as possible on the car hoist.
It is essential that the gearbox oil temperature is between 50°C and 60°C
It is advisable to check the level when the oil temperature is 55°C
Connect the SD3 tester and access “SERIAL DIAGNOSTICS”
Subsequently Select "INDIVIDUAL ECU DIAGNOSTICS”
Then select the vehicle and the ECU involved.
Wait for the ECU and serial number to be loaded.
Select “PARAMETER ENVIRONMENT” and then “GENERAL PARAMETERS 1”.
Then access the vehicle data and read the “TRANSMISSION OIL TEMPERATURE”
value.
Starting the checking procedure:
Check the oil temperature : If the temperature is above 60°C, wait until it cools down.
If the temperature is below 50°C, move the gearshift lever to REVERSE and then to
DRIVE, holding it in each position for at least 3 seconds.
Always keep the wheels locked.
Check the temperature with the SD3 tester; if it has risen to about 55°C, turn off the
engine and then search for the gearbox ECU errors and delete them.
Maserati Academy
359
Introduction to Maserati
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
ZF automatic 6-speed gearbox
Start the engine and let it run in idle, then unscrew the oil filler cap (1).
The sump is filled “to the brim” with oil, therefore if oil spills out when the cap is
unscrewed, no top-up is necessary.
WITH THE ENGINE OFF: position the tool in the filling hole on the sump and pump
in oil until it starts spilling out.
WITH THE ENGINE IDLING: continue filling with gearbox oil until it starts spilling out
Keeping the engine running, connect the SD3 tester and access “SERIAL
DIAGNOSTICS”
Subsequently Select "INDIVIDUAL ECU DIAGNOSTICS”
Then select the vehicle and the ECU involved.
Wait for the ECU and serial number to be loaded.
Select “PARAMETER ENVIRONMENT” and then “GENERAL PARAMETERS 1”.
Then access the vehicle data and read the “TRANSMISSION OIL TEMPERATURE”
value.
Check that the gearbox oil temperature is between 50°C and 55°C.
Continue filling with oil until it starts spilling out.
Tighten the oil filler cap (1) to a torque of 60 Nm.
1
CAUTION!
Maserati Academy
EXCLUSIVELY USE OIL TYPE SHELL M1375.4 ATF
360
Introduction to Maserati
Modular Transmission Shaft
Modular Transmission Shaft
For vehicles fitted with the ZF automatic transmission, a new modular transmission shaft
is applied. The shaft needs to be balanced after removing one or more components of the
transmission system. This is done using tool DSE1, by applying balancing weights on the
differential coupling flange.
The modular transmission shaft was chosen for technical reasons, due to the different
alignment of the engine axis with respect to the rear differential axis, which makes the
homokinetical motion transmission impossible.
Modular Transmission shaft balancing procedure
The balancing kit contains a set of nuts of known weight with which the balancing weight
calculated by the instrument must be approximated. As these nuts will be fitted on the
retaining bolts of the transmission shaft coupling flanges, the bolts need to be clearly
identified so that the fitting positions indicated by the instrument are respected. Actually,
unlike wheel balancing, where the balancing weight can be fitted in any position along the
perimeter of the wheel rim, in this case there are six fixed positions on the rear of the shaft
fastening flange.
The instrument thus divides the result into
weights equivalent to the theoretical balancing
weight. These weights must be approximated
with the available nuts, obtaining an overall
effect equivalent to that of one balancing weight.
Maserati Academy
361
Introduction to Maserati
Modular Transmission Shaft
To perform the test, you need to use the following instruments together with the SD3
diagnostic tester: DSE1 or DSE2
The kit contains two B&K 4508 accelerometers, but only one of the two shall be used for
the balancing procedure. The cables required to connect to the DSE1/DSE2 instrument
are also provided in the kit.
DSE2 instrument
B&K 4508 accelerometers
RPM sensor
Prepare the SD3 tester connecting it to the DSE1/DSE2 instrument and the DC/DC
converter, as described below.
8
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
7
9
10
3
4
5
1 2
8.
6
9.
10.
Maserati Academy
SD3 connection
SD3 connection
CAN connector
V BATT connector
SD3 CBL 07
Power supply
DC/DC converter (To
be used only in case
the EOBD connection
is not used)
DSE1/DSE2
instrument
Grey connector cable
RS232 – DSE1/2
Black connector cable
SD3 – DC/DC
converter
362
Introduction to Maserati
Modular Transmission Shaft
Preparing the vehicle
Position the vehicle on a hoist.
Remove the two rear wheels and position the vehicle on mounts which must be approx. 18
– 20 cm high.
These mounts must hold the vehicle level and compensate for the absence of the wheels.
Provisionally use the rubber bushings positioned underneath the hub carrier. Specific
mounts of predefined height are being tested, and these will rest in a less delicate area to
also facilitate levelling the vehicle. Cut some stickers 0.5 cm wide and 4 cm long out of a
reflective adhesive sheet of paper.
Apply the sticker (A) on the transmission shaft. The sticker must be positioned in
correspondence to the flange stud bolt marked with number 1 (B).
If present, remove all the balancing weights applied on the flange stud bolts before starting
the balancing procedure.
A
B
Positioning the RPM sensor
Position the RPM sensor (3) so that it is fully
perpendicular to the ground and in line with
the transmission shaft (X), at a distance of
approximately 50 cm from the shaft.
To do this, you can, for example:
Fit a mount (1) equipped with a base (2) to
support the speed sensor (3). The material is
not provided in the kit and must therefore be
purchased locally.
Securely fasten the sensor on the relative
mount and position it as described above.
CAUTION! Once positioned, the sensor must
not be moved for the entire duration of the
balancing procedure so as not to alter the
reference point for the instrument.
Maserati Academy
363
Introduction to Maserati
Modular Transmission Shaft
Positioning the accelerometer
The B&K 4508 accelerometer must be fitted underneath the differential near the
transmission shaft (Fig. 2)
Using HEPTANE, remove any residues of glue or grease from the flat surface on the
differential where the accelerometer holder will be positioned.
Apply epoxy glue in the centre of the flat surface of the accelerometer holder (1).
Position the accelerometer holder (1) on the differential and hold it down for about 20
seconds, so that it adheres properly.
Fit the accelerometer (2) on its holder (1).
Connecting the DSE1/DSE2 components:
Connect the speed sensor (1) cable and the accelerometer (2) cable to the
DSE1/DSE2.
Maserati Academy
364
Introduction to Maserati
Modular Transmission Shaft
Balancing cycle with SD3. (Phase I)
Start the SD3 tester, access the “SERIAL DIAGNOSTICS” environment and then
“INDIVIDUAL ECU DIAGNOSTICS”.
Select “TOOLS” and then “ALL”.
Select the item relating to transmission shaft balancing for the vehicle M139EV07.
A page will be displayed showing the following options.
DISPLAY DATA
ACTIVATE BALANCING
SET TEST WEIGHTS
UPDATE CARD
EXIT
Select “UPDATE CARD”.
A page will appear showing the software version installed on SD3 and on DSE1/DSE2. If
the software version of DSE1/DSE2 does not coincide with the version installed on SD3,
update it by selecting “YES”. If this is not the case, select “NO” and return to the
home page.
Select “ACTIVATE BALANCING”.
With the help of a second operator seated in the vehicle, start the engine, check that the
EPB (Electronic Parking Brake) is disengaged and manually deactivate the MSP function.
Select “SEQUENTIAL MANUAL” gearbox operation.
Balancing cycle with SD3. (Phase II)
The shaft balancing procedure is divided into three phases:
INITIAL RUN
TRIAL RUN
FINAL RUN
All three phases are guided “step-by-step” by the SD3 program. We recommended
that you carefully follow the instructions displayed on the SD3.
Maserati Academy
365
Introduction to Maserati
Modular Transmission Shaft
INITIAL RUN
The INITIAL RUN phase is a data acquisition phase performed by the tester. The tester
measures the shaft unbalance and stores the data as a basis for comparison of the
subsequent measurements
For data acquisition, the transmission shaft must run at a speed between 2850 – 3150
RPM (equivalent to 2800 engine RPM read on the instrument panel when 5th gear is
selected) and must be kept at this speed throughout the data acquisition phase.
To easily reach the required RPM, set “SEQUENTIAL MANUAL” operation to
progressively arrive at engaging 5th gear.
Hold the accelerator pedal depressed until reaching the required RPM values, keep them
constant throughout the data acquisition phase and wait for the result.
Initial Run OK
If the data acquisition phase is successfully completed, it means that the tester has been
calibrated using an unbalance value that does not exceed the maximum value set in the
tester.
Subsequently, you automatically go to the TRIAL RUN phase.
Initial Run NOT OK
If the data acquisition phase is not completed successfully, it means that the tester has
measured an unbalance value that exceeds the maximum value set in the tester.
The system will automatically prompt you to position a rebalancing weight of 4.5
grams on the flange stud bolt marked with number 1 (Position 1).
Maserati Academy
366
Introduction to Maserati
Modular Transmission Shaft
Repeat the INITIAL RUN phase.
If the unbalance value is still not compensated, the system will automatically prompt you to
move the rebalancing weight from Position 1 to Position 2 and to repeat the INITIAL RUN
phase. This process will be repeated (going through the various positions from 1 to 6) until
the correct position for the rebalancing weight is found.
Once the correct position for the rebalancing weight has been found, you will automatically
go to the TRIAL RUN phase
CAUTION. If the correct position for the rebalancing weight is not found, remove the
rebalancing weight of 4.5 grams and repeat the cycle using a weight of 7.5 grams.
Once the correct position for the rebalancing weight has been found, you will
automatically go to the TRIAL RUN phase
CAUTION. If the correct position for the rebalancing weight is not found even when using
the weight of 7.5 grams, carefully check all the components connected to the transmission
shaft (rear differential, axle shafts etc.).
When you have inspected all the mechanical components, repeat the entire cycle with the
rebalancing weight of 4.5 grams (7.5 grams if necessary).
If the procedures fails again, contact the Maserati Technical Service Department.
CAUTION!
Should the adhesive tape bearing the
corresponding number for each stud
bolt not be present, it is important to
assign the correct numbering: affix the
number 1 in correspondence to a stud
bolt and then the other numbers with
clockwise orientation.
Maserati Academy
367
Introduction to Maserati
Modular Transmission Shaft
TRIAL RUN
This is the phase where the tester reads the various positions to correct the unbalance.
The TRIAL RUN phase consists of two different actions, depending on whether or not the
INITIAL RUN is completed successfully the first time it is performed.
a) INITIAL RUN OK on first attempt. The system automatically prompts you to position a
reference weight of 4.5 grams in Position 1.
b) INITIAL RUN NOT OK on first attempt. The system automatically prompts you to
position a reference weight of 4.5 grams in the position where the rebalancing weight
is present.
Start the TRIAL RUN procedure from the SD3.
CAUTION. In condition (a) described above, the reference weight of 4.5 grams in Position
1 might cause an excessive unbalance not readable by the tester. In this case, the tester
will automatically prompt you to position the same reference weight in Position 4. Repeat
the TRIAL RUN phase with the weight in Position 4.
The TRIAL RUN procedure ends with a
page displaying a table:
A
“Value
in
grams”
B
“Value
in
grams”
C
“Value
in
grams”
A: Ideal value (information only)
B: Number of the flange stud bolt where you
have to position the first correction weight
(whose value in grams is indicated in the next
column)
C: Number of the flange stud bolt where you
have to position the second correction weight
(whose value in grams is indicated in the next
column)
Remove the reference weight of 4.5 grams previously positioned.
Apply the correction weights as described in the table.
Click on NEXT to go to the “FINAL RUN” phase.
FINAL RUN
This is the phase where the tester reads and assigns the weights for unbalance correction.
Continue the procedure and follow the on-screen instructions. Continue applying the
correction weights as described in the tables that will be displayed.
Continue until the tester indicates an IDEAL VALUE in the table lower than or equal
to 2.1 grams Having reached the correct value, click on “EXIT” and confirm to print the
test.
IMPORTANT
The procedure does not end automatically but only by selecting “EXIT”.
The procedure is complete when the transmission shaft is balanced.
Maserati Academy
368
Introduction to Maserati
Graziano Differential
Graziano Differential
Maserati Academy
369
Introduction to Maserati
Graziano Differential
Graziano Differential
The limited slip differential built by
Graziano is used in the Quattroporte
and GranTurismo in combination with
the
ZF
automatic
transmission
(M139GQ and M145BL)
The rear differential compensates for the different wheel movements.
The configuration of this differential provides for:
•
25% locking during acceleration
•
45% locking during deceleration
It is fastened to the chassis by means of specific cast iron mounts
TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS
Self-locking differential , Limited Slip type
Oil type: Shell Spirax S 75W140
Quantity: 1litre
Bevel gear pair: spiral with involute gear tooth profile
Final drive ratio for GranTurismo: 15/56
Final drive ratio for Quattroporte: 13/46
Support bearings: tapered rollers
Pinion axial clearance restored by means of a collapsible spacer
Maserati Academy
370
Introduction to Maserati
Graziano Differential
Checking the clearance between the crest and the tooth of the pinion and crown
wheel:
Undo the retaining screws of the differential housing cover.
Remove the axle shaft coupling flange and the relative bearing. Then turn over the
cover and remove the snap ring from the inside.
Place the cover in a press and, using a punch of suitable dimensions, remove the
differential flange shaft. Fit the differential cover and temporarily secure it with three or
four screws, then fit a base (1) onto it, which must be screwed onto one of the cover
fittings.
Position a dial gauge with a magnetic mount (2) on the base (1).
1
1
2
Maserati Academy
371
Introduction to Maserati
Graziano Differential
The plunger of the dial gauge must be positioned on the crown wheel diameter marking
(Æ 224mm), shown on the specific tool.
Check that the clearance between the pinion and the crown wheel is between 0.08 and
0.10 mm.
If the value falls within the specified values, complete the assembly stages.
Remove the magnetic mount, the dial
gauge and the differential cover.
Place the cover in a press and, using a
punch of suitable dimensions, fit the
differential flange shaft.
Fit the snap ring.
1
Refit the cover and tighten
the differential housing
cover retaining screws to a
torque of 28.5 – 31.5 Nm.
Replacing the flange O-ring on the transmission shaft side and checking the end
float of the pinion
Before removing the fastening ring nut, check the residual rolling torque using a torque
wrench with dial indicator on the flange nut. The inspection must be performed when the
differential
is removed or when the axle shafts are disconnected and without oil. With the differential
crown wheel removed and without oil, the rolling torque must be equal to 1Nm ± 0,5 Nm.
With the complete differential, without oil and with the axle shafts disconnected, the rolling
torque must be 3Nm ± 1Nm. This torque must be checked once again after the flange has
been tightened. Using a suitable punch, remove the two flattened parts of the flange
retaining nut
Maserati Academy
372
Introduction to Maserati
Graziano Differential
CAUTION!
The flange retaining nut must be
replaced each time it is removed
Apply a tool on the flange to lock its rotation, unscrew the nut and remove it.
Remove the oil seal from its seat. Clean the O-ring residues off the flange striking
surface. Then fit a new O-ring and a new oil seal using a dedicated tool.
Fit the base screwed onto the differential housing. Position a magnetic mount fitted with
plunger in correspondence to the pinion surface
CAUTION!
There must be NO end float of the pinion. The end float is eliminated by
tightening the flange nut on the transmission shaft side. There is no
specific tightening torque. It is recommended to apply a pre-torque and
then check the end float value.
Maserati Academy
373
Introduction to Maserati
Graziano Differential
Fit the flange, apply LOCTITE 270 and screw on a new retaining nut.
Apply a tool on the flange to lock its rotation.
Using a specific bushing, screw on the retaining nut.
IMPORTANT:
The nut tightening torque is related to the end float read by the dial gauge on the pinion
and by the residual rolling torque.
Pre-tighten the new ring nut that secures the flange. Tighten increasing the torque value
torque by 5÷10 Nm at a time, after having duly checked the end float and rolling torque.
With the differential crown wheel removed and without oil, the rolling torque must be
1Nm±0.5;
With the complete differential, without oil and with the axle shafts disconnected, the rolling
torque must be 3Nm ± 1Nm.
When the end float is
equal to zero and after
checking the rolling
torque,
stop
the
tightening
procedure
and flatten the ring nut
that secures the flange.
CAUTION!
If you have to replace the flange O-ring on the transmission shaft
side (if the differential is on the bench) it is advisable to also check
the clearance between the crest and the tooth of the pinion and
crown wheel.
Undo the retaining screws of the differential housing cover. Remove the axle shaft
coupling flange and the relative bearing. Then remove the entire crown wheel of the selflocking unit.
Maserati Academy
374
Introduction to Maserati
Graziano Differential
After fitting the differential assembly, it is advisable to check that the clearance between
the pinion and the crown wheel has not changed and that the measurement falls within the
indicated values: 0.08 – 0.10 mm for the 13/46 final drive (Quattroporte) and 0.08 –
0.11 mm for the 15/56 final drive (GranTurismo)
Remove the magnetic mount, the dial gauge and the differential cover.
Place the cover in a press and, using a punch of suitable dimensions, fit the differential
flange shaft. Fit the snap ring.
1
Subsequently, refit the cover and tighten the differential box cover retaining screws to a
torque of 28.5 – 31.5 Nm.
Maserati Academy
375
Introduction to Maserati
Graziano Differential
Nominal tightening torques for engine/gearbox assembly-transmission coupling:
PART
Flanged T.E. screw fastening Flexplate
to converter
T.C.E.I screw fastening converter
cover to gearbox
Hex. nut with edge fastening converter
cover to engine
T.E. screw fastening starter motor
T.C.E.I screw fastening mounting
bracket to gearbox
Hex. nut with edge fastening rubber
bushing to gearbox mount. bracket
T.E. screw fastening rubber bushing to
cross member
Hex. nut fastening rubber bushing to
cross member
T.C.E.I screw fastening oil pipes
Screw fastening transmission shaft to
gearbox
Stud bolt fastening transmission shaft
to differential
T.C.E.I screw fastening transmission
shaft central mount
T.E. screw fastening rubber bushings
to rear frame
T.C.E.I screw fastening gearbox
mount. cross member to frame
T.C.E.I screw fastening transmission
shaft mount. cross member to frame
Maserati Academy
THREAD
MATERIAL
TIGHTENING
TORQUE
M10X1.5 mm
Steel Cl 10.9
56 Nm
M10X1.5 mm
Steel Cl 10.9
49 Nm
M10X1.25 mm
Steel Cl 10.9
60 Nm
M8
Steel Cl 8.8
25 Nm
M10X1.5 mm
Steel Cl 10.9
56 Nm
M12x1.75 mm
Steel Cl 10.9
120 Nm
M10X1.25 mm
Steel Cl 10.9
50 Nm
M10X1.25 mm
Steel Cl 8.8
50 Nm
M8
Steel Cl 8.8
24 Nm
M10X1.5 mm
Steel Cl 12.9
30 Nm + 90°
M10X1.5 mm
Steel Cl 12.9
30 Nm + 90°
M8
Steel Cl 8.8
24 Nm
M14x1.5 mm
Steel Cl 8.8
120 Nm
M8
Steel Cl 8.8
23 Nm
M8
Steel Cl 8.8
23 Nm
376
Introduction to Maserati
Electric and Electronic Systems
4
Electric and Electronic Systems
Maserati Academy
377
Introduction to Maserati
Electric and Electronic Systems
PRESENT SITUATION OF MULTIPLEXED ARCHITECTURES IN THE GROUP
Electronic architecture for small cars:
VENICE (VEhicle Network with Integrated Control Electronics)
•
Mod. 188 (Fiat Punto)
Electronic architecture for medium cars:
VENICE PLUS or miniFLORENCE
•
Mod. 937 (Alfa 147)
•
Mod. 192 (Fiat Stilo)
Electronic architecture for luxury cars:
FLORENCE (Fiat Luxury car ORiented Network Control Electronics)
•
Mod. 841 (Lancia Thesis)
•
Maserati M139 & M145
NAB
Maserati Academy
378
Introduction to Maserati
Electric and Electronic Systems
THE FLORENCE CAN ARCHITECTURE
The Florence architecture permits the exchange of information between the various ECU’s
through different levels of telecommunication networks. The networks are the following:
Ö
Ö
Ö
Ö
Ö
Ö
C-CAN Network
I-CAN Network (M139 only, used for TV and data communication )
B-CAN Network
K Network (serial-line for diagnostics of the C-CAN nodes)
A-BUS Network
W-BUS Network(serial-line connecting the Body Computer and the
Bosch Motronic for recovery of the immobilizer)
The complete structure of the FLORENCE network is illustrated by the following figure that
represent the Maserati Quattroporte, and it comprises three different levels of network
for CAN communication:
•
The C-CAN Network for the dynamical control of the vehicle’s powertrain
(high speed network)
•
The B-CAN Network for the comfort functions of the vehicle’s bodywork (low
speed network)
•
The I-CAN Network (Maserati Quattroporte only) for the data communication
and the TV - the infotainment system
The C-CAN e B-CAN networks are interconnected through a gateway for the transfer of
common information located inside the Body Computer Node (NBC).
The abbreviations of the names of the nodes in the two vehicles are presented in the
table.
Maserati Academy
379
Introduction to Maserati
Electric and Electronic Systems
A-BUS:
The A-BUS is a serial line with a MULTIMASTER management system working with a
velocity of 4800 baud. It is utilised to exchange information between the control units and
to perform the diagnostics, and is a terminal to terminal communication. The transmitting
and receiving ECU’s are always identified. Please note that even if the communication is
terminal to terminal, the ECU’s connected to the line might be more than two. In the case
of a conflict between two ECU’s in simultaneous transmission, there is a well defined
priority table which gives each control unit the permission to regain access to the bus.
The control units connected through the A-BUS on the FLORENCE network are:
• CSP (Rain and Twilight Sensor ECU)
• CAV (Motion Alarm ECU)
• CTC (Windscreen Wipers ECU)
• CSA (Alarm System Siren ECU)
THE BODY COMPUTER IS THE HEART OF THE SYSTEM:
Interface function for all of the networks
Gateway between the B-CAN and the C-CAN networks
Master of the Network Management
Master of the A-BUS Network
Slave in the W-BUS Network
Master of the K-line
Diagnostic interface (EOBD connector)
Interface towards the CPL (dashboard control unit for the piloting of functions)
Diagnostics on the CAN-line for the B-CAN Network
IMMOBILIZER unit incorporated
Maserati Academy
380
Introduction to Maserati
Electric and Electronic Systems
IMMOBILIZER
Antenna
+ 12V
Immo-relay
OOOOO
Engine
Control
Module
W
K
Body
Computer
C-CAN
•
The above diagram represents the immobilizer system as used on vehicles using the
Florence architecture (M139 and M145) and fitted with Motronic ME7.1.1 system.
•
After reading the key code from the ignition key, the body computer asks confirmation
of the key code to the engine control unit over the C-CAN line.
•
The W-line (ISO 9141) is used as a back up safety line for the immobilizer system.
•
At ignition On, the body computer performs a check of the integrity of the W-line.
•
Shortly after, the engine control unit activates the immobilizer relay to connect to the Kline (ISO 9141), enabling by this way the possibility for diagnostics read out.
On the M138 model, which has no C-CAN line, the W-line is the main
communication medium for the immobilizer function.
On vehicles using the Motronic ME9 engine control system, the K-line
to the engine control unit and the W-line have been dropped.
Immobilizer function is using C-CAN only for communication between
the body computer and the engine control unit. Consequently the
immobilizer relay has been dropped also.
Maserati Academy
381
Introduction to Maserati
Electric and Electronic Systems
IMMOBILIZER
Immobilizer ME9:
Maserati Academy
382
Introduction to Maserati
Electric and Electronic Systems
POSITION OF ECUs AND NODES
1. CAF
Headlights set-up ECU
14. NPG
Driver's door node
2. NCS
Suspension control node
15. NPP
Passenger's door node
3. NCR
Automatic gearbox node
16. NIM
Inside roof node
4. NCM
Engine control node
17. NQS
Instrument panel node
5. NFR
Brake system node
18. CSP
Rain/ twilight sensor ECU
6. NAS
Steering angle node
19. CTC
Windscreen wiper ECU
7. NSP
Parking sensors node
20. CAV
Motion-sensing alarm ECU
8. CSG
Power steering ECU
21. CSA
Alarm system siren ECU
9.
Airbag node
22. NTV
TV node
10. NVO
STEERING WHEEL NODE
23. DSP
Hi-fi system amplifier
11. NVB
Luggage compartment node
24. NIT
IT node
12. NCL
Air conditioning and heating
system node
25. NBC
Body Computer Node
26. NTP
Tyre Pressure Node
NAB
13. NAG
Drive set-up node
Maserati Academy
383
Introduction to Maserati
Electric and Electronic Systems
HEADLIGHT SET-UP ECU (CAF)
The Headlight Set-up ECU (CAF) interconnects with the front wiring.
It manages the following functions:
•
CAF failure warning light control (directly to the control panel)
•
It receives a signal from the front axle potentiometer, and a signal from the rear axle
potentiometer,
•
Positive signal for headlights enable from CPL
•
It receives a vehicle speed signal from the brake system node (NFR)
•
Right and left-hand adjuster actuator (vertically only)
Maserati Academy
384
Introduction to Maserati
Electric and Electronic Systems
SUSPENSION CONTROL NODE (NCS)
The suspension control node manages information on the following networks:
•
C-CAN (information, data),
•
K LINE (diagnostics)
It manages the following functions:
•
Accelerometer on front RH and LH shock absorber fitting.
•
Accelerometer on front RH and LH wheel
•
Accelerometer on rear cross member
•
Via C-CAN, it reads the vehicle speed, the steering angle and other information
•
It manages the shock absorbers’ solenoid valves (operated when power supply is
connected)
Maserati Academy
385
Introduction to Maserati
Electric and Electronic Systems
ROBOTIZED GEARBOX NODE (NCR)
The robotized gearbox node manages information on the following networks:
•
C-CAN (information, data)
•
K LINE (diagnoses)
It manages the following functions:
•
Selection solenoid valves
•
Engagement solenoid valves
•
Clutch solenoid valve
•
Relay for pump (new type)
•
Clutch position sensor
•
Engagement position sensor
•
Selection position sensor
•
Reverse lights relay
•
Tachometer input signal from engine control node (NCM)
•
It acquires the M/A Shift, Ice (Low grip) commands
Maserati Academy
386
Introduction to Maserati
Electric and Electronic Systems
ENGINE CONTROL NODE (NCM)
4
The engine control node (NCM) is connected to the following networks:
•
C-CAN for data transfer with other vehicle systems (Motronic ME9: also for
diagnostics)
•
K-line for diagnostics (only for Motronic ME7)
It manages the following systems and components:
•
Complete engine control system (injection, ignition, throttle, intake timing variation)
•
Secondary air system
•
Catalytic converter protection strategy
•
Cooling fans
•
A/C compressor activation
•
Immobilizer function
•
Engine oil pressure and level warning lights
•
MIL activation
•
Fuel pump, EVAP system, DMTL system
Note: on vehicles fitted with the Motronic ME9 system, the NCM is fitted in a new location
in the engine compartment.
Maserati Academy
387
Introduction to Maserati
Electric and Electronic Systems
BRAKE SYSTEM NODE (NFR)
The interface with the brake system manages information on the following networks.
•
C-CAN (information, data)
•
K LINE (diagnoses)
The brake system node is connected to the front wiring
It manages the following functions:
•
Yaw sensor
•
Wheel speed sensors
•
System pressure sensor
•
MSP Off button
•
Hardware signal for vehicle speed
•
It receives the steering angle signal from the steering angle node (NAS)
Maserati Academy
388
Introduction to Maserati
Electric and Electronic Systems
STEERING ANGLE SENSOR NODE (NAS)
The Steering Angle Sensor Node performs the following functions:
•
It receives and transmits information via C-CAN line
•
It interconnects with the front wiring to send information to the brake system node
(NFR)
•
It sends a signal to the suspension control system:
N.B: in the event of repairs/operations on the steering system, the sensor must be
calibrated.
Maserati Academy
389
Introduction to Maserati
Electric and Electronic Systems
PARKING SENSOR NODE (NSP)
The Parking Sensor Node performs the following functions:
•
It receives and transmits information via B-CAN line (e.g.: data, commands) and
diagnoses
•
It interconnects with the front, rear and rear bumper wiring.
It manages the following functions:
•
Front and rear buzzer signal
•
Front sensors enable button
•
Trailer attachment set-up
•
Warning light on NSP button
•
Front sensors
N.B: The ECU differs depending on whether the vehicle is fitted with front and rear
parking sensors or just rear sensors.
Maserati Academy
390
Introduction to Maserati
Electric and Electronic Systems
POWER STEERING ECU (CSG)
8
The CSG interconnects with the front wiring and manages information via the following
network:
•
K LINE for diagnostics
It manages the following functions:
•
Negative control signal for failure warning light
•
It operates the solenoid valve (when powered)
•
It receives a vehicle speed signal from the brake system node (NFR)
Maserati Academy
391
Introduction to Maserati
Electric and Electronic Systems
AIRBAG NODE (NAB)
The airbag system interface is set up for connection via B-CAN line.
The Airbag Node performs the following functions:
•
It receives and transmits information via B-CAN line
•
It interconnects with the dashboard wiring (blue connector) and the passenger
compartment wiring (brown connector)
It manages the following functions:
•
Passenger airbag cut-out (not USA version)
•
Front passenger's side airbag
•
Front driver’s side airbag
•
Rear and front pretensioners
•
Front satellite signal (crash zone sensors)
•
Side Bags
•
Head Bags
•
Signal from seat belts fastened sensor (Buckle switches)
•
Side satellite signal
Maserati Academy
392
Introduction to Maserati
Electric and Electronic Systems
STEERING WHEEL NODE (NVO)
The Steering Wheel Node performs the following functions:
•
It receives and transmits information via B-CAN line (e.g.: commands)
•
It interconnects with the dashboard wiring by means of the clock spring
•
It manages the controls on the steering wheel
•
It does not have a diagnosis function
Maserati Academy
393
Introduction to Maserati
Electric and Electronic Systems
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT NODE (NVB)
The Luggage Compartment Node performs the following functions:
•
It receives and transmits information via B-CAN line (e.g.: diagnosis, warning lights,
commands, data)
•
It interconnects with the rear wiring
It manages the following functions:
•
All the rear door devices
•
Positive control signal for rear headrest lowering electromagnets.
•
Luggage compartment opening/closing
•
Luggage compartment lighting
•
Rear windows sunshade lowering control
•
It receives the signal from the inertia switch
Maserati Academy
394
Introduction to Maserati
Electric and Electronic Systems
HEATING, VENTILATION AND AIR CONDITIONING NODE (NCL)
The air conditioning and heating system interfaces with the rest of the vehicle by means of
specific sectioning.
It has pre-assembled wiring (specific serial line for actuator management)
It is connected to the B-CAN line
It monitors and manages the air conditioning and heating system and the passenger
compartment ventilation system.
It manages the following functions:
•
Anti-pollution sensor
•
Demisting sensor
•
Sunlight sensor
•
Actuators
•
Ventilation
Maserati Academy
395
Introduction to Maserati
Electric and Electronic Systems
DRIVE SET-UP NODE (NAG)
1
3
This node is located underneath the driver’s seat.
It receives and transmits information via B-CAN line (e.g.: diagnoses/commands)
It manages the following functions:
•
Seat and steering column movement
•
Memorisation of the seat / steering column / external rear view mirror positions
•
Memorisation of the external rear view mirror positions on the passenger’s side in
reverse gear
•
Easy entry / exit function (enabled / disabled with the NIT)
•
Seat heating (opt.)
Maserati Academy
396
Introduction to Maserati
Electric and Electronic Systems
DRIVER'S DOOR NODE (NPG)
The Driver's Door Node is an ECU incorporated into the controls.
The Driver's Door Node performs the following functions:
•
It receives and transmits information via B-CAN line (e.g.: diagnoses, warning lights,
commands, data)
•
It integrates the four doors’ power window controls and the rear windows’ inhibit
control
•
It interconnects with the wiring on the front door on the driver’s side
•
It acquires the outside temperature signal
•
It acquires the door lock control signal on the dashboard
•
It acquires the mirror control signals
•
It manages the power window and the anti-trapping mechanism on the driver’s side
•
External rear view mirror movement on driver’s side
•
Lock / unlock driver’s side door
•
It manages the step lights under the door and the mirrors and the courtesy lights at
the driver’s feet
Maserati Academy
397
Introduction to Maserati
Electric and Electronic Systems
PASSENGER’S DOOR NODE (NPP)
The Passenger's Door Node is an ECU integrated with the power window control.
The Passenger's Door Node performs the following functions:
•
It receives and transmits information via B-CAN line (e.g.: diagnoses, warning lights,
commands, data)
•
It incorporates the front power window control on the passenger’s side
•
It interconnects with the wiring on the front door on the passenger’s side
•
It acquires the door unlock control signal on the dashboard
•
It manages the power window and finger-trap prevention device on the passenger
side
•
External rear view mirror movement on passenger’s side
•
Lock / unlock passenger’s side door
•
It manages the step lights under the door and the mirrors and the courtesy lights at
the passenger’s feet
Maserati Academy
398
Introduction to Maserati
Electric and Electronic Systems
IMPERIAL NODE (NIM)
The Imperial Node performs the following functions:
•
It receives and transmits information via B-CAN line (e.g.: diagnoses, warning lights,
commands, data)
It manages the following functions:
•
Gearbox fluid level input
•
Front ceiling light
•
Tyre Pressure Calibration (opt.)
•
Glove compartment opening
•
It manages the repetition of the ‘passenger airbag Off’ warning light located on the
ceiling light
•
Serial line to analogue clock.
Maserati Academy
399
Introduction to Maserati
Electric and Electronic Systems
INSTRUMENT PANEL NODE (NQS)
The Instrument Panel Node is an electronic microprocessor which performs the following
functions:
•
It receives and transmits information via B-CAN line (e.g.: diagnoses, warning lights,
commands, data)
•
It interconnects with the dashboard wiring
•
It manages all the information displayed on the control panel.
Maserati Academy
400
Introduction to Maserati
Electric and Electronic Systems
RAIN/TWILIGHT SENSOR ECU (CSP)
The rain and twilight sensor ECU interfaces with the CAN line, with the windscreen wiper
ECU (CTC) and with the body computer node (NBC) (for the twilight sensor)
It manages the following functions:
•
Serial A-BUS line to rain/twilight sensor
•
+15 for twilight/rain sensor ECU
N.B: The sensor is fitted on the windscreen.
Maserati Academy
401
Introduction to Maserati
Electric and Electronic Systems
WINDSCREEN WIPER ECU (CTC)
The Windscreen wiper ECU is an electronic and electromechanical control unit which
operates the windscreen wiper motor according to the information received via the A-Bus
from the rain sensor and the steering column stalk commands (wired directly)
The CTC interface performs the following functions:
•
It receives and transmits information via serial line (rain sensor signal, windscreen
wipers activated)
•
It interconnects with the front wiring
•
1st and 2nd speed control signal from steering column stalk
•
Rain sensor sensing range controlled from steering column stalk
•
Windscreen washer pump control signal from steering column stalk
•
Power supply for windscreen wipers ECU
•
Power supply for windscreen wipers
Maserati Academy
402
Introduction to Maserati
Electric and Electronic Systems
MOTION-SENSING ALARM ECU (CAV)
The CAV is an electronic component supplied with the front ceiling light which is
connected to the serial A-bus line by means of the inside roof panel wiring.
It incorporates the motion-sensing anti-inclination sensors and it manages the motionsensors' deactivation buttons
Maserati Academy
403
Introduction to Maserati
Electric and Electronic Systems
ALARM SYSTEM SIREN ECU (CSA)
The Alarm System Siren ECU performs the following functions:
•
It receives/ transmits information regarding diagnosis and attempt theft to the body
computer node (NBC) via serial A-BUS line.
•
It interconnects with the front wiring
Maserati Academy
404
Introduction to Maserati
Electric and Electronic Systems
TV NODE (NTV)
The module consist of a Diversity Television receiver with aerials incorporated into the
rear window
It interfaces with the user by means of the NIT via I-CAN
It interfaces with the television wiring harnass.
Maserati Academy
405
Introduction to Maserati
Electric and Electronic Systems
HI-FI AMPLIFIER SYSTEM (DSP)
The hi-fi system amplifier interconnects with the rear wiring.
It manages the following functions:
•
Signal for front and rear woofer.
•
Rear LH and RH speaker
•
Central speaker
•
Secondary amplifiers activation.
Maserati Academy
406
Introduction to Maserati
Electric and Electronic Systems
IT NODE (NIT)
The IT Info Node is an ECU located in the centre of the dashboard which integrates
informative, IT, audio/ video and air conditioning and heating system programming
functions. The NIT has a multifunction display and a series of controls for interaction
connected to the main electronic unit.
The IT Node - NIT- performs the following functions:
•
It receives and transmits information via B-CAN line (e.g.: diagnosis, data)
•
It incorporates the menu interaction controls
•
It manages a high definition colour display for varied information and navigation or the
TV
•
It interconnects with the dashboard wiring for the connection to the vehicle’s electric
system
•
It interconnects with the IT wiring for the point-to-point connection with the TV tuner,
CD changer
•
It interfaces with the GPS, GSM and radio aerials by means of coaxial cables
•
Vehicle setup
N.B: The telephone module (opt.) is fitted separately underneath the Silver Box.
Maserati Academy
407
Introduction to Maserati
Electric and Electronic Systems
BODY COMPUTER NODE (NBC)
The Body Computer Node (fitted in the dashboard underbody on the steering wheel side)
is composed of an electronic section and a electromechanical section (CPL) which are
interconnected and constitute a single set (Dashboard Node). Both the electronic and the
electromechanical sections perform interconnecting functions with the system and have
fixed connectors for the link to the front, rear and dashboard wiring.
The electromechanical section contains the fuses and the remote control switches while
the electronic section contains an EOBD fixed connector (J1962-compliant) capable of
carrying out diagnoses of the Engine Control Node and the systems not connected on the
line B-CAN via the K LINE and diagnoses of the nodes connected to the B-CAN line via
this latter.
The Body Computer sets up a two-way gateway between the
C-CAN/ B-CAN networks.
The connectors for the links with the front and rear wiring (and with the EOBD) are
accessible from the front (fuses side) while those for the links with the dashboard wiring
are located on the opposite side.
Maserati Academy
408
Introduction to Maserati
Electric and Electronic Systems
BODY COMPUTER NODE (NBC)
The electronic section of the Body Computer Node performs the following functions:
•
It receives and transmits information on the B-CAN (e.g.: diagnosis, warning lights ,
commands, data) and C-CAN lines (e.g. warning lights, control signals, data)
•
It receives and transmits information on the two-way A-BUS serial line for the alarms,
windscreen wipers, twilight sensor
•
It interconnects with the front and rear dashboard wiring
•
It enables the diagnosis interfacing (J1962-compliant joint)
•
It is connected to the CPL to measure the power supplies/ read signals and to
operate the remote control switches
•
It manages the Immobilizer / remote control / alarm (in the event of disconnection of
the CAN line), recovery is enabled via the W line to the engine control node
•
Configuration of vehicle’s electronic systems (stored at line end)
•
Vehicle access (door lock/unlock)
•
Internal / external lights management
•
Headlight washers
•
SPORT button management
Maserati Academy
409
Introduction to Maserati
Electric and Electronic Systems
TYRE PRESSURE NODE (NTP)
The NTP manages the tyre temperature and pressure information.
It acquires the tyre condition data and the calibration request via B-CAN
Maserati Academy
410
Introduction to Maserati
Electric and Electronic Systems
AUTOMATIC GEARBOX NODE (NCA)
The automatic gearbox node positioned inside the gearbox (lower part) controls the
information through the following networks:
•
C-CAN (data transfer with other vehicle systems and diagnostics)
It controls the following functions:
•
Tachometric input signal and engine torque from Engine control node (NCM)
•
Receives the commands from the gearshift lever by means of an integrated position
sensor.
•
It receives information from the various driver commands from the Body Computer
over the B-can line.
Maserati Academy
411
Introduction to Maserati
Diagnostics
5
Diagnostics
Maserati Academy
412
Introduction to Maserati
Diagnostics
DIAGNOSTICS
OBD-II / EOBD connector
The 16-pin diagnostic connector is standardised in accordance with OBD-II / EOBD
standards (for Europe: from EURO 3 onward). The first Maserati with the 16-pin OBD-II /
EOBD connector was the 3200GT of 1998. For vehicles with Florence electronic
architecture (M139 and M145), the ODB-II / EOBD connector is located on the Body
Computer. The diagnostic connector is the interface between the tester (SD3) and the
various communication networks.
OBDOBD-II / EOBD connector
Quattroporte OBD-II / EOBD connector pinout:
Maserati Academy
413
Introduction to Maserati
Diagnostics
DIAGNOSTICS
Quattroporte MY07 Automatic and Gran Turismo OBD-II / EOBD connector pinout
In compliance with ISO / SAE standards, for all cars from MY08 onward, Scan Tool must
be available on the CAN line. For the Quattroporte from MY07 and Automatic, and for the
GranTurismo, a new pinout assignment for the OBD-II / EOBD connector has been
introduced. This makes it necessary to use a new "Switch Matrix" diagnostic cable.
All diagnostics for cars with Florence architecture are performed with the
SD3 tester!
Maserati Academy
414
Introduction to Maserati
Maserati Academy – March 2009
Maserati reserves the right to make any modification to the vehicles described in this manual, at any
time, for either technical or commercial reasons. All rights reserved. This document must not be
reproduced, even partially, without the written consent of Maserati S.p.A.
Maserati Academy
415